&EPA
          United States
          Environmental Protection
          Agency
           Environmental Research
           Laboratory
           Athens GA 30613
EPA/600/9-86/024
August 1986
          Research and Development
Problems of Aquatic
Toxicology,
Biotesting and
Water Quality
Management:

Proceedings of
USA-USSR
Symposium,
Borok, Jaroslavl Oblast,
July 30-August 1, 1984

-------

-------
                                  DISCLAIMER
     The information in this document has been funded in part by the United
States Environmental Protection Agency.  Papers describing EPA-sponsored re-
search have been subject to the Agency's peer and administrative review, and
the proceedings have been approved for publication as an EPA document.  Men-
tion of trade names or commercial products does not constitute endorsement
or recommendation for use by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.
                                     11

-------
                                   FOREWORD
     For almost a decade and a half, cooperation and exchange ot scientific
information under the US-USSR Agreement on Cooperation in the Field of
Environmental Protection has helped both countries in their efforts to con-
trol environmental pollution.  These efforts are pursued in recognition of
the international nature of the problem:  pollution knows no boundaries.

     Three projects are under the joint US-USSR Agreement's Working Group
on Cooperation in the Area of Water Pollution Prevention.  These are:
Project 02.02-11 "Planning and Management ot Water Quality in River Basins,"
Project 02.02-12 "Protection and Management of Water Quality in Lakes  ana
Estuaries," and Project 02.02-13 "Effect of Pollutants on Aquatic Organisms
and Ecosystems; Development of Water Quality Criteria."

     Over the years, scientific delegations and individual scientists  have
traveled to each other's countries to visit scientific institutions, pertorm
joint research, and exchange technical information.  This Proceedings  pre-
sents the papers that were delivered at the most recent formal symposium,
which was held in Borok, Jaroslavl Ob last in 1984.
                                   Rosemarie C. Russo
                                   Director
                                   Environmental Research Laboratory
                                   Athens, Georgia
                                   USA

-------
                                   PREFACE
     The problem of water pollution and the control of water quality has
assumed international importance due to its urgency.  The pooling of
efforts by scientists from different countries has helped to achieve suc-
cessful solutions.  Within the context of the Soviet-American agreement in
the area of environmental conservation, provision has been made both tor the
carrying out of joint research and the holding of symposia at which special-
ists would be able to discuss results and outline prospects tor further work.

     A regular Soviet-American symposium on the questions of water toxicology
was held in the USSR at the Institute for the Biology of Inland Waters Under
the USSR Academy of Sciences in Borok from 30 July through 1 August 1984.  At
the symposium, eight Soviet and eight American papers were presented and the
materials of these are being published in the current collection.  These
papers reflect the accomplishments of aquatic toxicology at the present stage
of its development and examines the following: water quality in natural
waters, question of utilizing indicators for the functional state of biota in
surface waters, approaches to biotesting of industrial effluents, and prin-
ciples of optimizing development programs for water conservation in the
system of water quality management considering point and non-point pollution
sources.

     Of substantial interest are the results of studying the effect of com-
plex-composition effluents on hydrobionts, the resistance of aquatic animals
to organophosophorus pesticides and the possibilities for further transfer
of toxic organic substances.  The spread of pollutants through the atmosphere
in a number of instances has substantial negative ecological consequences
and the study of this process is of important significance.  In light of this
problem, within the context of Soviet-American collaboration, particular
attention is being paid to studying ammonia toxicity tor fish as well as to
the effect ot low pH values on aquatic animals.

     The symposium, which was held in a spirit ot mutual understanding,
showed that the mutual interest of the United States and the USSR in study-
ing the problem of protecting bodies of water against pollution has success-
fully contributed in this area to the solving of problems confronting scien-
tists from both countries.

                                     N. V. Butorin, Director
                                     Institute for Biology of Inland Waters
                                     Borok, Jaroslavl Oblast
                                     USSR
                                    IV

-------
                                   ABSTRACT
     Sixteen papers delivered by US and USSR scientists at a symposium en-
titled "Problems of Aquatic Toxicology, Biotesting, and Water Quality Man-
agement" are presented.  The effect ot low pU on aquatic invertebrates and
the use of fish behavior in comparing toxic effects of chemicals are examined.
The production, and excretion of ammonia by fish, the relationship between
carbon dioxide excretion and ammonia toxicity, and the acute toxicity of iron
cyanides and thiocyanate to trout are discussed.  Mechanisms of organophos-
phorus pesticide resistance are analyzed.  Biological monitoring and testing
of surface waters and effluent is discussed and a complex effluents toxicity
information system is described.  Processes in the formation of water quality
and trends in the development of water quality in the two countries are out-
lined.  Pollution problems from toxic organic contaminants from point and
non-point sources in the North American Great Lakes are examined.  Agricul-
tural water quality management, including the use of simulation models, is
discussed.
                                      v

-------
                                   CONTENTS


FOREWORD	 iii

PREFACE	„	  iv

ABSTRACT	   v

FUNCTIONAL BASES FOR THE EFFECT OF LOW pH ON FISH
   AND INVERTEBRATES	   1
      G. A. Vinogradov

AMMONIA PRODUCTION AND EXCRETION BY FISH	  19
      D. J. Randall and P. A. Wright

THE USE OF FISH BEHAVIOR IN COMPARING TOXIC EFFECTS
   OF THREE CHEMICALS	  31
      M. G. Henry

RESISTANCE OF AQUATIC ANIMALS TO ORGANOPHOSPHORUS PESTICIDES
   AND ITS MECHANISMS	  37
      V. I. Kozlovskaya, G. M. Chuyko, L. N. Lapkina, and
      V. A. Nepomnyashchikh

ACUTE TOXICITY OF IRON CYANIDES AND THIOCYANATE TO TROUT	  55
      R. V. Thurston and T. A. Heming

PROCESS OF FORMATION OF NATURAL WATER QUALITY	  72
      M. I. Kuz'menko and A. I. Merezhko

C02 EXCRETION AND AMMONIA TOXICITY IN FISHES:  IS THERE A
   RELATIONSHIP?	  83
      T. A. Heming

USE OF INDICATORS OF FUNCTIONAL STATE OF BIOTA IN BIOLOGICAL
   MONITORING OF SURFACE WATERS	  95
      V. A. Bryzgalo,  L. S. Federova, T. A. Khoruzhaya,
      L. S. Kosmenko, and L. P. Sokolova

LONG RANGE TRANSPORT OF TOXIC ORGANIC CONTAMINANTS TO THE
   NORTH AMERICAN GREAT LAKES	 107
      W. R. Swain, M. D. Mullin, and J. C. Filkins

BIOLOGICAL TESTING OF INDUSTRIAL EFFLUENT	 122
      A. M. Beym


                                    vii

-------
COMPLEX EFFLUENTS TOXICITY INFORMATION SYSTEM	 136
      R. C. Russo, A. Pilli, and J. Crane

OPTIMIZING A PROGRAM FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF WATER CONSERVATION
   IN A SYSTEM OF WATER QUALITY MANAGEMENT CONSIDERING POINT
   AND NON-POINT POLLUTION SOURCES.	 150
      G. A. Sukhorukov

GREAT LAKES AGRICULTURAL POLLUTION  CONTROL
   IN PERSPECTIVE	 168
      V. J. Saulys

MODELING THE FORMATION OF WATER QUALITY IN WATER
   CHANNELS RECEIVING SURFACE RUNOFF FROM FARM LAND	 181
      Ye.  V- Yeremenko, V. Z. Kolpak and N. I. Selyu

CONTROL OF URBAN  NONPOINT SOURCES IN GREAT LAKES BASIN	 201
      D. Athayde, P- Bubar, and J.  Meek

TRENDS  IN  THE DEVELOPMENT OF WATER  QUALITY IN THE
   USSR AND THE US	 219
      L. A. Lesnikov
                                    Vlll

-------
                                ACKNOWLEDGMENT
     Preparation of a Proceedings is frequently a complex task, particularly
when the authors are from two countries with different languages.  Of great
assistance in the preparation of this Proceedings was the contribution of
Dr. Richard A. Schoettger of the Fish and Wildlife Service's Columbia National
Fisheries Research Laboratory who arranged for the translation of the Soviet
manuscripts.  Also essential to its preparation was the dedicated work of
Martha M, Brady of Computer Sciences Corporation who typed the final document.
Their contributions are gratefully acknowledged.
                                     IX

-------
                  FUNCTIONAL BASES FOR THE EFFECT OF LOW pH
                          ON FISH AND INVERTEBRATES

                                    by

                             G.A. Vinogradov-L
                                 ABSTRACT

     Low, acutely toxic pH levels increase the ion permeability ol gill epi-
thelium in lish ana invertebrates.  As a result 01 the increased permeabil-
ity, the rate of salt diliusion Irom the organism increases by several told.
Electrolyte concentration in the blood drops rapidly, there is an intense
intake ot hydrogen ions according to tne concentration gradient into the
inner medium, ana acidosis develops in parallel with salt elimination.  In
lish with low pH values, there are destructive changes in the gill epithel-
ium and these develop most intensely in a medium containing less than 20 mg/£
Ca"*""*".  The pH values that cause substantial changes in gill epithelium
permeability lor Na+ correlate with low limits ol pH values that are en-
countered by adult specimens ol various fish and invertebrate species under
natural conaitions.  Two adaptive processes occur simultaneously in lish in
acclimation to low pH values.  On the one hand, as a consequence of. the re-
duced gill permeability, the elimination of Na+ and Ci~ from the organism
is reduced; on the other, after a significant suppression of the absorption
of IMa"*" and Ci~, a partial recovery ot this process is observed.  As a result
of acclimation, alter 24-4b h, the losses and absorption of Na  are equal-
ized.  This makes it possible to maintain an ion balance between the external
and inner medium on a lower metabolic basis than in neutral ana slightly base
media.  In certain species of crustaceans and mollusks, calcium metabolism
is more sensitive to a decline in the pH than is sodium metabolism.
                         INTRODUCTION AND DISCUSSION

     Early experimental work dealing with the effect of active environmental
reaction on rish established that 0^ uptake Irom water diminishes with de-
cline 01 pH (.Wiebe et al. 1^34;.  The toxic effect was attributed to coagu-
lation ol gill mucus and membranes ot gill epithelium causing  "anoxia ot
coagulate lilm" (.Ellis iy37).  The more precise physiological effect ot this
film on the process ot oxygen uptake from water was investigated relatively
llnstitute of Biology of Inland Waters, USSR Academy of Sciences, Borok,  USSR

-------
recently (Ultsch and Gros 19—) .  It was established thar. mucus secreted
under the ertect ot acid  provides only  partial  decrease  in  permeability
ot fish gills for oxygen.  As a result, asphyxia  develops very slowly and
does not cause  death.

     A decline  or medium  ph  leading to  acidulation of  blood elicits in
most aquatic animals  a decrease in affinity ot  respiratory pigments tor
oxygen.  Ihe dissociation curve shifts  in the direction ot  higher P02
(.Bohr effect) with decline ot pH.   This reflects the correlation between
aftinity of  respiratory pigments for oxygen and their acid-base properties.
On the  basis of this  information,  as well as data concerning signmcant
coagulation  ot  mucus  on fish gill  epithelium, it was believed tor a long
time  that  the toxic etfect of low pH is related  to asphyxia.  Subsequent
studies  refuted the role ot  asphyxia in acid poisoning as the primary
cause  of  fish death (Vinograaov 1*7*, hddy 1974).  Acidulation ot medium
to a  pH of 4.5  elicits a decrease  in oxygen uptake in the carp, and it is
restored within 24 h.  After acclimation ot fish to hypoxia, oxidation ot
water  did not cause a decrease in oxygen uptake.   The results ot experi-
ments  showed that there is something in common in adaptation mechanisms
 that  react to medium oxidation and hypoxia (hogluna 19t>l, Vinogradov 1979).
 Respiratory  systems adapt to ph decline primarily by means of increase
 in oxygen capacity or blood due to increase in hemoglobin,  hematocrit,
 and erythrocyte content (Vaala and Mitchell 1970).

      At the present time, it can be considered  established that the toxic
 etfect of low medium pH is based on functional impairment ot systems ot
 ionic and osmotic regulation localized in the gill epithelium of aquatic
 animals (Maetz 1974,  McWilliams 1980, Packer and Dunson 1970, Packer and
 Dunson 1972, Spry et al. 19til, Vinogradov et al.  197b, Vinogradov et al.
 197b).  At  the present time, it is assumed that specialized chloride cells
 that maintain a specitic Na+ level in blood are possibly the location of
 systems ot  ion transport against a concentration gradient in fish (Laurent
 and Dunel 19bu).  The main element of ionic regulation in freshwater ani-
 mals is active transport of Ma+, K+, Ca"1"*" and Cl~ by the gills from water
 to the endogenous environment, as  well as removal trom the body ot metabo-
 lites such  as NH4 H1", hC03 (Maetz 1973, Payan et ai. 19bl).  Studies
 conducted recently furnished more  information about the mechanism of regu-
 lation of acid-base equilibrium in fish and crustaceans.  It was found that
 Na /H  , Na  /NH4, HCOyCi  turnover in gills of  freshwater fish is of
 substantial significance to maintaining blood ptt (Cameron and Randall 1972,
 Cameron and Randall 1974, Eddy 1974, Randall and Cameron 11*73, Renzis and
 Maetz 1973;.  The correlation between ion uptake through the gills and
 acid-base regulation was studied comprehensively by Haswell et al. (19t>0)
 and Perry et ai. (,19»1).  The rather low permeability of gill epithelium
 tor water and salts plays an important part in adaptation to lite in fresh
 water (.Packer and Dunson 1970, Packer and Dunson 1972, Vinograaov et al.
 197D, Vinogradov et ai.  197b).  Exogenous factors, which increase gill
 permeability, should cause excessive discharge  or electrolytes and cause
 penetration into the body ot undesirable substances.

      Another characteristic that is very important to processes ot ionic
 regulation  in freshwater animals is affinity of ion-absorbing systems ror

-------
concentration 01 substrate  (Na"1",  K+, Ca"1""1", Cl  )  in the exogenous environ-
ment, which is usually referred to as the semi saturation constant  (hams
19/2, Shaw 19b9, Sutclille  19bb,  Sutclille 1971,  Vinograciov 197b).   In
typical  treshwater species,  soaium absorption  begins  with a concentration
ol about U.b mg/Jl, while  saturation occurs at  b-iU mg/i Na+.  The values
are  consiaerably lower lor  potassium ions.   The  kinetics ot Ca"*"1" absorp-
tion are similar to  those lor Na+ ions.   Ca"^"  absorption begins at  concen-
trations ot 0.4-U.^ mg/£.   This process reaches  a maximum rate at  1U-4U
mg/J?,, and the values lor  Na"*~ and  Ca"1""*" ions are similar.  The rate ol K
absorption Irom water is  1/bth-i/iUth the rate lor Na+ ana Ca"1""1" (Vinogra-
dov  et  al. 19«3, Vinogradov et al.  19b4).

      It  was established in  several studies that  a decline ot ph increases
significantly loss of Na"1",  K+, Cl~  and Ca^"1"  ions in lish, crustaceans  and
mollusks (Packer and Dunson 197U, Packer  and Dunson 1972, Vinograaov et
al.  197b, Vinograaov et al.  1979, Vinogradov et  al. 1963;.  Oxidation  ol
the  medium causes manifold  increase in overall Na~*" loss in lish (Figure  la)
and  impairs Ca*~*~ metabolism.  Similar findings have been made in crusta-
ceans ana mollusks (Figure  Ib).  Tnreshola pH  levels  impairing gill perme-
ability tor ions are dilferent in different  animal species.  In the perch
(Perca  tluviatilis L.), which is  one ol the  most  acid-resistant and common
fish species, in reservoirs with high concentration of hydrogen ions,
critical values ot pH are considerably lower than lor other species ot
fish.   Investigation ot  rate ot loss in perch  inhabiting mildly alkaline
water (Rybinskiy Reservoir,  pH 7.fc>-y.U) and  acid  lakes (Lake Motykino  and
Lake Dubrovskoye in Volgograd Oblast, pH  3.b-4.2) revealed that permea-
bility  ot gill  epithelium tor Na+ is one-halt  less in lake fish than those
in  reservoirs (rivers).
                1. Perch  (Perco fluviolilis)
                2. Crucian Carp [Carossius aurotus)
                3. Roach (Rutilus rutilus)
                4. Current Year Salmon (Solmo salon)
                5. Ca**, Current Year Salmon (^ solar)
         1000
       c
       o
       - 500
       in
       v>
       O
       o
       o
          100
           0
  1. Freshwater Shrimp {Gommarus locustris)
  2. Crayfish (Astocus leptodoctylus )
  3. Snail ( Limnoeo stagnalis )
  4, Branchipod  ( Slreptocephalis joseflnae)
                                              400
                                              300
200
                                              100
                                    6      1
                                      Water pH
                                                                      B
Figure 1.  hftect ot  low  pH on rate ot total  loss ot Na"1" in tish(A)  ana
            invertebrates  (ii).

-------
      These aifrerences in permeability become insignificant atter perch
 irom an alkaline environment unaergo b-aay acclimation to water with pH
 3.J5 (.Table 1),  The threshold values lor ambient pH eliciting arastic in-
 crease in gill permeaoility lor ions, as well as resistance to oxidation,
 are the same in both groups ol perch.  These data indicate, in our opinion,(
 the phenotypic nature of differences in fish from dilferent bodies of water.
 TABLE i.  EFFECT OF ACCLIMATION TO ph 3.35 OM Na+ LOSS IN PERCH FROM LAKE
           AND RESERVOIR POPULATIONS

Acclimation,
days
u
3
b

Na"1"
lake
U. 25+0. 14
0.22+0. Ob
o.iy+o.oy

loss, pmol/(g'h)
reservoir
0.4«+0.12
0.25+0.13
0.24+0.11
      As shown by field and laboratory studies,  decrease in sodium concentra-
 tion of blood plasma and its oxidation result from increased permeability of
 gills for ions (.Leivestad and Muniz J.y7b,  Maetz iy73,  Packer and Dunson
 iy7u).  Data in the literature indicate that decline of Na+ content of blood
 and hemolymph of crustaceans is the chief  cause of rapid death of fish and
 crustaceans in fresh water at low ph (.Vinogradov et al. iy7b, Vinogradov
 lb*7y, Vinogradov iybi, Vinogradov et al. lybJU.  Figure 2 and Table 2 provide
 data on change in concentration of Na+ and ph in the endogenous environment.

      Studies ol survival revealed that freshwater shrimp ^Gammaracanthus
 lacustris; tolerates greater oxidation ol  medium (.ph 4.1-4.2.) in diluted
 salt water than in fresh water (pti 5.0-5.JJ.  Death of the shrimps in
 diluted salt and fresh water occurs at dilferent hemolymph pH and different
 concentrations or  ions.

      In ireshwater shrimp adapted to salt  water, Na+ transport through the
 gills  is inactivated.   Ion content of hemoiymph is due to their levels in
 the  external  environment, and the cavitary fluid is isotonic in relation to
 the  external  environment,  hemolymph is hypertonic in fresh water, in re-
 lation  to  the  external  environment.

     In  diluted  salt water,  these animals  die- at hemolymph pH b.3-6.4 and
 in fresh water at  higher ph.   Ion content  of hemolymph in shrimp from
 fresh water diminishes with  oxidation of water  and reaches the same criti-
 cal values before  death  as in desalinated  distilled water.  The toxic
 eltect of low ph is drastically  enhanced when Na+ concentration in water is
less than O.b-0.7 mmoi/£.  Gammaracanthus  adapted to water with 0.4  mmoi/
NaCl died at ph 5.5-5.7.   This is probably related to  diminished absorp-
 tion or Na~*~ irom water containing  less  than  U.b  mmoJ-/£, as well  as ae-
crease in sodium concentration and osmotic pressure  ol  hemoiymph due to

-------
o
CD
c
c
o
o
         6 -
       o
       c
       o
       o
       o 4
       o
       2
       X
       a.
                         Hn

                           ^,
                                                       B
               I      2     3
                Condition

          (l-distilled water, pH 3.7;
          2-distilled water, pH 5.6-6-5;
          3- fresh water, pH 7.5 )
                                     T>
                                     O
                                     O
                                     CD
ion
                              c  6
                              0)
                              o
                              o  5
                              0  4
                              O
                              o
    Hh
I

                                                                •d
                                                                 I
                                             Condition
                                  (l-distilled water, pH 3.8;
                                  2- river water, pH 3.8;
                                  3-distilled water  plus 70mg/ICa++,
                                  4- river water, pH 7.4)
figure  2.   ph ana Na+ concentration in blood ot  roach iRutilus rutilusj  (A)
            and crucian  carp  (.Carassius auratus)  (B)  as a runction ot  di±±er-
            ent ambient  conditions, according to  Vinogradov et al.,
            Vinogradov et  ai.,  I^b3, Vinogradov et  ai., lb»7b.
TAULb  2.   CONCENTkAllON  OF  ELECTROLYTES AND ph  01  HEMOLYMPH bEFORE DEATH
           OF GAMMARACANTHUS LACUSTRiS IN ACID MEDIUM AND DISTILLED WATER
                                                                     Number o±
                    Electrolyte and Na~*~ concentration                expen-
     Acclimation  in hemolymph, ymol (scaled to NaCl)   Hemoiymph    mentai-
 ph  environment	electrolytes	sodium	pH	animals
3.1  Diluted salt
     water (L27°)

3 .3  Fresh water

3.5  Diluted salt

     water (12%)

4 .5  Fresh water

7.0  Distilled
     water
                   310 + 15


                   105 + 10

                   305 + 15



                   105 + 15
255 + 5
       5.35 +0.1
100 + 10       6.6  +0.2       4

255 + 10       6.4 +  0.1       5


 yo + 15       b.y5 + 0.15      6

 yo + 5        7.6 +  o.i       6

-------
 insult icient affinity o±  the sodium-transporting system in this range or
 concentrations.  Among crustaceans, as in ±ish, acid-resistant species
 encountered in acid waters do not present excessive loss of salts in ex-
 periments over a wide range of changes in concentration of hydrogen ions.
 According to our data, threshold pH increasing discharge of Na"1" in the
 hog slater Usellus aquaticus) is 3.1-3.2 and for the freshwater shrimp
 iCammarus lacustris) 5.5-b.b, which is consistent with the results of
 field studies (Malley
      Thus,  the viability of some species of freshwater fish and crusta-
 ceans in acid waters is largely determined by the tolerance o± integument,
 primarily gill epithelium, to low ambient pH without change in permeabil-
 ity of these tissues for monovalent Ma"1", Cl  and HT" ions.

      General tissue permeability to substances is determined  by its  cellu-
 lar (.membrane) and intercellular elements.  The correlation between  rates
 of excessive loss of Na, K+ and CX~ ions through fish gills in an  acid
 medium corresponds to the concentrations of these ions in blood and  their
 mobility (Vinogradov et al. iS>79).  This is indicative primarily of  in-
 crease in intercellular permeability in an acid medium,  hlectron micro-
 scope studies of reaction of fish gill epithelium to an acidulated medium
 revealed that the increase in passive exit of Na+ under the effect of low
 pH is attributable to impairment of intercellular interactions in  gill
 epithelium.  Thus, in the crucian carp placed in water at ph  3.t>,  there
 is impairment of integrity of external cell membranes and lysis of some
 parts of them (Vinogradov et al. 19b3).  There is widening of intercellu-
 lar spaces  in the region of simple connections.  In some cases, there is
 partial impairment of solid connections of the apical segments of  gill
 epithelial  cells.

      On the basis of data concerning excessive loss of Na"1", K+ and Cl~
 in an acid  medium, as well as the capacity of calcium ions  to normalize
 these losses, the hypothesis was expounded that the protective effect
 of Ca"1""1" on  fish at low pH is based on  the  properties  of Ca"*"1"  to cement
 intercellular contacts with exposure to  factors that  disintegrate  the
 gill epithelium (Vinogradov et al. i97y).  With pH 3.6, Ca"1"1"  normalizes
 not only Na+ metabolism in Carassius carassius L. ,  but maintains acid-base
 homeostasis.  In the absence of Ca"1"1" ions, there is a drastic drop of
 blood Na"1" level.  It is oxidized (Figure 2) and fish death occurs within
 7-8 h.   Ga"1"1" capacity to stabilize in an acid medium both sodium and acid-
 base homeostasis indicates that Ca"1""1" ions limit gill permeability not
 only to Na+, but to h+.

      It was established in several works that Ca"1"1" and Kg"*""1" ions affect
 permeability of gill epithelium for Na"1" and Cl~ in freshwater and  euryha-
 line fish (Evans iy7i>, Maetz iy/4, Potts and Fleming iy — ).   In our  exper-
 iments,  we  studied the effect of Ca"1""1" on permeability of gill epithelium
 of  the  crucian carp (Carassius  auratusj tor Ma+ in a neutral  (ph 6.&-7.U)
 and  an  acid medium (ph 3.h).   It was shown that, with a neutral medium reac-
 tion, the increase in Ga"1""1" concentration in water  lowers the discharge of
Na"1"  from  the  body.  An increase  in Ca"1"*" content  beyond 30  mg/  £ has  virtu-
 ally no eitect  on  loss  ot  Ma"1" through  the gills, whereas  a  decrease in

-------
Ca"1"1" concentration to less  than  ID  mg/ a elicits drastic increase in per-
meability  ot gills in the crucian carp.   A drop of pH  ±rom b.b to 3.tt  in
distilled  water increases  by  many times the rate  of  loss of Na+ in fish
(.Figure  3a).  These data indicate that an increase in  Ca"1^" concentration
in water has an efrect  on gill epithelium that  is the  opposite of that of
decline  of ptt of the medium.

     The main changes in gill permeability for Na+ are observed within the
rirst  li> mm after addition of Ca"^ to both an  acid  (ph 3.6) and neutral
(.pH  b.b) medium (.Figure 3b>.   However, Na+ loss decreases to less than
1/bth  in acidulated distilled water with added Ca"^1", as compared to a
neutral  medium.  The dynamics ot the process  of increase in permeability
in crucian carp placed  in distilled water at  pH 3.b  are inversely propor-
tionate  to tne change under the eftect ot Ca"^".   The most significant
increase in permeability is observed within the first  few minutes of ex-
posure or  the fisti to an acid medium (.Figure  3b;.

      Investigation of total ha"1" loss  by fish  as related to change in ion
composition of water established that the decline in yield ol Na"1" with
decline  ot water pH is  not  a specilic reaction.   A decrease in total Na
loss is  observed in the perch (.Perca fluviatilis) and  salmon fry (.Salmo
salar) when kept tor  a  long time in distilled water  and CaCl^ solution
 (.Figure 4).   Analysis of  the  results  enables  us to conclude  that  insuf-
 ncient intake  of  Ma"1",  regardless ol  causes,  leads  to decrease in Na+
                         I. Permeability with Change in Medium pH
                         2. Permeability with Change in Ca+* Content, pH 6 8-7.0
                         3. Effect of pH 3.8 on Permeability in Distilled Water
                         4. Effect of Ca*+ (70mg/l) on Permeability, pH 3.8
                         5. Effect of Ca**(70mg/l) on Permeability, pH 6 85
             A.Gill Permeability as Function of Ca++
               and H+ Concentration in Medium
          200
       +
       D
          400
       JD
       o
       a>
       E
       k_
       
-------
        o»
        0)
             0.2
             O.I
                              I, Perch, river  water, pH 4,0
                              2, Perch, distilled water (DW)
                              3. Perch, DW plus Ca++
                              4, Salmon, DW
                          Acclimation Time, days
ligure 4.   Eitect oi aesalinadon ana  low pH on Ma  loss in the perch
           (.Perca tluviatilis) and current  year salmon (Salmo salar).
loss and, probably,  decrease in permeability  ot  gill epithelium.  Evi-
dently, Ca^"4" ions are  not ot basic signi±icance  to regulation ot gill
permeability tor  Na~*~ under natural conditions at optimum pH values in
treshwater tish capable ot living in waters with low mineral content.

     Unlike the phenomenon ot increased gill  permeability, which is dis-
tinctly manitested only with lethal or close  to  lethal ph values, in-
hibition ot Ma"1" transport through the gills ot treshwater tish is observed
in the tolerated  range ot pH values (.Maetz 1S*73, Maetz iy~/4 . Packer and
Dunson 197U, Packer  and Dunson  iy?2).  The extent ot  inhibition  ol Na+
absorption ot iish depends  on  ambient  ph  (.Figure b).   However,  the data
obtained in short-term experiments reliect only  the initial  stage ol
reactions ot sodium- and  chlorine-transport  systems ol treshwater tish to
oxidation ot medium.  Studies dealing with acclimation or tish to decline
oi medium ph revealed that  there  is  partial  or  complete  restoration ot
Ma+ absorption tunction during  acclimation, depending  on intensity ot

-------
exposure  and tish species (Sokolov and Vinogradov  1977;.  The capacity  ot
the soaium-transport system o±  iish  to adapt to acidulation ot medium was
continued in subsequent works (McWilliams 19bU,  Thurston J.y7ya, Vinograaov
et al.  iy?y,).  For exampie, with acclimation oi  the  crucian carp to a ph ot
5.5, the  rate ot Na+ absorption was  signiticantiy  slower already within 3~b
h than in control tish (52-407.,,).  Na+ sorption  increased 12 h atter the
start ot  the experiment, and it constituted 707, and  7'bX ot initial level
atter 24   and 4b h, respectively (Figure fa). A  decline ol pH to 4.5 atter
4b-h acclimation ot the crucian carp to a pH ot  5.5  again elicited a decrease
in Na  transport.  Na+ absorption atter 7 days  ot  acclimation constituted
only 5U%  ot  the Na+ sorption level in control tish (Thurston et al. 'iy7ya).
I.  Perch (Perca fluviatilis)
2. Three-spined Stickleback (Gasterosteus aculeathus)
3. Crucian Carp (Carassius ouratus)
4.Bolti (Tilapia mossambica)
5.Current Year Salmon (Salmo solar)

   100
     90
     80
     70
     60
     50
     40
     30
     20
     10
      0
       c
       o —
       o  §
                              4       5
                                Water  pH
                                                7
Figure 5.   Na"1" absorption in tish as a iunction ot  ambient pH, according
           to Vinogradov et al.,  197y.

-------
      Decrease in activity o±  diiferent enzymes could be  a  probable cause
 oi depression ot Na+ and Cl~  transport in ±ish giils with  change  in ambient
 ph.   This  applies, first o± ail, to Na+, K+, Mg "^-activated Al'Pases and
 succinate  dehyarogenase (.SDH), which are enzymes directly  involved in trans-
 membrane ion transport.  At  the  present time, it is assumed  that  active Na+
 transport  through ceil membranes is attected by the tunction  oi JNa+, K+-
 ATPase, which is a good explanation lor the presence oi  ionic gradients
 between intracelluiar and extracellular media.

      Na , K -ATPase,  however , constitutes an insignilicant part of overall
 ATPase activity  01 gill tissue to maintain ionic assymetry between cells
 oi the gill epithelium in iresh water, which has very low  levels  of ions
 (.Thurston et al .  1979 b).   Strophanthin-resistant ATPase  plays the leading
 role  (.over 9u%  ot all  ATPase  activity).  The optimum ph  lor Na+,  K+-
ATPase and strophanthin-resistant ATPase is in the  range of 7.5 to b.5,
and it^does not  change  when fish are acclimated to  a more  acid medium.
        ATPase activity remains stable during 10 days of acclimation of
     arp t0 a ph  ot 5>i'   The strophanthin-resistant component ot overall
       activity  increases  during acclimation to low ph.  Reliable ditter-
ences were  noted  one day after the  start  ot  the experiment (figure 7).
 the
                \.
               2.
               3.
               4.
               5.
               6.
                 Rate of Total  Na+  Loss in Crucian Carp, pH 5.5
                 Na* Absorption in Carp,  pH 5.5
                 Rate of Na* Loss in Stickleback, pH 5.0
                 No* Absorption in Stickleback, pH 5.0
                 Rate of Total Na* Loss in Crucian Carp, pH 4.5
                 Na+ Absorption in Crucian Carp, pH 4.5
                             2345
                                 Time, days
                                                               7
Figure 6.
          Effect ol low pil on Ma"1" exchange in crucian carp (Carassiu.s
          auratus., according to Thurston et ai., iy79,  ana stickelback
          (Gasterosteus aculeathus), according to Matey et al..,
                                   10

-------
                         I.  Control  2. 7 Days  3.  10 Days

               a. Strophanthin-resistant Element of ATPase Activity
               b. Na+ K+ -ATPase Activity
                                 7             8
                       pH  of  Incubation  Medium
9
figure /-  ATPase activity in crucian carp  (.Carassius auratus; gilis with
           acclimation to pH ^.5,  accoraing  to Thurston et ai., 1^/y.
These results warrant the belief that, in freshwater fish, Strophanthin
(,ouabain)-insensitive ATPase plays an important part in ion regulation.

     The results indicate that there are two concurrent adaptive processes
in tish during acclimation to low pH.  On the one hanci, there is less loss
of Na"t from the body and, on the other hand, atter -an initial significant
inhibition o± Na+ absorption, there is partial restoration of rate ot sorp-
tion ot this ion, which makes it possible to maintain a balance between
external and internaT Ma"1".

       In the crayfish, Astacus leptodactylus, Na+ exchange in gills, like
in the hog slater, Asellus aquaticus, is not sensitive to pH drop in the
range or t>.0-4.0.  however, acidulation ot the environment elicits a
drastic increase in loss ot Ca4"*".  In craynsh placed in water with pti ot
4..}, the rate or general loss ot Ca"1"1" increases by b-y times, as compared
to the control, and remains unchanged tor 7 days.  Threshold pti at which
Ca"*"1" absorption does not compensate tor its loss is 4.t>-4.7 C^'igure ba).
At neutral pH, Ca"1"1" sorption in crayfish is 7-b times greater than loss
(.Vinogradov et al. iyb3) .  This creates conditions tor accumulation and
deposition in the body ol Ca"*"1" required tor craylish growth and ecdysis.
                                     11

-------
 Apparently,  impairment  ot  Ca"*""1" exchange, along with changes in regulation
 ol Na"1" ana Ca"*""*" uptake  when the environment was  aciduiatea (.Figure tta ana
 b) .  Investigation ot Ca"1"1" ana Na"1" metabolism revealed that there is in-
 crease in total loss ol Ca"1"1" and Na+ in moliusks  starting at a ph ol less
 than b.b.  In  our  opinion,  impairment ol Ca"1""1" metabolism is ol primary
 significance to survival ol mollusks, since the  intensity ol their uptake
 ol Ca"""  is  substantially greater than its  uptake by lish and crustaceans
  (.Figure  4 to dillerent pH  values  alter placing  ireshwater  shrimp,
 Gammaracanthus lacustris, in it revealed that  total electrolyte  content
 of water at  pH ol less than 4.3 diminishes drastically,  in  spite ol  the
 significant  migration into  water ol  Na"1" and Cl~  ions  from the body (.Figure
 iU,).  The results  of  this experiment are indicative ol considerably great-
 er change in gill  permeability lor hyarogen ions  than lor salts at low
 environmental  pH.   Analogous data, which revealed that permeability o±
 the integument  ol  crustaceans  lor  h+ in an aciduiatea environment is much
 greater  than lor other  ions and that intake of H+ exceeds total output  of
 salts, were  also obtained tor  other crustacean species.

      On  the  basis  of many years of our own studies  and analysis ol aata
 in the literature,  it was  aetermined that  lish and invertebrate death with
 decline 01 ph. was  aue essentially  to impairment  ot  processes or ionic reg-
 ulation.   In an acid environment,  exchange oi Na"1",  Ci~ ana Ca4"*"  Between
 the organism ana water  shifts  in the airection of excessive escape ot
 these ions into the environment,  ana there is unbalanced intake ot H+.

      Low, acutely  toxic pH  levels  increase permeability of fish gill epi-
 thelium tor  ions.   In this  case,  the rate ot ailtusion ot salts trom the
 body  increases  by  several  times.   Blooa electrolyte concentration ae-
           I.
           2.
           3.
           4.
          05
Ca++ Uptake in Mollusk (Sphoerium suecicum)
Ca++ Loss in Mo I lusk (S. suecicum)
CQ++ Uptake in Crayfish (AJ^qtodactyjus)
Ca+ + Loss in Crayfish (A. leptodactylus)
    (Sphaerium suecicum)

 I. Ca++ Uptake 3. Ca++Loss
r3. Na+Uptake  4. Na+ Loss

                   B
               4.0  4.5   5.0  5.5  6.0   6.5   7.0
                                    Water pH
                                    4.0 45 5.0  5.5  6.0 6.5 7.0
Figure a.   Uptake ana loss ot ions  at  different environmental ph in
            invertebrates.
                                       12

-------
creases rapidly,  there is intensive passage  ot hydrogen ions over concen-
tration gradient  to  the endogenous environment,  and concurrently with
desalination there is development of acidosis.   At such pH values,  there
are serious destructive changes in the gill  epithelium, which are the most
intensive in a medium with less than 20-40 mg/£  Ca++.

     Low sensitivity of transepithelial Na+  transport and giii permeability
tor ions with drop ol ambient pH are typical features o± one of the most
acid-resistant fish  species, the perch.   In  an acid medium,  Ca"*"1" ions
normalize both sodium ana acid-base homeostasis  in fish thanks to the
capacity of this  cation to limit giii permeability tor Na+ and H+ by  means
ot "cementing" intercellular contacts and stabilizing external cytopiasmic
membranes.
                     I. Ca++ Uptake by Sphaerium suecicum
                     2. Na+ Uptake by S. suecicum
                     3. Co"*"1" Uptake by Limnaea peregra
                     4. Na* Uptake by L. peregra
       a>
       j*.
       o
0.75
       o  \
       0  o
       "=  H
       o  ••*.
               0.25-
                             5        10       15      20
                            Ion Concentration, mg/l
Figure y.   Ca"1"1" and Na+ uptake in treshwater mollusfcs Limnaea peregra
           and Sphaerium suecicicum as  a  function ot concentration  ot
           these  ions in water.
                                    13

-------
          PH values tnat elicit substantial changes «
 epithelium tor Na+ correspona to a low range or pH  £
 mens ot dilterent species are encountered under natural
                                                                    »*
      in the tolerated range ol low PH, lisn
 chan.es in activity ot metabolic process. «                    H iniially
 organization ol gil± epithelial cells.  A J^1^ °     o± cellSj anQ SDH
 depresses Na+ uptake, stimulation ot synthetic activity or      '
 activity in gill epithelium.  Suosequently ,  development ol these processes
 slows down and at  the next  stage there is partial restoration ot Na
 transport, decrease in permeability ot gill epithelium  "abiization ot
 metabolism, but usually at  a lower level tnan in a neutral and mildly

 alkaline environment.

      Strophanthin-resistant ATPase is apparently very important to osmotic
 regulation in treshwater  fish.  Activity  ot Na+ , K^-ATPase  constitutes  an
 insignificant part ot overall ATPase  activity of gills.   Ihe role  ot Na ,
 K+-ATPase in gills of treshwater fish is  apparently  limited to  regulation
 ot  intracelluiar proportions of Na"1" and K .
          .c
          a>
              I. Rate of Total Na* Loss (Gammaracanthus iacustris)

              2.Total Concentration of Electrolytes (G_. lacustris)

              3.Rate of Total Na* Loss (Gommarus lacustris)
              4.Total Concentration of Electrolytes (G_. lacustris)

              0.7
       (O U»
       o E  0.5

      +  cf

      Z o
      H- ^  0.3
       O T3
       
-------
     There is impairment ol processes or ion regulation in the case ot
acidulation, in crustaceans ana moiiusks, as well as iish.  One observes
increased loss ol Na+ and Ca"1""*", and inhibition ol Na+ uptake Irom the
environment.  Calcium metabolism is more sensitive to a decline of pH than
sodium metabolism in some species ol crustaceans and moiiusks.  This war-
rants the beliel that the changes in regulation ol Ca"1"1" that occur in an
acid medium could restrict the existence ol some species in waters with
low environmental ph.
                                BIBLIOGRAPHY

Cameron, J.N. and U.K. Randall.  1972.  The eflect oi increased ambient
     CO^ on arterial CO^ tension, C02 content and ph in rainbow trout.
     J. Exp. Biol.  5/ (3) . o73-ottU .

Cameron, J.N. and i .A; Poihemus.  1974.  Theory ol C02 exchange in trout
     gills.  J. Exp. Biol. bO(l) ; Ib3-194.

Eddy, t.b.  1974.  Acid-base balance in rainbow trout (Salmo Gairdneri)
     subjected  to acid stresses.  J. Exp. Biol.  b4(l) : 159-171.

Ehrenlela, J.   1974.  Aspects ol ionic transport mechanisms in craylish
     Astacus Leptodactiius.  J.  Exp. Biol.  51 (1) :57-7U.

Ellis, M.M.  1W3.  Detection and measurement ol stream pollution.  Bull.
     Bur. fisheries.  4b(.22) :3b5-437 .

Evans, D.H.  1975.  Ionic exchange mechanisms in lish gills.  Comp. Bio-
     chem. Physioi.  511,491-495).

Harris, R.R.  1972.  Aspects or  sodium regulation in a brackish water
     and a marine species ol the isopod genus sphaeroma.  l2(l):b-27.

Haswell, h.S.,  O.J. Randall, ana b.F. Perry.  190U.  Fish gill carbonic
     anhydrase.  acid-base regulation or salt  transport?  Am. J. Physioi.,
     23b.24U-2btt.

Hogiund, L.B.   1901.  The reaction ol lish in concentration gradients.
     Rep. Inst. Freshwater Res., 43:1-147-

Kerstetter, T.H., ana L.B. Kirschner.  1972.  Active chloride transport by
     the gills  ol rainbow trout  (.Salmo Gairdneri).  J. Exp. Biol.  5b(.l).
     2b3-272.

Laurent, P. and S. Dunel.  19bU.  Morphology ol gill epithelia in lish.
     Amer. J. Physiology.  23«(3):147-159.

Leivestad, H. and 1. Muniz.  197o.  Fish kill at low pH in a Norwegian
     river.  Nature (London).  259:391-392.

Maetz, J.  197/.  Branchial sodium exchange and ammonia excretion in  the
     goldlish Carassius Auratus.  Ellects oi ammonia-loading and  temper-
     ature changes.  J. Exp. Biol.  5b.6Ul-blU.

                                     15

-------
 Maetz, J.  1*73.   Na+/<,  Na+/H+ exchanges, NH, movement across gill of
      Carassius Auratus.   J. Exp.  Biol.   bb(l):25b  2/5.

 Maetz, J. 1974.  Origin  or  dirierence  in trans branchial  electric potential
      in Carassius Auratus goldfish.   Importance ot Ca   Ion.   C.R.  Acad.
      Sci. (Pans).  279:1277-12bU.

 Maetz, J. and J?.  Garcia-Romeu.   I9b4.   The mechanism of  sodium and  chloride
      uptake by the gills ol a treshwater tish Garassius  Auratus.   L.   tvi
      dence for Nb£/Na+ and HCO'/Cl"  exchanges.   J. General  Physiology.
      47(7):1U29-1229.

 Malley, D.  i9b(J.  Decreased survival and calcium uptake oy the crayfish
      Orconectes Viridis  in low ph.  Can. J. Fish. Aquatic Sciences.
      37.364-372.
 Matey,  V.Ye.,  A.D. Kharazova, and G.A.  Vinogradov.  1961.   Reaction ot
      chloride cells o± gill epithelium or stickleback, Gasterosteus Acul-
      eatus L., to change in pK and salinity 01 environment.  Tsitologiya.
      23(2) .159-lb5.  pp. 159-lb5.

 McWilliams,  P-  19bU.  Eliect ol ph on soaium uptake in Norwegian brown
      trout (Salmo Trutta)  trom an acid river.  J.  Exp.  Biol.  bb:259~2b7.

 Packer, R.K. and W.A. bunson.  19 /(_).  Effects of  low environmental ph on
      blood ph and sodium balance  ot brook  trout.   J. hxp. Zool.  74(1).
      fai-72.

 Packer, K.K. and W.H. Dunson.  1972.  Anoxia and  sodium loss associated
      with the death of brook trout at low  ph.  Coinp. Biochem. Physiol.
      41A.17-26.

 Payan,  P., N.  Mayer-Gostan, and P. Pang.  19bl.   bite 01 calcium uptake
      in ionic treshwater trout gill.  J. Exp. Zool.  21b:345-347.

 Perry,  S.*1., M.S. Haswell, D.J. Randall, and A.P- Farrell.   19bl.   Bran-
      chial ionic  uptake and acid-base regulation  in the'rainbow trout
      Salmo Gairdneri.  J. Exp.  Biol.  92:2b9-3U3.

 Potts,  W.T.W.  and W. Fleming.  (No year given;.  The effect ot prolac-
      tion and  divalent ions on the permeability to water ot the Fundulus
      Kansae, J. Exp. Biol.   53:317-327.

 Randall,  D.J.  and J.W. Cameron.   1973.   Respiratory control of  arterial
      pH as temperature changes  in rainbow trout Saimo Gairdneri.  Arner.
      J.  Physiol.   225(5;.997-1UU2.

Renzis, G. and J.  Maetz.  1973.   Studies on the mechanisms ol chloride
      absorption by the goldtish gill, relation with acid—base regulation.
     J. Exp. Biol.   b9(,2; .339-3^6.

Shaw, J.   19i>9 .  The absorption o± sodium ions in the craylish Astacus
     Pallipes Lereboullet.  1:  The erlect o± external and  internal  soaium
     concentrations.  J.  Exp.  Biol.  3b(. i ) : l2b-144 .

                                     16

-------
Sokolov, V.A. and G.A. Vinograaov.  i977.  investigation of fish adapta-
     tion to ditierent environmentai pti.  In.  biologiya vnutrennikh vod.
     Inform, byui. (Biology of Iniand Waters. Information Bulletin). No.
     33.  Leningrad, USSR.  pp. f>t>-b9.

Spry, D., C. Wood, C. and P- Hodson.  iybl.  The effects of environmentai
     acid on freshwater fish with particular reference to the soft water
     lakes in Ontario and the modifying effects of heavy metals.  A liter-
     ature review.  In;  Canadian Technical Report of fisheries and Aquatic
     Sciences.  Toronto, Canada.  999 pages.

Sutclitte, D.W.  19bb.  Sodium regulation and adaptation to fresh water in
     Gammarid crustaceans.  J. Exp. Biol.  4b:33i>-3bU.

 Sutclitte,  D.W.   1971.   Soaium intiux and  loss  in freshwater and  brackish-
      water  population of the amphipod Gammarus  Duebeni Littjebirg.   J.
      Exp. Jiioi.   54^1,1 .2bi>-2bb .

 Thurston, K.V.,  G.A.  Vinogradov,  V.T.  Komov,  ana  V.\u.  Matey.   19/9.
      Effect of low pH,  ammonia salts  and desalination on enzyme activity,
      sodium metabolism in gills  ana ultrastructure of  chloride  ceils in
      freshwater  fish.  Report 1.   in:   Bioiogiya  vnutrennikh vod.  Iniorm.
      byul.   pp.  7b-bl.

 Thurston, K.V.,  G.A.  Vinogradov,  V.T.  Komov,  and  V.Ye.  Matey.   197yb.
      Effect of low pti,  ammonia salts  and desalination on enzyme activity,
      sodium metabolism in gills  and ultrastructure of  chloride  cells in
      freshwater  fish.  Report 2.   In:   Bioiogiya  vnutrennikh vod.  Iniorm.
      byul.   No.  44.   pp.  75-79.

 Ultsch,  G.  and G.  Gros  (No  year).   Mucus as  a diffusion barrier to  oxygen:
      Possible role in 0^  uptake  at pH in carp (Cyprinus Caprio) gills.
      Comp.  Biochem.  Physiol.   b2A;bbb-bb9.

 Vaala,  S. and R.  Mitchell.   197U.   Blood oxygen tension changes in  acid
      exposed brook trout.   Proceed. Pennsylv. Acad.  Sci.   44:41-44.

 Vinogradov,  G.A.   197b.   Osmotic  reguiation  of  some  relict  glacier  crus-
      taceans as  related to  distinctions of  their  ecology  and origin.   In
      Solenostnyye  adaptatsu  vodnykh  organizmov (Salt  Adaptation  of  Aquatic
      Organisms).   Leningrad,  USSR.  pp. I7b~209.

 Vinograaov,  G.A.   J.979.  Adaptation of  aquatic  animals  with different  types
      of  osmotic  regulation  to decline of  environmentai pH.   In.   Fiziologiya
      i  parazitoiogiya presnovodnykh zhivotnykh  (.Physiology  and  Parasitoiogy
      of  Freshwater Animals).   Leningrad,  USSR.  pp.  i7-2t>.

 Vinogradov,  G.A.   19bi .  Processes  of  ionic  regulation in  freshwater animals
      in waters with anthropogenic pollution.   In  Bioiogiya vnutrennikh voa
      (Biology  of  Inland Waters).   No.  M.  Leningrad,  USSR.  pp.  i>3-5b.
                                      17

-------
 Vinogractov,  G.A.,  P.A.  Gdovskiy,  and V.Ye Matey.   1979.  Oxidation ot water
      reservoirs  and its  effects on metabolism of freshwater animals.  In:
      Fiziologiya i parazitologiya presnovodnykh  zhivotnykh.  Leningrad,
      USSR.   pp.  9b-ii6.

 Vinogradov,  G.A.,  Ye.S.  Dai', and V.T. Komov.  1983.  Investigation ot
      basic  gill  functions  of  crayfish  exposed to ammonia salts and acidu-
      lation of environment.   In.  Reaktsiya gidrobiontov na zagryazneniye
      (Hydrobiont Reaction  to  Pollution).  Moscow,  USSR.  pp. 168-i75.

 Vinogradov,  G.A.,  V.T. Komov, and V.Ye. Matey, 1964.  Functional  bases of
      effect  of low pH on fish and crustaceans.   In:   Fiziologicheskiye i
      biokhimicheskiye aspekty toksikologii presnovoanykh zhivotnykh" (Physi-
      ological and Biochemical Aspects  ot Toxicology  of Freshwater Animals)
      Manuscript  filed with V1NIT1 (Ail-Union Institute of Scientific and
      Technical Information) ,  IhVV (.Institute of biology of Inland Waters) ,
      USSR Acaaemy of  Sciences,  on ^5 March  1984, No.  163/64.   pp. 147-190.

 Vinogradov,  G.A.,  V.Ye.  Matey, V.Ye. and Ye.S. Dal1.  19&3.  Effect ot
      calcium on  mineral metabolism and gill  ultrastructure in  freshwater
      fish.   In;   Reaktsiya gidrobiontov na zagryazneniye.  Moscow, USSR.
      pp.  199-^07.

 Vinogradov,  G.A.,  V.A.  Sokolov. and G.I. Fierova.  1978.  Investigation ol
      mechanism of  action of low pH on  freshwater fish.   In;  Teoreticheskiye
      aspekty rybokhozyaystvennykh issledovaniy vodokhranilishch  (Theoretical
      Aspects of  Fishery  Studies of Reservoirs).  Leningrad, USSR. pp. 168-
      173.

 Vinogradov,  G.A.,  V.A.  Sokolov, and G.I. Fierova.  1976.  Loss of sodium
      ion ana changes  in  blood pH  ot fish exposed to  acid environment.
      In;  Tret'ya  Vsesoyuznaya konterentsiya po ekologicheskoy tiziologii
      ryb. Tezisy  dokl (Summaries  of Papers Delivered at 3d All-Union Con-
      ference on Ecological Physiology  of Fish) Part  1.  Kiev, USSR.  pp.
      76-77.

foiebe, A., A. McGavock,  A. Fuller, and h. Markus.  1934.  The ability or
      freshwater fish  to  extract oxygen at different  hydrogen ion  concen-
      trations.  Physiol. Zool.  7:435-448.
                                    18

-------
                   AMMONIA PRODUCTION AND EXCRETION BY FISH
                                      by
                                D.J. Randall1
                                 P.A. Wright

                                   ABSTRACT

     Ammonia is continually produced and excreted by fish.  High environmental
ammonia levels, however, will reduce excretion resulting in body
accumulations.  In this paper, published research on the production,
utilization, distribution, and excretion of ammonia by fish is reviewed.

                                 INTRODUCTION

     Ammonia is an end product of protein metabolism and, if allowed to
accumulate in the body, has a toxic action.  Ammonia must, therefore, either
be excreted or be converted to less toxic compounds such as urea or glutamine.
Ammonia is a substrate as well as a product of protein metabolism and in some
tissues it may be utilized rather than produced.  In general, however,  there
is a continual production and excretion of ammonia, or the less toxic
substance urea, by the whole animal.  Elevated environmental ammonia levels
will reduce excretion and result in ammonia accumulation in the body of fish.
     Although ammonia is almost completely ionized at body pH values, the
gill is much more permeable to unionized ammonia and it appears that passive
diffusion of NH-j is the major form of ammonia excretion across the gills of
freshwater fish.  Ammonium ions may also be excreted in exchange for Na~*"
ions.  The pH gradients across the gills will influence ammonia excretion,
which will vary according to blood and environmental water pH changes.

                      AMMONIA PRODUCTION AND UTILIZATION

     Amino acids in excess of those required for protein synthesis are
converted to ammonia in the liver.  Figure 1 illustrates the sources and fate
of ammonia in fish.  Transaminases in the liver convert amino acids into
glutamate for subsequent conversion into ammonia (Forster and Goldstein, 1969;
Watts and Watts, 1974).  Ammonia is also produced by the deamination of
adenylates in fish muscle (Driedzic and Hochachka, 1976).  Enzymes involved in
ammonia production have been located in the kidney, gill, and muscle, as well
as in the liver; however, the major site of ammonia production is probably the
liver.
     Ammonia toxicity can be ameliorated by the formation of less toxic
compounds, namely glutamine and urea.  Levi et al. (1974) recorded high
^Dept. of Zoology, University of British Columbia, Vancouver, B.C. Canada
                                      19

-------
  levels of glutamine in the brain of goldfish and found that brain
  levels increased with ambient ammonia concentrations.  Webb and Brown        _
  found high glutamine synthetase activity in the teleost and elasmobranch  brain
  and this may be important in protecting the brain from sudden surges in
  ammonia concentration.  Walton and Cowey (1977) were able to detect
  glutaminase activity in the gills of trout, but were unable to measure any  in
  vivo utilization of glutamine by the gills.
       Ammonia can be converted, through carbamyl phosphate, to urea either via
  purines (uricolysis) or via the ornithine cycle.  The enzymes required for
  uricolysis have been found in most fishes (Forster and Goldstein, 1969; Watts
  and Watts, 1974) but Florkin and Duchateau (1943) were unable to detect any
  activity of uricolytic enzymes in the cyclostome, Lampetra.  The ratio of urea
  production via the ornithine cycle and uricolysis is about 100 to 1  in
  elasmobranchs and dipnoi, whereas in teleosts, most of the urea is formed via
  uricolysis (Gregory, 1977).
               EXCRETION

                 INTO

               ENVIRONMENT-<-
                   INGESTED
                   PROTEIN
                    WATER
                                   UREA
                                        uricolysis
   PURINES
   CREATINE
   PORPHYRINES
   PYRIMIDINES
   AMINES
•NHj
                                 NH
 FISH
                                                     ornithine cycle
                                               AMINO ACID
                                                 POOL
• PROTEIN
                  CARBON SKELETON
Figure 1.   Production and excretion  of  nitrogenous compounds in fish.

                              AMMONIA DISTRIBUTTON

      Ammonia exists in aqueous solution either  as  ammonia  gas  or  as  ammonium
ion.   Trussell (1972)  and Thurston et al. (1979) present tables of the  percent
unionized  ammonia in solutions of different pH and temperature; the  percent
unionized  ammonia increases  with increasing pH and temperature but decreases
with  increases in ionic  strength of the solution.  The combined concentrations
of ammonia gas in solution  (NH3)  and  ammonium ions (NH^"1")  will be
referred to  as  total ammonia.
                                      20

-------
     Cameron and Heisler (1983) found that ammonia was  slightly more  soluble
in fish plasma than in water, and they also constructed a nomogram  to describe
the effects of ionic strength and temperature on  the pK of  the ammonia/
ammonium reaction (see also Kormanik and Cameron, 1981; Boutilier et  al.
1984).  The pK is around 9.5, so at the pH of fish tissues, nearly  all of  the
ammonia will be as ammonium ion.  The pH of the tissue will be an important
determinant of the total ammonia level.  Ammonia  gas diffuses at about the
same rate as CC>2 (Cameron and Heisler, 1983) so it will rapidly equilibrate
between different tissue compartments.  Ammonium  ion is not so permeable and
large differences in levels may occur between compartments; in mammals and
birds it has been shown that ammonium ion levels  reflect the pH of  the
compartment, tissues with a lower pH having higher concentrations.  This
situation probably holds true for fish (Figure 2).  Thus, the heart of a fish
may have a much higher total ammonia concentration because  the pH of  this
tissue is lower than that of the blood; this is due to  elevated ammonium ion
concentrations in heart muscle, with the ammonia  gas levels being in
equilibrium with the blood.  In general very little is known about  the
difference in total ammonia content in different  tissues in fish.
                                             10
                    1400 -i
                    1200 -
                    1000 -
                    800 -
                    600 -
                    400 -
                    200 -
[ZNH,]i   1 +

[Z NH3]2   1 + 1o'PKa

   NH3 = 2 pM
                                              (pKa   pHl)
                        pH 7.0
                        WATER
 7.8   6.9
  BLOOD
7.3   6.7
HEART
Figure 2.  pH dependence of NH3:NH4+ ratio  in water,  blood,  and  heart.
           pH values taken from Heisler  (1980)  for normal  and  acidotic
           conditions in fish.
                                       21

-------
                               AMMONIA EXCRETION

      The excretion of ammonia by fish is variable,  depending on the state of
 the animal, the environmental conditions, and the species.   Ammonia excretion
 tripled in sockeye salmon following daily feeding (Brett and Zala, 1975) but
 remained low and unchanging during 22 days of starvation.   In freshwater fish
 ammonia excretion increases in response to exercise (Sukumaren and Kutty
 1977- Holeton et al. 1983), long-term acid exposure (McDonald and Wood, 1981;
 Ultsch et al., 1981), hypercapnia (Claiborne and Heisler,  1984) and NH4C1
 infusion (Hillaby and Randall, 1979).  In contrast, short-term exposure to
 acid or alkaline water caused a decrease in ammonia excretion in trout (Wright
 and Wood, 1984).  It is not known if these changes in excretion reflect
 changes in the rate of ammonia production or in the ammonia content of the
 body.  The ammonia content of fish is likely to be the equivalent of the
 ammonia excreted in about 2 hours, most of the ammonia being in the tissues
 with a lower pH, like muscle.  Blood levels are around 0.200 to 0.300 mMol,
 but muscle at a lower pH may have concentrations up to 1 mMol.  Thus a kg fish
 may contain about 0.500 to 0.700 mMol of ammonia and have an excretion rate of
 about 0.300 mMol per hour.  There is increased ammonia production in muscle
 during exercise (Driedzic and Hochachka, 1976).  Ammonia excretion by the
 dogfish in seawater is unaffected by temperature change, exercise, hyperoxia,
 hypercapnia, or the infusion of either HC1 or NaHC03 or anything that
 induces acid-base stress (see Heisler, 1984, for review).   This is surprising,
 because many of these changes affect pH and therefore would be expected to
 alter the ammonia content of body compartments and therefore ammonia
 excretion.
      There is an elevation in blood ammonia during starvation (Hillaby and
 Randall,  1979; Morii, 1979), which is perhaps surprising because ammonia
 excretion declines (Brett and Zala, 1975).  Blood ammonia levels also rise
 with increases in temperature (Fauconneau and Luquet, 1979) and with higher
 ammonia concentrations in the water (Fromm and Gillette, 1968).  Exposure of
 fish either to air (Gordon, 1970) or to increased ammonia levels in water
 (Fromm, 1970;  Guerin-Ancey, 1976), raises blood ammonia levels and reduces
 ammonia excretion and this is associated with a rise in urea production in
 many,  but  not all fish.  Unlike the above studies, Buckley et al. (1979) found
 no  change  in blood total ammonia when coho salmon were exposed to elevated
 ammonia levels in the environment.  They did observe a significant rise in
 plasma  sodium,  however, indicating some coupling between sodium uptake and
 ammonia excretion (see below).

                         AMMONIA EXCRETION ACROSS  GILLS

     Most of  the ammonia produced by the fish is excreted  across the gills.
 Oxygen, carbon dioxide,  ions and water also are transferred across the gills.
 The movement  of ammonia gas is largely independent  of the  transfer of other
molecules, and  is  a  function of the unionized ammonia gradient.   Ammonia entry
 into the fish  depends  on this gradient (Wuhrmann et al., 1947; Wuhrmanp and
 Woker,  1948; Fromm and  Gillette,  1968).   The  rate of  loss also depends  on  the
 NH^ gradient,  in most  instances (Hillaby and  Randall, 1979; Kormanik and
 Cameron 1981;  Cameron and  Heisler,  1983).   The excretion of ammonium ion is
 strongly coupled to  the  movement of  other  ions.  Membranes, including the
gills, are not very permeable  to cations like ammonium ion.   Ammonium ion


                                      22

-------
displace potassium in many membrane processes, for example in squid giant axon
(Binstock and Lecar, 1969), and this is the probable reason that elevated
ammonia causes convulsions in so many vertebrates.  In fish gills it is
possible that NH^"1" can substitute for potassium in oubain-sensitive
sodium/potassium exchange and also substitute for protons in amiloride
sensitive Na /H  exchange, the former moving ammonium from blood into the
gill epithelium, the latter exchanging ammonium for sodium on the outer
surface of the gill epithelium (Maetz and Garcia-Romeu, 1964; Evans, 1977;
Girard and Payan, 1980; Wright and Wood, 1984).  Either acid conditions or
amiloride in the water inhibit Na+ influx across the gills and both these
conditions result in a reduction of ammonia excretion (Wright and Wood, 1984)
and ammonia infusion will stimulate sodium influx even in seawater fish
(Evans, 1977).  It is interesting to note that ammonia excretion was
maintained, even in the face of a calculated reversed ammonia gas gradient,
presumably by sodium/ammonium exchange.  Cameron and Heisler (1983) could
account for ammonia excretion in trout, under most conditions, by the
diffusion of unionized ammonia, but in the presence of high external ammonia,
sodium/ammonium exchange may counter balance the diffusive uptake of ammonia
gas.   Indeed, this would explain the unchanging blood ammonia but increased
sodium levels in coho salmon exposed to elevated water ammonia (Buckley et al.
1979).  Ammonium ion efflux and sodium influx must be quantified to determine
the exact relationship between sodium and ammonium movements.  It is
relatively easy to determine sodium influx using isotopes but it is difficult
to determine NH^  efflux.  Methods exist for measuring total ammonia
excretion from measurements of total ammonia in blood or water.  If the pH is
known  in both blood and water, then the ammonia and ammonium ion
concentrations on both sides of the gills can be calculated and the ammonia gas
and ammonium  ion differences across the gills estimated.  Wright and Wood
(1984) did this for rainbow trout exposed to a variety of acid and alkaline
conditions or following  inhibition of sodium uptake with amiloride.  They
observed a positive correlation between total ammonia excretion and the
ammonia gas gradient.  If  the ammonia gas excretion is subtracted from total
ammonia excretion, then there was an approximate relationship between sodium
influx and ammonium ion efflux.
     The difficulty with  this approach is that the exact pH of water and blood
on either side of the gill epithelium is not known.  The pH of afferent and
efferent blood  can be measured and the mean of these two may be an
approximation of the pH of blood in the gills.  Water pH is equally difficult
to determine.  Firstly there are undoubtedly boundary layers next to the gill
surface and this will contain concentration gradients; secondly there will be
longitudinal  gradients as material is added to the gill water.
     Substances added to  the water that will affect pH are C02, ammonia and
ammonium ion, and protons.  There is no evidence  that C02 hydration occurs
at a catalysed rate in gill water; in as much as  the water is only  in contact
with the gill for about 100 to 400 msec. (Randall, 1982), and at low pH the
uncatalysed C02 reaction  takes several seconds, any effect of C02 on water
pH will occur after the water has passed over the gills.  Any excretion of
protons will  have an immediate effect lowering pH, whereas excretion of
ammonia gas will raise pH.  Conversely, excretion of ammonium ion will lower
pH and, because ammonia/ammonium reactions are rapid, they will influence
water  pH at the gills and therefore ammonia excretion.  One might predict
that,  under most conditions, ammonia excretion will exceed both ammonium  ion


                                       23

-------
  and  proton  excretion, thus the effect will be to raise the pH of the water
  in contact  with  the  gills.  Although the amount of C02 excreted will far
  exceed that of ammonia,  there will not be an appreciable reduction in
  water pH until the water has left the gills.  It is clear a more detailed
  understanding of  ammonia excretion requires a more detailed analysis of pH
  gradients across  the gills.

        Wright and  Wood (1984) measured ammonia excretion in trout exposed
  to a variety of water pH conditions, and they found that sodium influx was
  zero at  pH  4.1.   If  it is assumed that under these conditions ammonium/
  sodium exchange  is also  zero, then all ammonia excreted must have been
  due  to unionized  ammonia diffusion.  The unionized ammonia gradient was
  calculated  from measurements of pH and total ammonia content in water and
  blood.   The calculated permeation coefficient for ammonia diffusion across
  the  trout gill was 65% of that calculated by Cameron and Heisler (1983).
  The  unionized ammonia excretion was then calculated for trout under other
  conditions  using  this permeation coefficient and the estimated NH3 gradi-
  ents.  The  ammonium  ion excretion was then determined by subtracting the
  NH3  excretion from the measured total ammonia excretion.

       A  plot of ammonium ion excretion against sodium influx for trout
  under a  variety ot conditions is shown in Figure 3a.  Considering only
  control  and acid  exposed fish there is a close 1 to 1 correlation between
  sodium influx and ammonium excretion (Figure 3b), indicating a tight
  coupling of sodium and ammonium exchange.  Under alkaline conditions,
  however,  the coupling was not obvious although clearly sodium influx was
  reduced.  If it is assumed that under all conditions there is a 1 to 1
  relationship between sodium and ammonium ion flux (Figure 3c) then under
 alkaline conditions there must have been an underestimate of the unionized
 ammonia excretion (Figure 3a).

       The estimation of  unionized ammonia excretion depended on the
 assumption that pH in the bulk medium was the same as that at the surface
 of the gills.   If, under alkaline conditions, there is still a tight
 coupling of  ammonium ion and sodium exchange—that is, ammonium efflux
 equals sodium influx (see Figure 3c),  we can estimate unionized ammonia
 excretion by subtracting ammonium ion excretion from total ammonia excre-
 tion.   Table 1  lists  the calculated NH3 and NH4+ movements across  the
 gills,  note  that  in some cases there is an excretion of ammonium ion but
 an uptake of ammonia  by  the  fish.   We  have determined the effect  of
 ammonia transfer  on water pH at the gills from these fluxes,  the  buffer-
 ing capacity of the water, and the  equilibrium constants for  the NH3/NH4+
 reaction  (Thurston et al.,  1979).

       The effects  of  ammonia  movements  on water  pH (Table  1)  are small,
 especially at water pH between 6.6  and  8.1.   At  water  pH of 8.7 and  9.5,
 however,  ammonia transfer has  some  effect  on  the pH  of water as it passes
 over  the  gills.  The  NH^  gradient,  and  therefore NH3 excretion in the
 study of  Wright and Wood  (1984), was based on  the pH of  the bulk phase
water rather than  the pH of water at the gill surface.  The fact that the
 pH of water  at the gill surface was affected by ammonia transfer at these
high water pH levels, may have led to an error in NH3 excretion and


                                      24

-------
                           -BOO-i
Tj  -600-

1
                           -«00_
                       i!
                           -200-
                                                    ,pH=8.7
                                        • pH=9.5
                                                       I Control
                                                        pH=8.1
                                          «pH=6.6
          Amilorlde
           pH=8.1
                                pH=«.1
                             0 •
                           -800-1    B
                                      4-200
                                              +100
                                                      	1—
                                                       +600
                                                               +800
                       Ll   -600-
                        u>
                       jf
                           -«00-
                          -200—
                                           , pH 6.6
                               pH 4.1
                                      4-200
                                              +400
                                                       +600
Figure 3.   Relationship  of Na+ influx  to NH4+ efflux,  and  Na+  influx
             to  pH.   Each  dot  represents  mean  of at least 8  fish.
                                              25

-------
  TABLE 1.   ANALYSIS OF AMMONIA EXCRETION  IN  TERMS  OF  Na+/HN4+ EXCHANGE AND
            WATER pH NEXT TO THE GILL.
Water
Acid
pH 4.1
1
1 Tout
M J
amm NH~
280.99 280.99
2
out
NH4+
0
APH3
.06
  Moderate
  acid               403.09           118.20           284.89          .02
  pH 6.6

  Control
  pH b.l             393.58          -179.73           573.31         -.03

  Amiloride
  pH 8.1             232.00           193.04            38.96         +.03

  Moderate
  alkaline
  pH 8.7             261.35          -231.00           492.35         -.10

  Severe
  alkaline
  pH 9.5              67.19          -155.22           222.7b         -.10


  1.   measured in umol.kg"1.h"1
  2.   measured in uequiv.kg~l.h~l
  3.   ApH = pH calculated -pH measured
 therefore an overestimate of ammonium ion excretion.  As a result,  Wright
 and  Wood (1984) did not observe a one to one relationship between ammonium
 ion  and sodium flux at these elevated water pH levels (Figure 3a) .
      Carbon dioxide in the water affects ammonia toxicity;  if C0£ levels
are  raised,  total ammonia toxicity is decreased (Alabaster  and Herbert,
1954).   C02  causes a fall in pH and decreases the proportion of unionized
ammonia  in  solution.   The unionized form has  a greater toxic effect  be-
cause ammonia  must enter the fish to exert its toxic action and lipid mem-
branes are much more  permeable  to unionized ammonia  (Wuhrmann  et  al.,
1947- Wuhrmann and Woker,  1948;  Thurston et al . ,  1981).  Thus  the reduction
in unionized ammonia  associated  with  the fall  in water pH caused  by  the
rise in  C0£ decreases  total  ammonia toxicity.  Lloyd and Herbert  (I960)
found, however, that although total ammonia toxicity was reduced at high
C02 levels, the inverse  was  true when considering unionized ammonia alone.
More unionized ammonia is required in low C02~high pH water  to exert the

                                      26

-------
same toxic effect as seen in fish in high C02~low pH water.  The explanation
presented by Lloyd and Herbert (1960) for the decreased toxicity of union-
ized ammonia in low CC>2 water was that C02 excretion across the gills would
reduce pH and therefore the concentration of unionized ammonia in water
flowing over the gills.  This is consistent with our conclusions of the
effects of C02 at high pH, but not at water pH levels of below 8.10.
Another possible explanation is that the blood pH of the fish also varied
inversely with the C02 content of the water such that the total ammonia
content of the blood decreases with the C02 in water pH in Lloyd and
Herbert's experiments, and both these factors are known to reduce blood
pH in fish (Janssen and Randall, 1975; Randall et al., 1976; Heisler,
1980).  The tish in Lloyd and Herbert's experiments were exposed to "water
of different pH and C02 levels for 18 hours and the blood pH of these fish
was probably inversely related to C02 levels in the water at the time of
ammonia exposure.  Blood pH will be an important determinant of blood total
ammonia levels and this in turn is an important factor in its toxic action
(.Hillaby and Randall, 1979).  Blood pH is probably decreased with increas-
ing CC>2 levels in the water, and this causes an increase in the blood total
ammonia levels for a given unionized ammonia concentration.  This could
account for the differences in unionized ammonia toxicity observed.  What
is required is accurate measurement of pH in both blood and water and
therefore NH3 gradients across the gill epithelium.

                                  REFERENCES

 Alabaster,  J.S.,  and D.W.  M.  Herbert.  1954.   Influence of carbon dioxide on
     the toxicity of ammonia.   Nature 174:404.

 Binstock,  L.,  and H.  Lecar.   1969.   Ammonium ion currents in the squid giant
     axon.   J.  Gen.  Physiol.  53.  p.  342-361.

 Boutilier,  R.G.,  T.A.  Heming,  and  G.K.  Iwama.   1984.   Appendix:  Physiochemical
     parameters for use in Fish Respiratory Physiology-   Appendix: Fish
     Physiology,  Vol XA ed.  W.S.  Hoar and D.J.  Randall.   Academic Press Inc.

 Brett, J.R.,  and C.A.  Zala.   1975.   Daily pattern of nitrogen excretion and
     oxygen consumption of  sockeye  salmon (Oncorhynchus  nerka) under controlled
     conditions.   J.  Fish.  Res.  Biol. Can.  32:2479-2486.

 Buckley,  J.A.,  C.M.  Whitmore.,  and  B.D.  Liming.   1979.   Effects of prolonged
     exposure to ammonia on the blood and liver glycogen of coho salmon
     (Oncorhynchus kisutch).   Comp.  Biochem.  Physiol.  63C:297-303.

 Cameron,  J.N.,  and N.  Heisler.   1983.  Studies of ammonia in the rainbow
     trout:  physio-chemical  parameters,  acid-base behavior, and respiratory
     clearance.   J.  Exp.  Biol.  105:107-125.

 Claiborne,  J.B.,  and N.  Heisler.   1984.   Acid-base regulation in the carp
     (Cyprinus  carpio)  during and after exposure to environmental hypercapnia.
     J. Exp.  Biol.  108:25-43.

 Dr'iedzic,  W.R.,  and P.W.  Hochachka.   1976.  Control of energy metabolism In
     fish  white muscle.   Am.  J.  Physiol.  230:579-582.

                                      27

-------
Evans, D.H.  1977.  Further evidence for Na/NH4 exchange in marine teleost
    fish.  J. exp. Biol. 70:213-220.

Fauconneau, B., and P.  Luquet.   1979.   Influence d'une elevation de
    temperature sur 1'evolution de 1'aminoacidemie et de 1'ammoniemie apres le
    repas chez la truite arc en ciel (Salmo gairdneri R.).  Ann. Biol. anim.
    Bioch. Biophys. 19(4A):1063-1079 .

Florkin, M.,  and G. Duchateau.   1943.   Les formes du systeme enzymatique de
    1'uricalyse et 1'evolution du catabolisme purique chez les animaux.  Arch.
    Int. Physiol. 53:267-307.

Forster, R.P., and L.  Goldstein.   1969.   Formation of excretory products.  In:
    Fish Physiology.   Eds.  W.S. Hoar and D.J. Randall, Academic Press, NY.
    Vol I., pp. 313-350.

Fromm, P.O.,  and J.R.  Gillette.  1968.   Effect of ambient ammonia on blood
    ammonia and nitrogen excretion of  rainbow trout (Salmo gairdneri).  Comp.
    Biochem.  Physiol.  26:887-896.

 Fromm,  P.O.   1970.  Section III. Effect of ammonia on trout and goldfish.  In:
    Toxic action  of water  soluble pollutants on freshwater fish.  EPA Water
    Pollution Control Research Series.  18050 DST  12/70 pp. 9-22.

 Girard,  J.P.,  and P. Payan.  1980.  Ion exchanges  through respiratory and
    chloride cells in freshwater and seawater adapted teleosteans.  Am. J.
    Physiol.  238:  (Regulatory  Integrative Comp. Physiol.  7) R260-R268.

 Gordon,  M.S.   1970.  Patterns  of nitrogen excretion  in amphibious fishes.
    Urea Kidney,  Proc.  Int. Colloq. 1968:238-242.

 Gregory,  R.B.   1977.  Synthesis and total excretion  of waste nitrogen by  fish
    of  the Periophthalmus  (mudskipper) and Scartelass families.  Comp.
    Biochem.  Physiol. 57A:33-36.

 Guerin-Ancey,  0.   1976.  Etude experimentale de I1excretion azotee du bar
    (Dicentrarchus labrax) en  cours de croissance.   II.   Effets du jeune  sur
    1'excretion d'ammonia  det  d'uree.  (Experimental study of  the nitrogen
    excretion  of  bass (Dicentrarchus labrax) during  growth.  II.  Effects of
    starvation on the excretion of ammonia and urea).  Aquaculture
    9(2):187-194.

Heisler,  N.   1980.  Regulation of the acid-base status in fishes.  In:
    Environmental physiology of fishes.  Ed. M.A.  Ali, Plenum  Publishing  Co.,
    NY.

Heisler, N.  1984.  Acid-base  regulation in  fishes.   In:  Fish  Physiology Vol.
    XA,  ed. W.S. Hoar and D.J. Randall.  Academic  Press Inc.,  NY.

Hillaby, B.A., and D.J.  Randall.  1979.  Acute ammonia toxicity and ammonia
    excretion in rainbow trout (Salmo gairdneri).  J. Fish. Res. Biol. Canada
    36:(6)621-629.

                                      28

-------
Holeton, G.F., P. Neumann, and N. Heisler.  1983.  Branchial ion exchange and
    acid-base regulation after strenuous exercise in rainbow trout.  Resp.
    Physiol. 51,303-318.

Janssen, R.G., and D.J. Randall.  1975.  The effects of changes in pH and
    PCQO in blood and water on breathing in rainbow trout, Salmo
    gairdneri.  Resp. Physiol. 25:235-245.

Kormanik, G.A., and J.N. Cameron.  1981.  Ammonia excretion in the FW catfish:
    the role of diffusion.  Amer. Soc. Zool. 21(4):1042.

Levi, G., G. Morisi, A. Coletti, and R. Catanzaro.  1974.  Free amino acids in
    fish brain: normal  levels and changes upon exposure to high ammonia
    concentrations in vivo, and  upon incubation of brain slices.  Comp.
    Biochem. PhysioTT 49A:623-636.

Lloyd, R. , and D.W.M. Herbert.   1960.  The influence of carbon dioxide on the
    toxicity of un-ionized ammonia to rainbow trout (SaImo gairdneri
    Richardson).  Ann.  appl. Biol. 48:399-404.

Maetz J., and F. Garcia-Romeu.   1964.  The mechanism of sodium and chloride
    uptake by the gills of a freshwater fish, Carassius auratus II Evidence
    for NH4+/Na+ and HC03~/C1~ exchanges.  J. Gen. Physiol.
    47:1209-1227.

McDonald, D.G.,  and C.M. Wood.   1981.  Branchial and renal acid and ion fluxes
    in the rainbow trout at low  environmental pH.  J. Exp. Biol. 93:101-118.

Morii, H.  1979.  Changes with time of ammonia and unea concentrations in the
    blood and tissue of mudskipper fish, Periophthalmus cantonensis and
    Boleophthalmus pectinirostris, kept in water and on land.  Comp., Biochem.
    Physiol. 64A:235-243.

Randall, D.J.  1982.  The control of respiration and circulation in fish
    during exercise and hypoxia.  J. Exp. Biol. 100:275-288.

Randall, D.J., N. Heisler and F. Drees.  1976.  Ventilatory response to
    hypercapnia  in the  larger spotted dogfish Scyliorhinus stellaris.  Am. J.
    Physiol. 230:590-594.

Sukumaran, N., and M.N. Kutty.   1977.  Oxygen consumption and ammonia
    excretion in the catfish Mystus armatus, with special reference to
    swimming' speed and  ambient oxygen.  Proc. Indian. Acad. Sci. 86B:195-206.

Thurston, R.V., R.C. Russo, and  K. Emerson.  1979.  Aqueous ammonia
    equilibrium-tabulation of percent un-ionized ammonia.  U.S. Environmental
    Protection Agency,  Duluth, Minnesota.  EPA-600/3-79-091.

Thurston, R.V., R.C. Russo, and  G.A. Vinogradov.  1981.  Ammonia toxicity to
    fishes: effect of pH on the  toxicity of the un-ionized ammonia species.
    Environ. Sci. Technol. 15(7): 837-840.
                                      29

-------
Trussell, R.P-  1972.   The percent unionized ammonia in aqueous ammonia
    solutions at diffeent pH levels and temperatures.  J. Fish. Res. Board
    Can.  29(10):1505-1510.

Ultsch, G.R., B.C. Jackson, and R. Moalli.  1981.  Metabolic oxygen conformity
    among lower vertebrates: the toadfish revisited.  J. Comp. Physiol.
    142:439-443.

Walton, M.J., and C.B. Cowey.  1977.   Aspects of ammoniogenesis in rainbow
    trout, Salmo gairdneri.  Comp. Biochem.  Physiol. 576:143-149.

Watts, R.L., and D.C.  Watts.  1974.  Nitrogen metabolism in fishes.  In:
    Chemical zoology.   Eds. M.  Florkin and B.T. Scheer, Vol. VIII, Academic
    Press, NY.  pp. 369-446.

Webb, J.T., and G.W. Brown, Jr.  1976.  Some properties and occurrence of
    glutamine synthetase in fish.   Comp.  Biochem. Physiol.  548:171-175.

Wright,  P.A., and C.H. Wood.   1984.  An analysis of branchial ammonia
    excretion in the  freshwater rainbow trout: effects of environmental pH
    change and  sodium uptake blockade.  J. Exp. Biol. (in press).

Wuhrmann,  K., and Woker, H.  1948.  Contributions to the toxicology of fishes.
    II Experimental investigations on ammonia - and hydrocyanic acid
    poisoning.  Translation.   Schweiz.  Z. Hydrol. 11:210-244.

Wuhrmann,  K., F. Zehender, and H.  Woker.  1947.  Biological significance for
    fisheries of ammonium-ion and ammonia content of flowing bodies of water.
    Translation of: "Uber die  fischereibiologische Bedeutung des Ammonium-und
    Ammoniakgehaltes  fliessender Gewasser".  Vierteljahrsschrift der Naturf.
    Gesellschaft in Zurich 92:198-204.
                                     30

-------
   THE USE OF FISH BEHAVIOR IN COMPARING TOXIC EFFECTS OF THREE CHEMICALS

                                      by


                                 M.G. Henry1
                                   ABSTRACT

      The behavioral effects of three chemicals are compared using a method
developed to monitor changes in social groups of bluegill, Lepomis macrochirus.
Ten behaviors were observed once daily for 96-hr before and after treatment.
Methyl parathion induced hyperactivity followed by changes in frequency of
comfort movements.  Copper sulfate disrupted respiration, but the most strik-
ing impact was an increase in aggression caused by chlordane.  The distribu-
tion of toxicant-related responses was related to social rank in each of the
treated hierarchies.  The dominant and subordinate fish were most affected.
The best indicator of toxicant effect across rank was respiratory in nature,
because coughs increased in all fish exposed to each of the three compounds.
This assay was sensitive enough to detect, behavioral alterations at concentra-
tions well below lethal levels.  Behavioral bioassays, if selected to relate
to important life history characteristics of the species of interest, could
provide useful ecological links for interpreting laboratory effects and veri-
fying them in the field.

                                 INTRODUCTION

      Assessing the toxicity associated with environmental contaminants is
chiefly a biological problem because their impact on aquatic organisms is at
the heart of the hazard evaluation process.  Despite good intentions and
sound hypotheses, however, the reality persists that our ability to relate
laboratory effects to field effects is very limited.  Classical toxicity tests
examining mortality, changes in growth, and effects on reproduction have used
single species and single compounds under sterile test conditions.  The pur-
pose they serve is that these tests produce toxicity values that are compar-
able in nature due to the use of standardized test methodology.  Despite this
-"-Columbia National Fisheries Research Laboratory, Rt. 1, Columbia, MO 65201
 Present address:  Great Lakes Fishery Laboratory, 1451 Green Road, Ann
 Arbor, MI 48105

                                      31

-------
 advantage,  the issue of  ecological  significance  remains.   Ecological aspects
 of an organism's life history,  such as  its  behavior,  need to be incorporated
 into the development and standardization of testing protocols.

       Behavior is considered the organismal level  manifestation of the physi-
 ologically and environmentally  influenced state  of the animal.   Behavior
 mediates survival and reproduction  by influencing  predator-prey interactions,
 feeding efficiency,  swimming performance, courtship,  nest digging, etc.  If
 key behaviors are altered by a  contaminant, then ultimately survival and re-
 production could decline.  Measurement  of behavioral  parameters can assist us
 in interpreting toxicant effects within an  ecological framework.   In addition,
 data from behavioral bioassays  may  aid  us in designing more focused field
 studies so that verification of laboratory  effects is possible.

      Keeping in mind the issues of  ecological significance, cost effective-
 ness, standardized methodology,  and applicability  over a  range of compound
 classes, we developed this test. Bluegill  (Lepomis macrochirus)  were used
 because they are ubiquitous throughout  North America, have been used in
 classical toxicity tests, and are behaviorally diverse.  The objectives of
 this research were to compare the behavioral effects  of three chemically
 distinct compounds and evaluate the overall utility of this test method.

                              MATERIALS  AND  METHODS

       Ten different behaviors were  monitored in  each  established population
 consisting of five adult bluegill.   Each behavior  related either to body
 maintenance or social interaction.   Daily observations (0.5 hr/tank) were
 made directly and the frequencies of each behavior were recorded by hand.
 Individual fish were recognized on  the  basis of  s-ize, color and natural
 markings.   No tags,  brands or fin clips were utilized in  the event that they
 would interfere with normal behavior patterns.

       Fish were randomly assigned to four 295L aquaria, equipped with plants
 (Elodea)  and gravel  to simulate some of the characteristics of a natural
 habitat.   Tanks were monitored  for  96-hr before  and after addition of the
 toxicant.   Each flow-through system utilized a modified Mount and Brungs (1967)
 proportional diluter to  deliver a different toxicant  concentration to each
 test  tank.   The lowest concentration selected for  each toxicant examined was
 based on a  level (if available  in the literature)  that approximated the low
 end of  the Maximum Allowable Toxicant Concentration  (MATC).  The middle con-
 centration  approximated  the upper end of the MATC  and the high concentration
 approached  the  reported  Lethal  Concentration (LC50).   If  a MATC was not avail-
 able, a geometric  progression from  the  LC50 was  used  instead.   A well water
 control was  incorporated to monitor changes through time.  The purpose of
 selecting levels based on MATCs  and LCSOs was to facilitate comparison of the
 sensitivity  of  this  new  behavioral  technique to  endpoints obtained through
more  classically accepted protocols.

      Three  separate experiments were conducted, each including two  complete
replications.   The three experiments were based  on the behavioral  evaluation
of three chemically  distinct compounds:   methyl  parathion -  an  organophosphate
insecticide, copper  sulfate - a  heavy metal,  and chlordane - an organochlorine

                                     32

-------
insecticide.  Water concentrations were determined using gas-liquid chroma-
tography or atomic absorption spectrophotometry.

      Because the number of chemicals in the United States requiring screen-
ing is so vast, standardization of new methods is crucial so that industry,
universities and government agencies can utilize them.  In over 40 replica-
tions of this behavioral bioassay, methods standardization was possible so
that the whole procedure could be completed in 17 to 21 days.  This time
period is considerably less than that required in partial-chronic tests,
thereby increasing cost efficiency without sacrificing sensitivity.  A more
detailed methods description and results/discussion can be found iri papers
by Henry and Atchison (1979a, 1979b, 1984, in review).

      For comparative purposes, four behaviors affected by the middle concen-
tration of each chemical have been selected for discussion.  Two behaviors
relate to respiratory processes and two relate to social interaction, spe-
cifically aggressive behaviors used in hierarchy establishment and maintenance.

      The two respiratory behaviors that were examined were coughs and yawns.
Coughs (Henry and Atchison 1979a, 1979b, 1984) were identified as the rapid,
repeated opening and closing of the mouth and opercular coverings, accompa-
nied by partial extension of the paired fins.  A yawn was conversely recog-
nized as a singular event typified by maximal opening of the mouth and oper-
cular covering accompanied by hyperextension of all fins, both paired and
medial.

     The two socially induced behaviors we will discuss are nips (bites) and
nudges (contact between fish, the aggressor touching the recipient with a
closed mouth).  Both of these behaviors are aggressive in nature.

      Data were transformed  (4x+1) and analyzed using analysis of .variance
and least significant difference determinations (Snedecor and Cochran 1967).

                           RESULTS AND DISCUSSION

      The postures and forms of behaviors monitored did not change in the
presence of the toxicants used; however, frequency- and hierarchy-related
distribution throughout the test population was altered.

      In general, hyperactivity was noticeable in all fish exposed to methyl
parathion.  Two comfort movements (s-jerks and fin flicks) were most altered
in frequency, increasing .significantly (P=0.001) over control levels once
methyl parathion was introduced (Henry and Atchison 1984).  Coughs also in-
creased significantly (P=0.01) in the presence of the toxicant  (Table 1).
Copper sulfate did not induce hyperactivity but dramatically influenced res-
piratory disruptions, increasing the frequency of coughs  (P=0.01) and yawns
(P=0.01) well beyond levels observed during the pre-exposure period.  Chlor-
dane produced large elevations (P=0.01) in aggressive behaviors.  The more
intense manifestations, nips, became so frequent that the most  subordinate
fish was killed by the dominant in the 0.044 mg/L treatment.
                                     33

-------
TABLE 1   MEAN FREQUENCIES  OF  FOUR BEHAVIORS  EXAMINED BEFORE AND AFTER
TABLE i.   M^AW    y    ADDITION OF THREE  CONTAMINANTS
                                                Behavior 	_^_______
Toxicant                       T**&"^^^^
     (middle concentration)



Tol rng/Lf ^             19-0/29.5     7.C0;8.5      39.COA25    8.0A.5

Copper sulfate                9.0/72.0     6.0/31.0    31.0/71.5   4.0/9.0
  (0.057 mg/L)

chlordane                    13.5/48.0     7.0/41.0    31.0/78.5   6.5/1.0
  (0.002 mg/L)               ^	

aC:T represents mean control values compared to treatment values.
       Differential response associated with social rank occurred at every
 concentration for each toxicant examined.   The dominant and the most subordi-
 nate fish were usually affected to the greatest extent.  Because fish of
 those two ranks are initially under the greatest amount of social stress
 (Sparks et al. 1972,  Noakes and Leatherland 1977), the combination of social
 stress and toxicant stress produced a more extreme response than was seen in
 fish of intermediate  rank.  The dominant and subordinate fish of each experi-
 ment are compared in  Table 2 before and after toxicant addition.  Subordinate
 fish suffered more respiratory disruptions than dominants; however, aggres-
 sive behaviors were significantly altered  in top ranking individuals.  Fish
 were affected differently, therefore, depending on hierarchy position but all
 responded to  the  presence of the toxicants.  Coughs,  although most altered in
 subordinates,  universally increased in fish of every rank exposed to each of
 the  three contaminants.   If one behavior had to be selected for cursory ex-
 amination across  ranks,  cough frequency would be the best overall indication
 of effect.

      We  know that the toxic.mode of action for methyl parathion is inhibi-
 tion  of cholinesterase at synaptic and neuromuscular junctions.  Severe inhi-
 bition of  this  enzyme  often results in induction of hyperactivity and muscular
 spasms  (Brown  1978).   As  was previously mentioned, hyperactivity was observed
 in fish exposed to methyl parathion.  Copper, on the  other hand, has been
 associated with causing  changes in gill structure (Anderson and Spear 1980).
 Increases  in coughs and  yawns relate to this suspected underlying change in
physiology and morphology.   Chlordane also disrupts respiration.   However,  it
 seems to do so by  creating anaerobic conditions in gill tissue  via inhibition
of acetylcholinesterase  (Verma et al. 1981).   Thus it  is both a neurotoxin
and respiratory disrupter.   Coughs and yawns increased  in  fish  exposed to
chlordane but aggression  did as well.
                                     34

-------
       These underlying  physiological  mechanisms  associated  with  the  induction
 of  toxic  responses  can  be  observed  at an  organismal  level in  the altered  fre-
 quency of behaviors described  above.   Thus,  this technique  appears to  be  not
 only  sensitive  but  applicable  across  different classes  of chemicals.   It  re-
 quires minimal  equipment,  can  be  conducted  in 17 to  21  days,  and is  ecologi-
 cally related to maintenance of social groups of bluegill.

       This test is,  however, only appropriate for examining species  that  form
 hierarchies.  It is not appropriate for solitary predators, schooling  fishes,
 etc.  Consequently,  use and standardization  of other behavioral  tests  such as
 predator-prey,  swimming performance or avoidance tests  could  be  utilized
 depending on the life history  characteristics of the species  of  interest.
 For example, swimming performance should  be  evaluated when  anadromous  fish
 are exposed to  a toxicant.  Sufficient swimming  stamina allows them  to reach
 nursery spawning areas  and if  altered could  reduce reproduction.

       Behavioral bioassays, used  in conjunction  with other  approaches  such as
 acute, chronic, and partial chronic tests, residue dynamic  studies, and phy-
 siological or biochemical  assays  will help us more realistically  evaluate
 chemicals and set ecologically meaningful water  quality standards.

                                   REFERENCES

 Anderson, P. D., and P.  A. Spear.   1980.  Copper pharmaco-kinetics in  fish
       gills-II.  Body size  relationships for  accumulation and  tolerance.
       Water Research 14(8):1107-1111.
TABLE 2.  MEAN FREQUENCIES OF FOUR BEHAVIORS PERFORMED BY MOST DOMINANT AND
             SUBORDINATE RANKED FISH EXPOSED TO THREE TOXICANTS
                                                Behavior
Toxicant
Methyl parathion
(0.03 mg/L)
Control
Treated
Cough
D:S
0.5/8.0
4.5/16.0
Yawn
D:S
0.0/5.0
1.0/3.5
Nip
D:S
14.5/0.0
4.5/0.0
Nudge
D:S
4.0/0.0
0.5/0.0
Copper sulfate
 (0.057 mg/L)
   Control                  3.5/3.0        0.0/2.5      16.5/0.5    0.5/1.0
   Treated                 14.5/30.5       7.0/12.0     52.5/1.5    1.0/0.0

Chlordane
 (0.002 mg/L)
   Control                  2.0/4.5        1.0/2.0      19.0/0.0    0.25/0.5
   Treated                 14.0/22.0      10.5/19.5     62.5/0.0    0.25/0.25
                                      35

-------
 Brown,  A.  W.  A.  1978.   Ecology  of  pesticides.   John Wiley and Sons, New York,
      New York.

 Henry,  M.  G.,  and  G.  J. Atchison.  1979a.   Behavioral changes in bluegill
      (Lepomis macrochirus)  as indicators  of  sublethal effects of metals.
      Environmental Biology  of Fishes  4:37-42.

 Henry,  M.  G.,  and  G.  J. Atchison.  1979b.   Influence of social rank on the
      behavior of bluegill Lepomis  macrochirus   Rafinesque,  exposed to sub-
      lethal concentrations  of cadmium and zinc.   Journal  of Fish Biology
      15:309-315.

 Henry,  M.  G.,  and  G.  J. Atchison.  1984.   Behavioral effects of methyl para-
      thion on social  groups of  bluegill  (Lepomis  macrochirus).  Environmental
      Toxicology  and Chemistry 3:399-408.

 Henry,  M.  G. ,  and  G.  J. Atchison.  In  review.   The effects of copper on the
      behavior of bluegill,  Lepomis macrochirus.   Transactions of the American
      Fisheries Society.

 Noakes,  D.  L.  G.,  and J. F.  Leatherland.   1977.   Social dominance and inter-
      renal cell  activity in rainbow trout, Salmo  gairdneri.   Environmental
      Biology  of  Fishes  2:131-136.

 Mount,  D.  I., and  W. A. Brungs.  1967.  A simplified dosing apparatus for
      fish  toxicology studies.  Water Research  1:21—29.

 Snedecor,  G. W., and W. G.  Cochran.  1967.   Statistical methods.   Iowa State
     University Press, Ames, Iowa.

 Sparks, R.  E., W. T. Waller, and J. Cairns, Jr.   1972.  Effects  of  shelters
     on the resistance of dominant and submissive bluegills  (Lepomis  macro-
     chirus) to a lethal concentration of  zinc.   Journal  of  the  Fisheries
     Research Board of Canada  29:1356-1358.

Verma, S. R.,  I.  P. Tonk,  A. K.  Gupta, and R. C. Dalela.  1981.   In-vivo
     enzymatic alterations in certain tissues of  Saccobranchus fossilis
     following exposure to four toxic substances.   Environmental  Pollution
     Series A:  Ecological Biology  26(2):121-128.
                                    36

-------
            RESISTANCE OF AQUATIC ANIMALS TO ORGANOPHOSPHORUS
                      PESTICIDES AND ITS MECHANISMS
                                    by

               V.I. Kozlovskaya, G.M. Chuyko, L.N. Lapkina
                        and V.A. Nepomnyashchikh.1
                                 ABSTRACT

     Aquatic animals possess varying resistance to organophosphorus pesti-
cides.  Fish are more resistant than invertebrates.  The toxicity of organ-
ophosphorus pesticides is caused by their ability to inhibit cholinester-
ase, primarily acetylchoiinesterase of the nervous system.  This leads to
a disruption ot the nervous system.  The molecular forms ot acetylchoiines-
terase from various animal species differ in terms of sensitivity to
organophosphorus compounds.  A dependence between the sensitivity of an
enzyme to organophosphorus pesticides and the toxicity of preparations
for an organism is apparent between invertebrates and tish, among species
close in taxonomic position as well as in individuals in the same species
for various toxic substances.  The resistance of aquatic animals, like
ground insects and mammals, depends upon the sensitivity of their choiin-
esterase.  But this is not the only mechanism of resistance.  In the
resistance of animals to organophosphorus pesticides, a definite role is
also played by the processes of metabolism and permeability.
                       INTRODUCTION AND DISCUSSION

     Water pollution by pesticides, including organophosphorus compounds,
has an adverse eftect on hydrobionts.  To effectively monitor these agents
in water and.forecast their eftect on fauna, it is necessary to determine
the resistance ot different aquatic animals to pesticides and investigate
its mechanisms.

     Aquatic animals differ in resistance to this group of compounds.  Thus,
among the 12 species ot leeches referable to 2 orders and 4 tamilies, there
are species with high (Protoclepsis tessulata, Hemiclepsis marginata) and
 •'•Institute of Biology of Inland Waters, USSR Academy of Sciences, Borok, USSR

                                      37

-------
low  (.Caspiobdella fadejewi, Herpobdella nigricollis) resistance  (Lopkina
and  Flerov  1979).  Among crustaceans and mollusks,  the  water  flea (Daphnia
pulex), hog slater (Asellus aquaticus) and large snail  (Limnaea  stagnalis)
are  the least  resistant.  The trumpet snail  (Planorbis  corneus)  dies at
high concentrations, the same as fish including crucian carp  (Carassius
carassius), roach (Rutilus rutilus) and zope  (Abramic ballerus).   The carp
 ICyprinuT carpio) is the most resistant species.  Chlorofos toxicity is
 100,000 times  higher tor the water tlea than  the carp.   There are also fish
 species with low resistance.  They are representatives  of  the Salmonidae (£.
 irrideus) and  Percidae  (P. tluviatilis) families (Table 1  and 2).  Our data
on toxicity of  organophosphorus pesticides for aquatic  animals are essenti-
ally in agreement with  the data in surveys  IHogan and Knowles 19bb, Chuyko
 et al.  19b3j prepared on the basis of results of American  studies.

      Organophosphorus compounds have a dissimilar effect on different
 stages  of the  life cycle of aquatic animals.  In leeches,  newly  hatched
 young specimens that have not begun independent feeding are  the  least
 resistant.   (4b-h LC5 are 0.003 and 0.03 mg/& for Caspiobdella fadejevi
and Piscicola  geometra, respectively.  Leech  cocoons are the  most resis-
 tant to toxicants.  Chlorofos in concentrations of  0.5  and 1  mg/& , with
4b-h exposure,  which has a devastating effect on adult  specimens, is
virtually harmless for  cocoons.  Resistance of eggs in  cocoons is at a
maximum at  the early stages of embryonic development and it diminishes by
 the end of  development  (Table 3) (Lapkina 1983).

      For  fish,  organophosphorus pesticides are the  most hazardous during
 the embryonic  (from the time of fertilization to cleavage  and at  organo-
genesis stage), larval, and young fry periods of development. In concen-
trations  of 0.01-0.001 mg/Jl, metaphos, phosalone, methylnitrophos, ioso-
phos, and sayfos impair embryogenesis and cause hatching of malformed
larvae.   At the prelarval stage, exposure to a weaker toxic agent does
not  reveal  visible disturbances; however, by  the larval stage there are
pathological deviations of development.  One of the distinctions  of effect
of organophosphorus compounds on embryogenesis is slower embryonic devel-
opment, which is associated with loss of a large number of embryos.

TABLE 1.  TOXICITY OF ORGANOPHOSPHORUS PESTICIDES FOR AQUATIC INVERTEBRATES,
          4b-h EXPOSURE AND TEMPERATURE OF lb-21°C, mg/£
                             Stage,   Maximum  tolerated
                             size,      concentration
Pesticides and Organisms	mm	(MTC)	LCso	

Chlorofos

  Leeches

  Protoclepsis tessulata      15              5              105       300

  Hemiclepsis marginata      15-22           20              100       300
                                      38

-------
TABLE i.  (Continued)
Pesticides and Organisms
Glossiphonia complanata
Helobdelia stagnalis
Caspiobdella fadejevi
Piscicola geometra
Hiruao medicinalis
haemopis sanguisuga
Herpobdella octoculata
H. testacea
H. nigricollis
H. (Dina) lineata
Crustaceans
Strep tocephalus
torvicornis
Daphnia pulex
Asellus aquaticus
Mollusks
Limnaea stagnalis
Planorbis corneus
Carbotos
Leeches
Hirudo medicinalis
Herpobdella octoculata
H. nigricollis
Stage,
size,
mm
15-25
5-10
15-25
20-35
eO
70-90
30-45
30-45
25-35
20-40
Adult
Adult
Adult
Adult
Adult

00-80
30-45
20-30
Maximum tolerated
concentration
(MTC)
15
3
0.003
0.01
0.05
2.5
0.5
0.1
0.03
1
0.00007

0.00515
1

fa. 5
4.5
1

80
50
0.07
0.8
0.3
10
1.5
O.fa
0.2
3.5
0.04
0.00028
0.4
0.5
50

11
b.5
4.7

300
250
0.5
1.5
0.6
25
1.5
1
0.8
8
0.00141

51.5
250

14
8
7
                                      39

-------
 TABLE
           (Continued)
 Pesticides and Organisms
                              Stage,   Maximum tolerated
                              size,      concentration
                               mm            (.MTC)
               LC
                 51L
          LC"in
 Crustaceans

   Daphnia pulex              Adult

   Asellus aquaticus          Adult

 Moilusks

   Limnaea stagnalis          Adult

   Planorbis corneus          Adult

 Rogor

 Leeches

   Hlrudo medicinalis          60-bO

   tierpobdella octoculata     30-45

   H.  nigricollis              20-30
 O.OUU1

 0.011



11.2

72.9
 2

 5

 3
  0.0013    0.0177

  0.27      b
 36.7

14b.O
 2b
183.2

359.7
 40

100

100
     Roe  had  the  lowest  resistance from the time or  fertilization to  cleav-
age and at  the  organogenesis stage.  Larvae on exogenous nutrition and  fry
at early  stages of  development  also have low resistance (.Guseva 1980).
Among larvae  and  fry,  the younger specimens perish taster (.Table 4).  For
try, 9b-h LC^u  of most agents constitutes 0.1-iO mg/Jl (.Johnson and Finley
1964, Post  and  Schroeder 1971,  Grischenko et al. 1975,  Prokopenko et  al.
1975).

    Current conceptions  ol  the  mechanisms  of  animal  resistance to organo-
phosphorus  compounds are based  on results  obtained primarily  for mammals
and terrestrial anthropods  (O'Brian 1971,  Rozengart  and  Shestobitov 1978).
It was established  that  resistance involved  many factors, among  which we
can single out  three basic mechanisms:  difference in rate of  penetration
ot toxicant into the body, metabolism of compounds in the body,  and sensi-
tivity of cholinesterases, which are the "targeted" enzymes.   The  last  is
the most  important, because  affinity ot  the  enzyme tor a toxicant  deter-
mines the toxicity of organophosphorus pesticides.

     In aquatic animals,  as  in mammals, choiinesterases are represented by
two types:  acetyicholinesterase (ACE) and cholinesterase (CE).  The enzyme
                                      40

-------
TABLE 2.  TOXICITY OF ORGANOPHOSPHORUS PESTICIDES FOR FISH WITH 4b-h
          EXPOSURE AT TEMPERATURE OF lb-21°C,
Fish species
Stage, age, and size,
          mm
MTC
LC
Chlorotos

  Cyprinus carpio     Current Year Brood (CY)

                            2-year old

  Carassius carasslus           CY

                            2-year old
                           90
            340
                                                            100
 1157

  500

  150
Abramis brama
A. ballerus
Rutllus rutilus
Perca tluviatilis
Salmo irrideus
Lebistes reticulatus
DlJVP [dichlorvosj
Cyprinus carpio
Perca tluviatilis
Carbotos
Cyprinus carpio
Perca fluviatilis

200 — — 200
200 — — 70
140 — 30 60
120 0.25 O.fa2 1.95
CY — 1
Adult — 14

CY i2.1 21.9 44.1
CY 0.37 0.59 1

CY 30 50 100
CY — 0.034*
 *According  to Prokopenko  et al.  1975
                                      41

-------
TABLE 3.  SURVIVAL OF  FISH LEECH  COCOONS  IN  CHLOROFOS  SOLUTIONS,  48-h
          EXPOSURE

Chlorof os
concentration
mg/
Caspiobdeila

20
20
20
10
10
10
2
2
2
Control
Cocoon
age,
days
f adejevi
(period o± embryonic
1-4
10-11
lb-20
1-4
9-11
17-20
1-4
9-12
lb-20
—
Number
of
cocoons

development ,
33
40
27
44
50
30
84
50
31
175
Hatched
quantity

20 days)
3
0
0
44
18
2
84
36
15
175
fry
%


y
0
0
100
36
6.7
100
70
48.5
100
Pisciocola geometra

50
50
50
5
5
5
Control
(.period of embryonic
1-2
7-8
10-12
3-4
7-8
11-12
—
development ,
24
25
41
44
48
35
65
14 days)
10
0
0
44
28
13
65

41.5
0
0
100
58.5
37
100
                                    42

-------
TABLE 4.  TOXICITY OF ORGANOPHOSPtiORUS COMPOUNDS FOR FISH AT DIFFERENT STAGES OF LIFE  CYCLE,  96-H.

Fish species
Salmo clarki
Salvelinus fontinalis
S. namaycush
Acipenser stellatus
Cyprinus carpio
^

-------
ol the lish brain is typical ACE.   There is ACE in biood serum ol lish, the
properties ol which resemble the enzyme ol the brain.  At the same time,
there is a blooa serum enzyme relerable to the CE type in some representa-
tives ol the lamily ol Cyprinidae Uope, roach, bream) L1UJ.  In the tested
aquatic invertebrates (with the exception ol the iresh-water oligochaetous
worm, Tubilex tubifex), there is one enzyme ol the ACE type represented in
dilterent molecular lorms.  Homogenates ol the oligochaetous worm have high
BuCE and PrCE activity, which warrants the beiiel that this species has
two enzymes (ACE ana CE,),  or one enzyme that occupies an intermediate
position, between ACE and CE, with regard to its properties figures 1
and 2).

     Data on inhibition ol fish brain ACE by chlorofos, DDVP—metabolite
oi chlorolos and carbofos—are listed in Table 5.  All oi the tested spe-
cies showed similar extent ol inhibition ol this enzyme by chlorolos.  The
values  ol pl^y constituted 3.6 lor the enzyme of roach (Rutilus rutilus)
and bream lAbramis brama)  , and about 4.0 for the enzyme of carp (Cyprinus
carpio) and perch  (Perca lluviatilis).  The values of p^Q and K^ are
higher  with carbolos and DDVP than with chlorolos, which is indicative of
the more marked inhibitory eliect of these toxicants.  We also failed to
observe species-specific dillerences in enzyme sensitivity to DDVP and
carbolos.
 TABLE  5.  VALUES OF p!5u AND K^ FOR FISH BRAIN ACETYLCHOL1NESTERASE
          DURING INTERACTION WITH CHLOROFOS, DDVP, AND CARBOFOS IN VITRO

Chlorolos
Fish species pl
-------
     There also is a correlation  between enzyme sensitivity ana product
toxicity in species that  are  close in their systematic place.  Thus, in two
species or gastropod moliusks,  the large snail ILimnaea stagnalisj and the
trumpet snail  (.Planorbis  corneus), which differ by 1UU times in resistance
to chlorotos,  an enzyme of  the  ACE type is present in nerve ganglia, which
ditfers in relative eiectrophoretic mobility (REM) and sensitivity to the
toxicant.  In  the less resistant  species, the large snail, this enzyme is
more inhibited by chlorofos (.Figure 3).

     In the species of the  family Cyprinidae that we studied, brain and
blood serum ACE  had  the  same  sensitivity to chlorotos.  At the same1time,
there was a correlation between fish resistance to this toxic agent and
blood serum CE sensitivity.  For example, blood serum contains toxicant-
sensitive CE in  the fish  species  that is less resistant to chlorofos (zope,
4tt-h LC^QQ = 7U mg/ i) , and  the  more resistant species (.carp, 4b-h L
5UU mg/^> does not have this  enzyme (.Figure 4).
W
'in

~o
-o
I*
CD
"5
"w
JD
3
CO
      a>
      o
     OC
    A. Cyprinus carpio
         .(brain)
 1400

 1200

 1000

 800

 600

. 400

 200

    0
   D. Not identified
336r
280

224

168

I 12

 56

  0,
               ATCBr
  B. Perca f luviatilis
        (brain)
350

300

250

200

150

100

 50

  0
                                 E. Not identified
                        168

                        140

                        I 12

                        84

                        56

                        28

                         0
                                    ATCBr
                                  5   4
                                                      C.Tubifex tubifex
                                                           (whole)
                                                    798
                                                    684

                                                    570

                                                    456

                                                    342
                                                      j
                                                    228

                                                    I  14

                                                      0
                                                 ATCBr
                                                       PrTCBr
                                                    BuTCBr
                                             F  Asellus aquaticus
                                                   (head]
                                                 ATCBr/
                      456

                      380

                      304

                      228

                      152

                       76
                                                      0
                                                             BuTCBr
                                                          0—0—O-rO-Oi
                                              54321
               Negative Logarithm of Molar Concentration of Substrate
Figure 1.   Substrate specificity of aquatic animal cholinesterases  at  3U°,
            pH 7.5.
                                       45

-------
                       REM 0.07-acetyicholinesterase
                       REM 0.26-0.29-cholinesterase
               0.07
               0.26
               0.29
            UJ
            on
                                         sss
                   +    1         234

                  l-Cyprinus carpio 2-Abramis ballerus

                  3-Rutilus rutilus 4-Perco fluviatilis


Figure 2.  hlectrophoregram ot  fish blood serum  cholinesterases,
    005


    0.195
  UJ
  ir
&2600
\

E  2200
=L

.«  1800
  1000

k_

2  600
3

o  200

^    0
ct:
                      A. Limnea staanalis
                                   B. Planorbis corneus
                       4321
                             II            I

                       I-Cholinesterase Electrophoregram
                      II-Substrate Specificity of Cholinesterases
        Figure 3.  Acetylcholinesterase  of mollusk ganglia.
                                  46

-------
TABLE 6.  INHIBITION OF ACETYLCHOL1NESTERASE OF  SOME  SPECIES OF AQUATIC
          INVERTEBRATES AND FISH IN VITRO BY CHLOROFOS, CARBOFOS AND DDVP,
          I50 (INHIBITOR CONCENTRATION ELICITING 50%  DEPRESSION OF ENZYME
          ACTIVITY) IN 30 MIN.

Animal species
Daphnia magna
Tubitex tubifex
Limnaea stagnalis
Chironomus plumosus
Planorbis corneus
Asellus aquaticus
Cyclops sp.
Parca fluviatilis
Abramis brama
Cyprinus carpio
Rutilus rutilus
Carassius carassius

Source ot Chlorofos, DDVP Carbotos
enzyme M M M
Whole body 7 .5 -10~b
Whole body y-10~7 — 5-iU~b
Ganglia 5-10~~t> 1.1 °10~7 7*1U~^
Whole body 10"^ 5.1-lO~b 5'10~5
Ganglia 5- 10"-5 — S'lO"-3
Head b'10~^ — —
Whole body 3°10~4 — ti°10~4
Brain 10~4 4.1-iO~b 2.y-10~3
Brain 5-10"4
jirain 10~4 2.5-10~b 10~5
Brain 5-10~i*
Brain — — l.btt-lU"-*
     A correlation between enzyme sensitivity to organophosphorus pesti-
cides and systemic resistance  is demonstrable in  the  same  species with
regard to ditterent toxicants.  Thus, T^. tubitex and  L_. stagnalis are less
resistant to chlorolos  than  carootos, and  the enzyme  ot these  species is
also more sensitive to  chlorofos (.Table 7).
     Regardless  ot  degree  ot ACE  sensitivity  to  the toxic agents  in vitro,
 a  decline  in enzyme activity  occurs in the case  ot both acute and sublethai
 intoxication,  and  it precedes  appearance  ot external signs of poisoning.
 Thus,  in carp exposed to acutely  lethal concentrations ot carbotos (.A^-h
 LC^y = 50  mg/£,  in a state ol  heightened  excitability ; hydrolyzing capacity
 ol  brain ACE decreased by  54.7/i,  with 73. 5£ loss ot equilibrium retlex.
 Thirty percent ot  the tish died within 24 h,  and the rest were on their
                                      47

-------
side at  the bottom ot  the  aquarium.
low—7.6%  (Table «).
In them, enzyme activity  was  very
     With sublethal concentrations,  upon  appearance or the tirst signs  ol
poisoning there were also  reliable  ditterences in ACE activity between  the
experiment ana the control.  When loss  ot  the  equilibrium ret lex was ob-
served, enzyme activity  constituted only  15.5%.   Thereatter, the condition
ot the tish improved.  After 2 days  there  was  recovery ot the equilibrium
retlex and ACE activity  also rose somewhat,  but  on the whole, enzyme level
was very low alter both  2  and 5 days—19.5 and 22.2%, respectively.  Enzyme
activity was not tully restored at  a later time  (1U-2U days), although  out-
wardly the condition ot  the tish did  not ditfer  from the control (Table 9)
(Kozlovsk.aya 1983).

     In gastropod mollusks CL. stagnalis and P^.  corneus) , the tirst symptom
of chiorofos intoxication  was weight  gain  due  to excessive accummulation
ot fluid in the body.   A comparison ot  changes of  weight and ACE activity
ot nerve ganglia revealed  that the decline in  enzyme activity preceded the
increase in mass (.Table 1U) (Kozlovskaya et al.  19b2).

Hog slater (A.  aquaticus)  specimens placed in  glass containers without
rough surfaces  are capable ot aggregating  (forming collections).   In the
presence oi  chlorolos poisoning, depending on  its  severity, the animals
separate (crawl arouna the dish) due  to their  excited state.  Reliable
inhibition ot ACE (by 45-50%) occurs  arter 4 h,  with U.01 mg/Ji chlorotos
concentration,  which is distinct disaggregation.
                          A. Abramis ballerus
                                                     B. Cyprinus carpio
                          Acetylcholinesterase, REM 0.07  QCholinesterase, REM 0.26

0.07




0.26
UJ
o:
1
_L






-



W\
\\






100

Qt~\
80
^^
+-
1 60
o
o) 40
E
>»
c 20
UJ
0

-

"

•
.


V

^
V
V-
x;
|
^
'////////////////a"..



















^
^
V;
^
V-
1
^
|























\
I
1
'&2W//////////A ,





























SS\
















_

-

-
.



























^
|








I
                                                     10-6 10-5  IQ-4  iQ-3
                                   Chiorofos Concentration, mol

    Figure  4.   Fish blood serum cholinesterases and  their
                chlorotos.
                      sensitivity to
                                    48

-------
TABLE 7.  TOX1CITY OF CHLOROFOS AND  CARBOFOS FOR TUBIFEX TUBIFEX AND LIMNAEA
          STAGNALIS, AND CHOLINESTERASE  SENSITIVITY  TO  THESE  AGENTS

48-h LCsd, mg/£
Animal species
T.
L.

tubif ex
stagnalis

chlorof os
0.029
0.5
carbof os
11.75
36.7
Enzyme inhibition,
1^0 in 30 min, M
chlorofos carbofos
9-10~7 5-10~6
     All of the foregoing warrants the conclusion that the resistance ot
aquatic animals to organophosphorus pesticides depends on sensitivity ot
their cholinesterases.  However, one cannot fail to consider other factors
as well.  Resistance could be aue to the rate ot penetration of the toxic
agent into the body and to detoxification processes, as indicated by the
experiments dealing with toxicity oi chlorotos and DDVP tor iish as re-
lated to ditterent routes ot administration.
     The carp and perch ditter signincantiy in resistance to chlorotos and
DDVP (, Table ll).  Investigation ot sensitivity ot brain ACE in tne carp ana
perch to chlorotos revealed that pl^(j values are similar.  4.0 lor the carp
ana 4.2 tor the perch,  brain and blood serum enzymes ot these two species
also tail to diller in sensitivity to DDVP-  The K^^ values found tor them
are ot the same order, and are in the range ot 5.t>-10-1< to 9. 2-10^ m"1
TABLE b.  CARP BRAIN ACE ACTIVITY  IN  THE  PRESENCE  OF  ACUTE CARBOFOS
          POISONING, 4b-H  LCu,0  = 50 mg/£

Dynamics ot manifestation of
poisoning symptoms
35 min — heightened excitability
1.5 h — loss ot equilibrium reflex
24 h — loss of sensitivity
24 h — deaths
48 h — loss of sensitivity
Number
of fish
10
10
10
10
10
Acetylcholinesterase activity
jjmol ATC/(g-h)
168.9+39.5*
98.4+26.3*
29.2+9.9*
45.3+11.0*
24.3+4.07*
% of control
45.3
2b.5
7.8
12.2
6.5
*Ditterence  between  control and experiment is reliable with p 0.001,
                                      49

-------
TABLE 9.  CARP BRAIN ACETYLCHOLINESTERASE ACTIVITY WITH SUBLETHAL CONCEN-
          TRATION OF CARBOFOS, 30 mg/£
Dynamics o± manelestation
Number    Acetylcholinesterase  activity
of fish   ymol ATC/Cg'h)  | % of control
UJ
1
i
2
h — heightened excitability
day — loss ot equilibrium reflex
days — restored equilibrium re-
10
1U
10
206.5+54.01*
57.8+15.02*
72.7+17.39*
55.4
15.5
19.5
  flex, but body is arched when
  fish swims

5 days—normal tish behavior, but     10
  integument is dark

10 days—condition does not differ    10
  from control fish

20 days—condition does not differ    10
  from control fish
            02.6+22.9*
           151.5+40.5*
           210.0+69.96*
40.6
56.4
*Difference between control and experiment is reliable with p 0.001
     With the intraperitoneai route of intoxication, the carp also is more
 resistant to DDVP than the perch.  In this case, however, it is only 10
 times more resis'tant than the perch (.Table 12) .

     Intraperitoneai injection ot this toxic agent precludes the route ot
 its usual penetration into fish.  For this reason, the higher value lor
 the ratio of LC^u or MVT tor carp to LC^u tor perch with the usual mode
 ot intoxication, as compared to the LD^Q ratio with intraperitoneai injec-
 tion is indicative of taster penetration ot the toxic agent into the perch.
 This warrants the conclusion that the rate ot DDVP penetration determines
 the ditterences in tish resistance to it.  Water ana substances it contains
 penetrates into all fresh-water tish mainly through the gills.  The skin is
 virtually uninvolved in this process (.Prosser 1977, Schmidt-Nielson 19b2j.

     The difference noted between DDVP resistance ot carp and perch when
 given by intraperitoneai injection can apparently be attributed to the
 difference in rate of its detoxification in fish, which occurs enzymatic-
 aliy,  mainly in the liver.  Fish liver homogenates actively break down
 organophosphorus compounds, including DDVP (.Hogan and Knowies l96b).  It
was shown that this process is taster in carp than in other tish species
 (.Fujii and Asaka 1902).
                                      50

-------
TABLE 10.  CHANGE IN WEIGHT AND CHOL1NESTERASE ACTIVITY OF GANGLIA IN
           LIMNAEA STAGNALIS WITH CHLOROFOS INTOXICATION

Time ot
experiment , h
0
3
b
24
4b**
^jj***
Number
of animals
15
15
15
15
15
12
Average
weight , %
100
100
10b.4
I2t>.3*
160.5*
97.1
Chonnesterase
activity, %
100
62.3*
45.7*
26. 9*
15.2*
y.i
   *Uitlerence between control and experiment is reliable with p 0.01.
  **Live moliusks
 ***Deaa moliusks
     The inrormation about toxicity ot organophosphorus pesticides tor
aquatic animals makes  it possible  to assess, to some extent, their adverse
effect on aquatic fauna.  Thus, judging by the results ot investigating
acute toxicity, we should expect that  the presence ot pesticides in reser-
voirs would have a devastating etlect  on leeches ot the herpobdeilidae and
Ichthyobdellidae families and, among those in  the Hirudinidae tamily, it
would attect Hirudo medicinalis, which is useful in medicine, but would
not have a deleterious ettect on the predatory leech Haemopis sanguisuga.
Among fish, representatives of the Salmonidae and Percidae families would
be the most susceptible to organophosphorus pesticides.  Fish would be
less resistant to toxic agents at  early stages of ontogenesis.  Ot all the
animals studied, crustaceans would be  the most vulnerable.

     Cladocera and, in particular, Daphnia pulex, which have low resistance
to organophosphorus compounds, are the most suitable as test objects  to  reg-
ulate levels of water  pollution by organophosphorus compounds and assess  the
toxicity of sewage trom industrial enterprises.  One should  bear in mind,
however, that plankton crustaceans have low resistance to a number of pollu-
tants,  tor this reason, in order  to .demonstrate expressly organophosphorus
compounds in water it  is necessary  to  have adequate methods ot  identifying
them.  The enzymatic method could  be used with success for this purpose,  it
is based on measurement of cholinesterase activity in animals exposed to  a
toxic agent or with direct introduction ot the enzyme into a toxic medium.
Commercial preparations and homogenates of aquatic animal organs and  tis-
sues, which contain CE that is more sensitive  to organophosphorus compounds
than ACE, can serve as sources ot  enzyme lor such purposes.

                                       51

-------
     Because production ana use ot organophosphorus pesticides will remain
high in the tuture,  along with regulations for their use, it is important to
search tor highly selective agents, with consideration ot their potential
toxicity tor aquatic animals.   It is possible to solve the problem 01 syn-
thesizing agents with selective action only it the mechanisms ot resistance
to organophosphorus  compounds  ol animals in difterent systematic groups are
known.

     In aquatic animals, resistance to organophosphorus compounds is
largely determined by the sensitivity of their target enzymes, AcE and CE.
In aquatic invertebrates that  have low resistance to organophosphorus com-
pounds, ACE is more sensitive  to toxic agents than in tish.  Resistance
of gastropod moliusks also depends on the senstnvity of ACE of their
ganglia.  Resistance of fish in the Cyprinidae family is unrelated to
sensitivity ot ACE of the brain, but is related to sensitivity ot blood
serum CE.  As shown by the results ot the experiments with the carp and
perch, there may also be mechanisms other than sensitivity of target en-
zymes', such as rate of penetration ot the toxic agent into the body and
processes ot its detoxification, that determine the resistance ot tish
to organophosphorus compounds.
       11.  TOXICll"* OF CHLOROFOS AND DDVP FOR PERCH  CPERCA FLUV1AT1L1S) AND
           CARP (.CY.PR1NUS CARP10) WHEN FISH ARE PLACED IN TOXIC ENVIRONMENT
 Fish        Number      Length ot                       Ratio ot  carp
species	ot tish	tish, mm M+m	48-h LC^p, mg/&	to perch L(

Chlorolos

  Carp         28          b2+2             340.0                b48
                                        (2by.8r428.4)*

  Perch        48          b4+l               U.b2
                                         (O.bb-rO.70)

DDVP

  Carp         3b          b7+l              21.y                  37
                                         (20.2-T23.8;

  Perch        42          b3+i               O.by
                                         (,0.b4-r0.b4)


*Coniidence intervals ot
                                      52

-------
TABLE 12.  TOXICITY OF DDVP FOR PERCH (PERCA FLUVIAT1LIS) AND CARP
           (CYPRINUS CARPIO) WHEN GIVEN BY INTRAPERlTONEAL INJECTION
 iish        Number      Length of                       Ratio o± carp
species	ot fish	fish, mm M+m	LD^^pg/g	to perch

Carp           20          109+2           292.0
                                       (254.0T33b.O)*            9.b
                                                                    )
Perch          42          109+2            30.4
                                        (23.0-40.1)
*Lonfidence interval or
                                 BIBLIOGRAPHY

Chuyko, G.M., V.I. Kozlovskaya, and V.M. Stepanova.   1983.   Blood serum
    carbonate esterases in the zope (Abramis ballerus),  roach (Rutiius
    rutilus) , bream (Abramis brama) and perch (Perca f luviatilis).  Man-
    uscript filea with the All-Union Institute of  Scientific and  Techni-
    cal Information, IBVV [Institute of Biology of Inland Waters],  USSR
    Academy of Sciences, 22 February 1983,  File No.  bi93-83.  20  p.

Fujii, Y. and S. Asaka.  1982.  Metabolism ot diazinon and  diazoxon in
    fish liver preparations.  Bull. Environ. Contam. Toxicol.  29(4).
    455-460.

Grishchenko, L.I., A.P- Verkhovskiy, and G.A. Trondina.   1975. Toxicity
    of benzophosphate (Phosalone) t-or fish and detection ot poisoning.
    In;  Byulieten1 Vsesoyuznogo instituta ekspenmental'noy veternarii
    (Bulletin ot the All-Union Institute ot Experimental Veterinary Sci-
    ence).  Moscow, USSR.  pp. 58-bl.

Guseva, S.S.  1980.  Effect of organophosphorus compounds on embryonic
    and early postembryonic development of  the carp.  Abstract of  candi-
    datorial dissertation—biological sciences.  Moscow, USSR.  22 pages.

Hogan, J.W. .and C.O. Knowles.  19b8.  Degradation of organophosphates by
    fish liver phosphatases.  J. Fish Res. Board Canada.  25(8):1571-1579.

Johnson, W.W. and M.T. Finley.   19b4.  Handbook of  acute toxicity  ot  chemi-
    cals to tish and aquatic invertebrates No. 137.  Washington,  USA.  9tt
    P-

Koziovskaya, V.I., T.V. Volkova, andV.T. Komov.  1982.  Choiinesterase
    ot neural ganglia ana water  metabolism  in Limnaea stagnalis in the
    presence ot chlorofos poisoning.  In.  Biologiya vnutrennikh vod. in-
    to rm. byul. (Biology of Inland  Waters.   Information Bulletin)  No. 55.
    Leningrad, USSR.  pp. 49-51.
                                      53

-------
Kozlovskaya, V.I.,  V.M.  Stepanova,  ana G.M. Chuyko.  iyb3.  Reversibility
    of carbotos poisoning ot carp.   In;  Reaktsii gidrobiontov na zagry-
    azneniye (Hydrobiont Reactions  to Poiiution).   Leningrad, USSR.  pp.
    191-198.

Lapkina, L.N.  19b3.   Leeches in the Rybinskiy Reservoir and their resis-
    tance to toxic agents.  Abstract of candidatoriai dissertation—bio-
    logical sciences.  Moscow,  USSR.  23 p.

Lapkina, L.N. and B.A. Fierov.   1979.  Investigation of acute poisoning
    by certain toxic  agents of  leeches.  In:   iiziologiya i parazitolo-
    giya presnovodnykh zhivotnykh (Physiology and Parasitology of Fresh-
    Water Animals).  Leningrad, USSR.  pp.  50-59.

O'Brian, R.  1971.   Toxic phosphates.  Moscow, USSR.  631 p.

Perevoznikov, M.S.   1979.   Ichthyocidai properties of carbofos.   GosMIORKh
    No. 14b.  Leningrad, USSR.   pp. 42-52.

Post, G. and T.R. Schroeder.  1971.  The toxicity  of lour insecticides to
    tour salmonid species.  Bull. Environ.  Contain. Toxicology.  6(2):
    144-145.

Prokopenko, V.A., N.P. Sokol'skaya, S.S. Nikulina, and N.R. Kosinova.  1975.
    Comparative ichthyotoxicological characteristics of methylnitro-
    phos and methathion.  In.  Problemy vodnoy toksikologii (.Problems of
    Marine Toxicology) Vol. 1.   Petrozavodsk, USSR.  pp. 11U-112.

Prosser, L.  1977.  Fluid metabolism:  Osmotic balance and hormonal regu-
    lation.  In:  Sravnitel'naya riziologiya zhivotnykh (Comparative
    Animal Physiology) Vol. 1.   Moscow, USSR.   pp. 21-11b.

Rozengart, V.I. and O.Ye.  Shestobitov.  1978.  izbiratel'naya tofcsicnnost'
    foslororganicheskikh insektoakaritsidov (Selective Toxicity of Organo-
    phosphorus Insecticides-Acaricides). Leningrad, USSR.  173 p.

Schmidt-Nielsen, K.  19»2.  Animal  physiology.  Moscow, USSR.  800 p.
                                     54

-------
          ACUTE  TOXICITY  OF 1ROM CYANIDES AND IhlOCYANAIE TO TROUT

                                      by


                              R.V. Thurston
                               T.A. Heming2
                                   ABSTRACT

      Toxic effects to rainbow trout and brook trout of exposure to terro-
cyanide,  ferricyanide, and thiocyanate were examined, under controlled light
conditions in a series of 96-hour laboratory tests.  Solutions of both iron
cyanides  were more acutely toxic to rainbow trout when tested under light
than when tested in total darkness.  Thiocyanate was acutely toxic at con-
centrations lower than suggested in a previous study, but its effects
appeared  to be relatively unpredictable.
                                 INTRODUCTION

      The toxic etfects of cyanides arise primarily trom the formation of
CN~ complexes with the metal ions present in many proteins and the subse-
quent inhibition of protein function (for review see Vennesland et al.
19bl).  In vertebrates, cytochrome c is the protein most sensitive to cya-
nide and, as a consequence, the principal effect ot cyanide is to inhibit
oxidative phosphorylation at the level ot the mitochondria.  The major
pathway for detoxification of cyanide in most animals is via conversion of
cyanide to thiocyanate (SCN~), a reaction that is catalyzed by the enzyme
rhodanase.  The resultant thiocyanate is excreted via the urinary tract.

      Acute and chronic toxic effects of cyanides, and  the effect levels,
have been extensively" studied in most groups of animals including fishes
(for review see Doudoroff 197b, Towill et al. 1978).  Similar information
regarding iron cyanides,  thiocyanate, and cyanate is limited, however,
especially for fishes and other lower vertebrates.  This lack of data is
^-Fisheries Bioassay Laboratory, Montana State University, Bozeman, MT 59717
2Aquatic Toxicology Section, Alberta Environmental Centre, Vegreville,
 Alberta, Canada TOB 4LO
                                     55

-------
especially apparent with respect to the characteristics and kinetics  of  up-
take and excretion, tissue distribution, and metabolism.

      Ferrocyanide LFe(CN)64~J and ferricyanide [FeCCN)^3"] are  byproducts
of  the cyanidation process employed in the extraction of gold  and  silver
±rom ore.  Both complexes are present frequently in ore mine effluents.
Environmental concerns about  these iron cyanide complexes generally center
around their photodegradation to free cyanide.  Light of wavelength less
than 420 nm is active in the  decomposition of ferrocyanide, and  of less
than 480 nm in the decomposition of ferricyanide (Broderius and  Smith,
1980).  Light source and intensity, therefore, are critical in any toxicity
testing with these two anions.  Free cyanide concentration, as well as
total cyanide concentration,  is important in interpreting test results.
Although quality and intensity of light appear to be the most  important
factors in the decomposition  process, temperature, pH, and dissolved  oxy-
gen also play significant roles.

      Thiocyanate enters the  aquatic biosphere directly as SCNT  and indi-
rectly as a product of the metabolism of cyanide.  The fact that endogenous
conversion ot cyanide to thiocyanate is the principal pathway  tor cyanide
detoxification in many animals does not inter that thiocyanate is not
toxic.  Thiocyanate inhibits  transport of halides in the thyroid (Wolff,
1964), stomach (Davenport 1940, Davies 1951), cornea (Zadunaisky et al.
1971), and gills (Epstein et  al. 1973, 1975) and also inhibits various
enzymes such as carbonic anhydrase (Davenport 1940) , succinic  dehydro-
genase (Solomon et al. 1973), and moieties of ATPase (Katz and Epstein
1971, Solomon et al. 1973).

      Thiocyanate has been used therapeutically in the treatment of hyper-
tension in humans, occasionally with unpredictable and tatal consequences
(Garvin 1939. Goodman and Gilman 1970).  Toxic effects to humans are  the
result of an action of SCN~ on the central nervous system and  include
irritability, nervousness,  hallucinations, psychosis, mania, delirium,
and convulsions (Barnett et al. 1951).

      Evidence of the conversion of inorganic and organic thiocyanates to
cyanide has been found in mammals (Boxer and Rickards 1952a, 1952b, Gold-
stein and Reiders 1951,  Pines and Crymble 1952).  It has been  proposed
that these conversions involve a red cell enzyme, thiocyanate  oxidase
(Goldstein and Reiders 1953), and the enzyme glutathione-S-transferase
(Habig et al. 1975).

      Information on the toxicity of thiocyanate to aquatic life forms is
scant and contains conflicting results (for reviews see Doudoroff 197b,
Huiatt et al.  1983,  Towill  et al. 1978).   Doudoroft (1976), for  example,
noted ettect levels under various conditions to occur at concentrations
ranging trom 29  to 5000  mg/liter SCN~; he concluded that "thiocyanate is
somewhat toxic."   APHA et al. (1980) have dismissed the toxicity ot thio-
cyanate as being  relatively unimportant unless subsequent chlorination,
which would produce cyanogen  chloride, is anticipated.  The U.S. Environ-
mental Protection Agency (U.S. EPA 1980)  does not list a water quality
criterion for thiocyanate.   Further examination ot the aquatic toxicity
                                     56

-------
of Chiocyanate is timely because of the recent development of the INCO
SC>2/air process for cyanide removal from industrial effluents.  This pro-
cess selectively oxidizes cyanide and metal cyanide complexes, but has
little effect on thiocyanate (Devuyst et al. 1982, Huiatt et al. 1983).

      In this presentation, we will discuss the results of recent unpub-
lished research at Fisheries Bioassay Laboratory  (FBL) on the acute tox-
icity to fishes of both iron cyanide complexes and thiocyanate.  The toxi-
cants we tested were reagent grade potassium ferrocyanide, potassium ferro-
cyanate, and potassium thiocyanate.  The test fish were hatchery-reared
rainbow trout (Salmo gairdneri) and brook  trout (Salvelinus f ontinalis).
Chemical analyses were conducted according to methods prescribed by APHA
et al. (1980), ASTM (.1981). and U.S. EPA (1974).  Fish were tested using
diluters either of the design o± Benoit (1982) or Mount and Brungs (1967).
Each diluter delivered water to one control tank  and five test tanks;
each of the test tanks was maintained at a different concentration of toxi-
cant.  Except as noted, ten fish were tested in each tank.  Median lethal
concentration (LC50) values were determined according to the Trimmed
SpearmanKarber method (Hamilton et al. 1977).  More complete details of
the testing methods have been, or will be, reported elsewhere (Meyn et al.
1984, Kerning et al. Submitted).
                FERROCYAN1DE AND FERR1CYANIDE TOXICITY TESTS

TEST PROCEDURES

      A series of 96-hour, flow-through toxicity tests was conducted on
rainbow trout to determine the toxicity of ferrocyanide and ferricyanide
under two light regimes:  total darkness and a cycle of 18 hours light/
6 hours darkness.  A minimum of two tests were run with each chemical under
each light regime.  Four additional tests, two each on ferrocyanide~and
ferricyanide, were conducted at an elevated temperature under a cyclic
regime of 18 hours light/6 hours darkness.  The tanks were glass aquaria
with glass covers, having a water volume of approximately 14 liters.  The
diluters had a flow rate of 30 ml/minute and the turnover time was approx-
imately 8 hours.  Tests were started with the test concentrations already
established in the tanks.  Fish for a given test were from a single pool
and were distributed at random among the control and test tanks.  The
tests were conducted in a room equipped with wide-spectrum bulbs (Spectra-
lite, Long-Lite Lighting Products) that were reported to produce a spec-
tral energy distribution similar to daylight.  For tests conducted in
total darkness, a red bulb was used for illumination during the collection
of water samples and during mortality checks.

      In designing the experiment, it was assumed that there might be
marked differences in photodecomposition of the toxicants between a test
regime of total darkness and one that, provided light during a simulated
daytime period.  It was further assumed that, at relatively low light
intensities (as compared with the intensity of bright sunlight, modest
differences in intensity between tanks would not significantly affect test
results.  As a consequence, no special attempt was made to ensure that


                                     57

-------
light intensities at the water surface of the different tanks  in  each test
were identical.  Two sets of test tanks were used;  the range of light
intensity at the tank water surface for one of these was 230 to 400  lux
(mean 330 lux) and for the other was 550 to 780 lux (mean  680  lux).   It
subsequently developed that these light intensity differences  most probably
played a tar greater role in determining the test results  than originally
anticipated; these differences may have been sufficient to mask differ-
ences in results attributable to temperature within the range  tested (9  to
16°C).

      Water samples for cyanide analysis were collected from the  effluent
of each tank three times during each test.  Sodium  hydroxide was  added to
each sample to raise the pH to 12;  samples were then refrigerated and
shipped to Homestake Mining Company at Lead, South  Dakota, for analysis.
Total cyanide (total CN~) was determined using a modified acid reflux/
distillation method (ASTM 1981), and "weak acid dissociable cyanides"
were determined by "Method C" (ASTM 1982).  Under our test conditions
using FBL water, which contained only insignificant quantities of metals,
"weak acid dissociable cyanides" was essentially tree cyanide.  Results
tor all tests were reported in terms of total CN~;  results for two tests
in the dark and all tests in the light also were reported in terms of
Method-C CN~.  All other water measurements were made at FBL,  and included
dissolved oxygen, temperature, pH,  alkalinity, and  hardness (Meyn et  al.
1984).

      It should be noted that solutions of ferricyanide ion are dis-
tinctly yellow.  The intensity of color increases with increasing concen-
trations and was almost orange at the highest concentrations tested.  By
contrast, ferrocyanide ion imparts only a pale yellow color to its solu-
tions, even at very high concentrations.  The presence of iron inter-
fered with alkalinity and hardness determinations in all but the  control
tanks.  Light intensity measurements were made with a Gossen Panlux
Electronic FootLambert meter, recorded as foot-candles and converted  to
lux.

      The LC50 values derived in terms of either total CN~ or Method-C CN~
should be considered valid only under the conditions of testing,  i.e.,
total darkness or 18-hour day, and at the specified temperature and  con-
centration of dissolved oxygen.  The LC50 values expressed in  terms  of
Method-C CN~ are further restricted by being computed from the means  of
concentrations that increased during some of the tests.


TEST RESULTS

      Comparison of the results of  the ferrocyanide tests conducted  in
total darkness (Tests 1074,  1077, 1078) and those under an intermittent
light regime of  either  330  lux (Tests 1088, 1090) or 680 lux (Tests
1080, 1083)  shows the fish were more sensitive to the test water  in  those
tests conducted  under light  (Table  1).   Comparison of  results of  the
tests conducted under light further shows that the  fish were more sensi-
tive  to  the  test water  at 680 lux than at 330 lux.  A variable introduced
                                     58

-------
  TABLE  1.   FERROCYAN1DE  TOXICITY  TESTS - SUMMARY  OF TEST CONDITIONS AND 96-HOUR LC50 VALUES OBTAINED
             (Ten fish per tank)
Ln
ID

Test
no.
1U74

1077
1078

1088

1090

1080

1083

Light regime,
hours of
light/dark
0/24

0/24
0/24

18/6

18/6

18/6

18/6

Mean
light
intensity,
lux
0

0
0

330

330

680

680

Mean
pH
(range)
	

-
7.95
(7.89-8.01)
7.77
(7.66-7.94)
7.83
(7.75-7.95)
7.33
(7.30-7.34)
7.55
(7.50-7.57)
Mean
temperature ,
°C
(range)
9.4
(9.4-9.5)
-
9.4
(9.4-9.5)
15.7
(15.4-16.1)
15.2
(15.2-15.4)
9.6
(9.6-9.7)
9.5
(9.5-9.6)
Mean
D.O.,
nig/liter
(range)
8.44
(7.03-8.85)
-
8.83
(8.76-8.97)
8.22
(8.01-8.49)
7.85
(7.64-8.11)
7.93
(7.77-8.17)
8.37
(8.16-8.58)
Method-C CN~
96-h LC50,
mg/liter
(95% C.I.)
	

-
1.10
(0.99-1.23)
0.79
(0.63-1.0)
0.71
(0.51-0.98)
0.15
(0.13-0.17)
0.17
( - )*
Total CN~
96-h LC50,
mg/liter
(95% C.I.)
752
(474-1190)
> 867
939
(828-1064)
220
(184-261)
232
(178-302)
33.0
(28.7-37.9
37.4
( - )*
   *Confidence interval not calculable by method used.

-------
in this second comparison, however, is that the 330-lux tests were con-
ducted at a higher temperature (15 to 16°C) than those at 680 lux (9 to
10°C).

      Comparison of the results of the ferricyanide tests conducted in
total darkness (.Tests 1075, 1076, 1079) with those conducted under an
intermittent light regime of 680 lux (Tests 1085, 1087, 1089) shows
markedly greater toxicity under light (Table 2).  Of the three tests
conducted at 680 lux, one was conducted at 10°C (Test 1085) and the
other two at 16°C (Tests 1087, 1089).  Results show a slight increase
in toxicity at the higher temperature, but the overlap in LC50 confi-
dence intervals for these tests suggests that the finding is not con-
clusive.

      To see whether there are additional conclusions that might be
drawn from these data, we combined the results ot all tests and made the
assumption that differences in toxicity, if anyt resulting from tempera-
ture differences were over-ridden by other factors.  We looked at all
the data for each test, and from each we selected the tank with the high-
est Method-C CN~ concentration at which no more than 10% mortality
occurred (Table 3).  For two of the ferricyanide tests, more than 10%
of the fish died at even the lowest concentration tested.  These were
Test 1087 with 40% mortality in Tank 2, and Test 1089 with 30% mortality
in Tank 2.  To include these tests in our data pool it was necessary to
use these tanks with > 10% mortality, presumably <^ 10% mortality would
have occurred at a lower Method-C CN~ concentration.  We then plotted
the measured light intensity for each of these test tanks versus its
measured Method-C CN~ concentration, using the highest single measurement
of Method-C CN~ in each tank as opposed to the mean of three measurements.
The rationale for selecting the highest measured Method-C CN~ value was
that the toxic action of cyanide is rather rapid, and the fish that
died were probably most affected by that highest concentration, rather
than by a 96-hour average.

      The results of this plot (Figure 1) are revealing.  The estimated
curves for both sets ot tests (ferrocyanide and ferricyanide) are simi-
lar, and one may conjecture that there may not be a significant differ-
ence between them.  The implications are that the toxicity of Method-C CN~
is light dependent, i.e., there is a correlation between the toxicity of
Method-C CN~ and light intensity.

      The behaviour and distress symptoms of fish in the ferrocyanide and
ferricyanide acute toxicity tests were similar to, but less dramatic than,
those that we also observed during acute toxicity tests on thiocyanate.
These symptoms included flaring of the gills, gaping of the mouth, erratic
and sudden movement, and immediate stiffness ot the body when the tish
died.  The symptoms were particularly noticeable at the termination of a
test when all remaining fish were anesthetized with tricainemethanesulfonate
prior to weighing and measuring.  The degree to which these symptoms were
evident was directly related to toxicant concentration; at the lowest
concentrations tested, and in the control tanks, fish did not evidence
these symptoms.
                                     60

-------
  TABLE 2.  FERR1CYANIDE TOXICITY TESTS - SUMMARY OF TEST CONDITIONS AND 96-HOUR LC50 VALUES OBTAINED
            (Ten fish per tank;
en

Light regime,
Test hours of
no. light/dark
1075 0/24

1076 0/24

1079 0/24
L081 18/6

1082 18/6

1084 18/6
1085 18/6

1087 18/6

1089 18/6

Mean
light Mean
intensity, pH
lux (range)
0 7.87
(7.46-8.23)
0 7.96
(7.75-8.17)
0
330 7.33
(7.30-7.34)
330 7.56
(7.53-7.58)
330
680 7.78
(7.76-7.80)
680 7.96
(7.89-8.06)
680 7.89
(7.79-8.10)
Mean
temperature ,
°C
(range)
9.3
(9.1-9.4)
9.3
(9.2-9.4)
-
9.6
(9.5-9.7)
9.6
(9.5-9.7)
-
10.3
(10.1-10.7)
16.0
(15.8-16.1)
16.0
(15.5-16.4)
Mean
D.O. ,
mg/liter
(range)
8.18
(7.03-8.85)
8.88
(8.70-9.01)
-
7.91
(7.61-8.11)
8.28
(8.09-8.43)
-
8.26
(8.13-8.34)
8.69
(8.58-8.83)
8.16
(8.05-8.37)
Method-C CN~ Total CN~
96-h LC50, 96-h LC50 ,
mg/liter mg/liter
(95% C.I.) (95% C.I.)
1210
(1060-1380)
869
(680-1110)
> 1.14 > 877
0.24 69.6
(0.23-0.26) (54.7-88.5)
> 0.50 > 541

> 0.61 > 731
0.42 44.2
(0.36-0.50) (38.2-51.0)
0.40 38.8
(0.36-0.43) (25.0-60.2)
0.31 10.8
(0.30-0.32) (8.96-13.1)

-------
TABLE 3.  LIGHT INTENSITY IN TANKS WITH HIGHEST METHOD-C CM" CONCENTRATION
          AT WHICH NO GREATER THAN 10% MORTALITY OCCURRED


           "                    ~    Tank with <^ 10% mortality

    Chemical and           Highest measuredLight intensity,
      test no.          Method-C CN~, mg/liter              lux
  Ferrocyanide

        1074                     1.15                         0
        1078                     1-13                         0
        1080                     0.13                       780
        1083                     0.14                       590
        1088                     0.35                       250
        1090                     0.49                       310
  Ferricyanide

         1079                     1.30                         0
         1081                     0.22                       310
         1082                     0.64                       400
         1084                     0.58                       390
         1085                     0.46                       780
         1087                     0.47*                      780
         1089                     0.33T                      780
*Test tank reported is that with lowest mortality (40%).   [See text]
TTest tank reported is that with lowest mortality (.30%).   (.See text]
                         THIOCYANATE TOXICITY TESTS

TEST PROCEDURES

      Acute (96-hour) toxicity tests were conducted on both brook trout
and rainbow trout under continuous-flow conditions as described above,
except that these tests were started at zero toxicant concentration, and
full test toxicant concentrations were effectively reached within 18 hours
Tests were conducted under two conditions:  an ambient photoperiod with
fish visually exposed to normal laboratory traffic and activities and con-
trolled photoperiods with fish isolated from these activities by curtains.
Controlled photoperiods were 24-hours white light (223 lux),  12-hours
light/12-hours dark, and 24-hours dim red light (0.2 lux).  Effects of
stress on thiocyanate toxicity were assessed in tests in which fish were
forced to swim vigorously for 30 seconds, by inserting a hand-held dip net
into the tank water and moving it around taking care not to touch the fish.
                                     62

-------
                                                 —O	 FERROCYANIDE
                                                 —,Q__ FERRICYANIDE
        0.0   O.I   0.2   0.3   0.4   0.5   0.6   0.7   O.8   0.9   1.0    I.I    i.2   1.3

                            METHOD-C CN" (mg/liter)

    Figure 1.  Test tank concentrations with £ 10% mortality vs. light intensity.
              (Ferricyanide data points with arrows  indicate  > 10% mortality.)


TEST RESULTS

      In conducting our  initial  acute toxicity tests on brook trout, we
observed that, although  there was  an overall dose response correlation,
some fish survived the 96-hour test  period at  thiocyanate concentrations
an order of magnitude  greater than those  that  caused a high percentage
of mortality to others (Table 4).  We also observed that the death of fish
frequently would be sudden,  i.e. fish that evidenced little or no sign of
distress at the time of  routine  scheduled  mortality observations were
under distress or dead shortly thereafter.  We further observed that fish
with relatively placid behaviour in  a given tank markedly increased their
swimming activity when we were collecting  water samples, or when we were
removing the fish from the  tank  at the end of  the test; some of the seem-
ingly healthy fish died  in  the dip net during removal from the tank.
These mortalities in the tank or upon removal  were characterized by sudden
rapid movement, onset  of tonic convulsions, loss of equilibrium and
buoyancy, gasping, flaring  of the  operculae, darkening of the skin epi-
thelia, and  finally cessation of ventilation and extreme  rigor.  We
termed this occurrence "sudden death syndrome" (SDS).
                                      63

-------
TABLE 4.  PERCENT MORTALITY OF BROOK TROUT* IN EACH TEST TANK DURING
          96-HOUR ACUTE TOXICITY TESTS ON THIOCYANATEt  (Tests 651,
          652, 653, 655)

Test no. -
Tank no.
651-6
651-5
651-4
651-3
652-6
651-2
652-5
652-4
653-6
652-3
653-5
652-2
653-4
653-3
653-2
655-6
655-5
655-4
655-3
655-2
All tests-1
Exposure
concentration,
mg/ liter SCN~
517
375
298
232
198
163
148
115
96.4
90.8
72.1
65.4
56.1
44.3
31.6
31.3
24.1
18.5
14.8
10.5
0.0
No. o±
fish
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
15
10
15
9
15
15
15
10
10
10
10
10
45
Percent
mortality
at 96 h
90
90
80
80
90
80
70
90
73
90
47
56
73
53
47
50
70
30
20
0
0
*Mean fish size (.and range):   6.7(5.56-7.94)  g,  8.2(6.1-10.3)  cm.

tOther measured water variables, mean values  and ranges  for  all tanks:
 temperature 15.1(12.9-17.3)°C; dissolved  oxygen 7.70(6.38-8.31) mg/liter;
 PH 7.88(7.83-7.90);  alkalinity 176(167-181)  mg/liter  as CaCO-i:  hardness
 203(195-208)  mg/liter as  CaC03.
      To test the hypothesis that SDS was related to the fish being dis-
tressed by activity near the test area, two 96-hour acute toxicity tests,
one each on brook trout (Test 658) and rainbow trout (Test 723), were con-
ducted during which activity near the test area was reduced to a necessary
minimum.  At the close of the standard 96-hour test periods, the fish were
stressed with a dip net, and mortality counts taken 15 minutes later (Test
658) and 75 minutes later (.Test 723) showed a dramatic increase over those
taken at 96 hours (Table 5).  Two additional 96-hour tests on brook trout
(Tests 657 and 659) were conducted during which the fish (10 fish per
tank) were stressed with a dip net at 24, 48, 72, and 95 hours.   Fish
                                     64

-------
size and measured water chemistry variables for  these  tests were similar
to those reported tor Test  658.  The  96-hour LC50  for  Test 657 was  13.8
mg/liter SCN~ and that for  Test 659 was  13.3 mg/liter  SCN~.

      To determine whether  the toxicity  of thiocyanate might differ with
different photoperiods, duplicate 96-hour  tests  were conducted on rainbow
trout under each of  three different light  regimes:  continuous exposure
under red light, a daily regime of  12 hours white  light and 12 hours in the
dark, and continuous exposure to white light.  The fish were least sensitive
to thiocyanate toxicity under red light, more so under the alternate light/
dark regime, and most sensitive under continuous exposure to white light
(Table 6).  At the end of the 96-hour test periods, the fish tested under
continuous red light were briefly exposed  to white light, and the light
was briefly turned off on the fish  tested  continuously under white light;
mortality counts were taken again 45  minutes later tor each of these tests.
Although not as dramatic as in the  tests with trout subjected to dip net
stress at the close  of the  96-hour  test  period  (Table  5), there was an
TABLE 5.  PERCENT MORTALITY BEFORE AND AFTER STRESS OF FISH EXPOSED
          TO THIOCYANATE*  (Ten fish/tank)
 Tank
  no.
            Brook troutt (Test 658)
  Exposure
concentration
mg/liter SCN~
   Percent
  mortality
96h
96.25h
                                     Rainbow trout** (Test 723)
  Exposure
concentration
mg/liter SCN~
                               Percent
                              mortality
96h
97.25h
   1
   2
   3
   4
   5
   6
    0.00
    5.52
    8.00
    9.99
   13.0
   16.7
  0
  0
 10
 10
  0
 10
   0
  10
  70
  70
  80
 100
     0.02
     7.70
     9.90
    11.8
    15.3
    20.8
 0
 0
 0
30
 0
50
   0
 100
 100
  80
 100
  90
 *0ther measured water chemistry variables, mean values, and ranges for all
  tanks:  Test 658 - temperature 16.3 (15.9-16.7)°C, dissolved oxygen
  7.54(7.20-7.93) mg/liter; pH 7.86(7.83-7.95), alkalinity 164 mg/liter as
  CaC03 (all measurements), hardness 194(194-195) mg/liter as CaC03; Test
  723 - temperature 11.8(11.3-12.5)°C, dissolved oxygen 9.35(9.20-9.78) mg/
  liter, pH 7.95(7.92-8.00), alkalinity 175(172-178) mg/liter as CaC03,
  hardness 202(198-206) mg/liter as CaC03.

 TMean fish size (and range) 8.9 g, 9.1(7.8-10.7) cm; 96-h LC50 > 16.7 mg/
  liter SCN~, 96.25-h LC50 7.79 mg/iiter SCN~ (95% C.I. 6.62-9.16).

**Mean fish size (and range) 0.72(0.32-1.42) g, 4.16(3.15-5.25) cm; 96-h
  LC-50 20.8 mg/liter SCN~ (95% C.I. not calculable by method used),
  97.25-h LC50 < 7.70 mg/liter SCN~.
                                     65

-------
 TABLE  6.   ACUTE  TOX1CITY  OF  THIOCYANATE.  TO  RAINBOW TROUT* DURING TESTSt
           WITH DIFFERENT  LIGHT REGIMES (Ten fish/tank)

LC50 mg/liter SCN~ (95% C.I.)
Test
no.
721
725
727
728
720
724

Light regime
Continuous red light
Continuous red light
12h white light/12h dark
12h white light/ 12h dark
Continuous white light
Continuous white light

96-h
159 (119-213)
64.6 (13.2-316)
83.5 **
55.7 (39.0-79.6)
48.3 (34.6-67.5)
44.9 (30.0-67.2)

9b.75-h
76.3 (48.7-120)
64.6 (13.2-316)


3b.7 (25.7-58.3)
41.4 (27.4-62.5)
  *Mean fish size (and  range)  0.83(0.28-1.79)  g,  4.42(3.10-5.55)  cm.

  tOther measured water variables,  mean values,  and ranges for all tanks:
   temperature 13.0(12.2-13.5)°C, dissolved  oxygen 8.96(8.66-9.30) mg/liter,
   pH. 7.93 (7.77-8.87), alkalinity  174(168-206)  mg/liter as CaC03, hardness
   202(200-206) mg/liter as CaC03.

 **Confidence intervals not  calculable by method used.
increase in mortality in three out of four of these tests following the
sudden change in light regime.

      The persistence of SDS was tested by stressing (dip net method) sep-
arate groups of juvenile rainbow trout (10 fish per group) at 0, 4, 12,
24, and 48 hours after exposure to thiocyanate for 96 hours under flow-
through conditions, a single control group was stressed at each of these
time periods.  After the 96-hour exposure period, thiocyanate addition to
the incoming water to each test tank was discontinued, concentrations in
the test tanks at 4 hours were approximately 4 mg/liter SCN~, and < 1 mg/
liter SCN~ by 12 hours.  The group stressed at 4 hours suffered 60% mor-
tality, and none of the fish died after stress at 48 hours (Table 7).
                                 DISCUSSION

      Solutions of both ferrocyanide and ferricyanide  proved  to  be  more
acutely toxic to rainbow trout when tested under light  than when tested  in
total darkness.  Further, there was a trend toward greater toxicity of
either of these solutions at greater light intensity.   Both of these poten-
tial toxicants are known to decompose under light to produce  free cyanide.
Although it was not possible for us to measure free cyanide,  the concentra-
                                     66

-------
tion of Method-C CN~ was assumed to approximate the concentration of free
cyanide.

      If free cyanide alone were the toxic agent, and it Method-C CN~
concentrations approximate free cyanide concentrations, then calculation
of LC50 values in terms of Method-C CN~ should have been comparable for
all tests regardless of light regime.  This was not the case; toxicity
of the solutions tested in terms of Method-C CN~, whether considering
the LC50 values for either or both sets of tests, or considering the
individual tanks with _< 10% mortality for both sets of tests combined,
revealed a relationship between available light and mortality of fish.

      We conclude that Method-C CN~ is not a true (approximate) measure of
free-cyanide under the conditions of our tests and/or that free cyanide was
not the sole toxic agent  in  the tests conducted.  Additional research will
be necessary to quantify  better the toxicity of solutions of iron cyanide
complexes, and  the conditions of their photodegradation.  In conducting
this additional research, greater care should be exercised to standardize
light conditions both among  tanks for any given test, and between tests
that are to be  compared for  other variables such as temperature.  Further,
the procedures  for analysis  of different forms of cyanide in the test
waters should be reviewed to ensure that samples collected have not appre-
ciably altered  by the time of analysis.
TABLE 7.  PERSISTENCE OF SUDDEN DEATH SYNDROME  IN JUVENILE RAINBOW TROUT*
          MAINTAINED IN FRESH WATER FOR DIFFERENT TIME PERIODS AFTER 96-
          HOUR EXPOSURE TO SCN~ (Test 726)





Group
no.
1
2
3
4
5
6


Exposure
concentration,
mg/liter
SCN-
0.0
6.7
7.3
6.y
b.o
7.7


-Mortalities
during
96-h
exposure
0
2
0
1
1
1
Hours in
replacement
water after
SCN~ exposure
and before
30s stressT
0
0
4
12
24
4b
Additional
mortalities
within
45-m
after
stress
0
b
6
2
3
0
Total
mortalities
during
entire
test
period
0
b
6
3
4
1
*Ten fish per group, mean  size  and  range  1.03(0.37-2.4b)  g,  4.57(3.25-6.00)
 cm.

TNo fish died during these periods.
                                     57

-------
      The results of our tests on thiocyanate demonstrate it  to  be  acutely
toxic to trout at concentrations lower than those suggested by previous
studies (see Doudoroff 1976).  The acute toxicity of thiocyanate to trout,
however, would appear to be relatively unpredictable.  Exposed fish,  which
seemed healthy, would suddenly and often tor no apparent reason  begin to
convulse and quickly expire.

      The signs of SDS in trout (convulsions, loss of equilibrium and
buoyancy, extreme rigor, among others) are virtually identical to the
characteristics of acute thiocyanate toxicity in mammals, including humans
(convulsions, vertigo, coma, hyper-reactivity, extensor rigidity) (Garvin
1939, Smith 1973).  In mammals, these effects are probably due to the SCN~
ion itself, rather than to its metabolic products, HCN, OCN , and NH-j
(Smith 1973); administration of sodium thiosulphate, an antidote for  cya-
nide poisoning, has no effect on thiocyanate toxicity in mammals.   Thiocya-
nate toxicity in mammals would appear to be influenced by neural activity,
inasmuch as sympathomimetic stimulants (e.g. amphetamines) increase the
toxicity of SCN~, whereas barbiturate anaesthetics (e.g. phenobarbital)
decrease its toxicity (Smith 1973).

      SDS in fish may represent a direct effect of the thiocyanate  anion
on neuromuscular functioning; SCN~ has been shown to enhance  the con-
tractility and electrical conduction of frog muscle fibers (Lubin 1957),
and to increase  the excitability and electrical transmission  of  spinal
neural pathways and motoneurons (Goto and Esplin 1961).  Regardless of the
exact mechanism  involved in SDS, normal rapid movements of wild  fish
during feeding and predator avoidance probably would be sufficient  to
trigger SDS as a consequence of thiocyanate exposure.

      Standard acute toxicity tests (96-hour LC5U determinations) are of
limited value in predicting the toxicity of thiocyanate because  of  the
unpredictability of SDS.  Subsequent to the studies reported  here,  we de-
termined that the correlation between plasma thiocyanate concentrations and
SDS provides a more certain measure of thiocyanate toxicity (Heming et al.
Submitted).  Those results demonstrated that fish readily accumulate  SCN~
and 50% of the fish tested would be at risk of SDS when plasma SCN~ concen-
trations reached approximately 4 mmol/liter.  The duration of thiocyanate
exposure necessary to attain that plasma concentration depends upon the
exposure concentration,  fish size,  water temperature, and ambient water
quality.

      It is possible that,  under conditions when uptake of SCN~  is  extreme-
ly slow, excretion of SCN~ would be able to keep pace with SCN~  uptake and
plasma concentrations of thiocyanate would remain low.  Under such  circum-
stances, SDS would not be expected to occur.  None of our experiments was
run at a sufficiently low concentration of thiocyanate to test this hypoth-
esis;  the lowest concentration of toxicant we tested was 17 umol/liter
KSCN.   At that level of  exposure, 6.7 g rainbow trout accumulated thiocya-
nate at a rate of approximately 15  mmol/liter plasma/day/kg fish.   Given
such a rate of SCN~ accumulation, one would expect that 50% of the  exposed
population would be at risk of SDS  within 1-2 months.  During such  long
term exposures,  fish probably would encounter the chronic toxic  effects of
                                     68

-------
thiocyanate.  In mammals, and presumably in fishes as well, SCN~ inhibits
incorporation of I~ by  the  thyroid gland, which  in the  long term results
in goiter (Wolff 1964).
                              ACKNOWLEDGMENTS

      Elizabeth L. Meyn, Donald R.  Skaar,  and Richard K. Zajdel were
principally responsible tor performing  the acute toxicity tests, and Ms.
Meyn and Terry L. Mudder (Homestake Mining Company)  for  the water cjiem-
istry analyses.  This research was  funded by the U.S. Environmental Pro-
tection Agency, Environmental Research  Laboratory, Duluth, Minnesota,
Research Grant CRbU7240, and by the Homestake Mining Company, Lead, South
Dakota.
                                 REFERENCES

APHA  (American Public Health Association), American Water Works Associa-
      tion, and Water Pollution Control Federation.  1980.  Standard
      methods for  the examination  of water and wastewater.  15th ed.
      American Public Health Association, Washington, D.C.

ASTM  (American Society  for Testing and Materials).  1981.  Proposed re-
      vision of standard methods of test for cyanide in water, Standard
      D-2036-81.   American Society for Testing and Materials, Philadelphia,
      Pennsylvania.

ASTM  (American Society  for Testing and Materials).  1982.  Designation
      D2036.  Annual book of standards.  American Society for Testing and
      Materials.   Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

Barnett, H.J.M., M.V. Jackson, and W.B. Spaulding.  1951.  Thiocyanate
      psychosis.   J. Am. Med. Assoc. 147: 1554-1558.

Benoit, D.A., V.R. Mattson, and D.L. Olson.  1982.  A continuous-flow mini-
      diluter system for toxicity  testing.  Water Res. 16: 457-464.

Boxer, G.E., and J.C. Rickards.  1952a.  Determination of traces of hydro-
      gen cyanide  in respiratory air.  Archs. Biochem. Biophys. 39: 287-
      291.

Boxer, G.E., and J.C.  Rickards.  1952b.  Determination of thiocyanate in
      body fluids.  Archs. Biochem. Biophys. 39: 292-300.

Broderius,  S.J.,  and L.L. Smith.    1980.  Final Report.  Grant No. R805291.
      U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency, Duluth, Minnesota.

Davenport,  H.W.   1940.   The inhibition of  carbonic anhydrase and of gastric
      secretion by thiocyanate.  Am. J. Physiol. 129:  505-514.

Davies,  R.E.  1951.  The mechanism of  hydrochloric acid production by the
      stomach.   Biol.  Rev. 26:  87-120.

                                     69

-------
Devuyst, E.A., B.R. Conard, and V.A. Ettel.  1982.  Pilot plant operation
      of the INCO SC>2/air cyanide removal process.  Can. Mining J. August
      1982: 27-30.

Douaoroff, P.  1976.  Toxicity to fish of cyanides and related compounds.
      A review.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Duluth, Minnesota.
      EPA-600/3-76-038.

Epstein, F.H., J. Maetz, and G. de Renzis.  1973.  Active transport of
      chloride by the teleost gill:  inhibition by thiocyanate.  Am. J.
      Physiol. 224: 1295-1299.

Epstein, F.H., P- Silva, J.M. Forrest, and R.J. Solomon.  1975.  Chloride
      transport and its inhibition by thiocyanate in gills of seawater
      teleosts.  Comp. Biochem. Physiol. 52A:  681-683.

Garvin, C.F.  1939.  The fatal toxic manifestations of the thiocyanates.
      J. Am. Med. Assoc. 112; 1125-1127.

Goldstein, F., and F. Reiders.  1951.  Formation of cyanide in dog and man
      following administration of thiocyanate.  Am. J. Physiol. 167: 47-51.

Goldstein, F., and F. Reiders.  1953.  Conversion of thiocyanate to cyanide
      by an erythrocytic enzyme.  Am. J. Physiol. 173: 287-290.

Goodman, L., and A. Gilman.  1970.  The pharmacological basis of thera-
      peutics.  4th ed.  The Macmillan Co., London, England.

Goto, K., and D.W. Esplin.  1961.  Excitatory effects of thiocyanate on
      spinal cord.  J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 133: 129-136.

Habig, W.H., J.H. Keen, and W.B. Jakoby.  1975.  Glutathion S-transferase
      in the formation of cyanide from organic thiocyanates and as an
      organic nitrate reductase.  Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 64: 501-
      506.

Hamilton, M.A., R.C. Russo, and R.V. Thurston.  1977.  Trimmed Spearman-
      Karber method for estimating median lethal concentrations in
      toxicity bioassays.  Environ. Sci. Technol. 11:714-719.
      Correction — Environ. Sci. Technol. (1978) 12: 417.

Heming, T.A., R.V. Thurston, E.L. Meyn, and R.K. Zajdel.  (Submitted).
      Acute toxicity of thiocyanate to fishes:  some physiological impli-
      cations.  Trans. Am. Fish. Soc.

Huiatt, J.L., J.E. Kerrigan, F.A. Olson, and G.L. Potter.  1983.  Work-
      shop — Cyanide from Mineral Processing.  Utah Mining and Mineral
      Resources Research Institute, Salt Lake City, Utah.

Katz, A.I.,  and F.H. Epstein.  1971.  Effect of anions on adenosine
      triphosphatase of kidney tissue.  Enzymes 12: 499-507.
                                     70

-------
Lubin, M.  1957-  The effect of iodide and thiocyanate ions on the mechani-
      cal and electrical properties of frog muscle.  J. Cell Comp. Physiol.
      49: 335-349.

Meyn, E.L., R.K. Zajdel, and R.V. Thurston.  1984.  Acute toxicity of
      ferrocyanide and ferricyanide to rainbow trout (Salmo gairdneri).
      Technical Report No. 84-1, Fisheries Bioassay Laboratory, Montana
      State University, Bozeman, Montana.

Mount, D.I., and W.A. Brungs.  1967.  A simplified closing apparatus tor
      fish toxicology studies.  Water Res. 1: 21-29.

Pines, K.L., and M.M. Crymble.  1952.  In vitro conversion of thiocyanate
      to cyanide in  the presence of erythrocytes.  Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol.
      Med. 81:  160-163.

Smith, R.P-  1973.  Cyanate and thiocyanate:  acute toxicity.  Proc. Soc.
      Exp. Biol. Med. 142:  1041-1044.

Solomon, R.J.,  P- Silva, and F.H. Epstein.  1973.  Thiocyanate inhabitable
      ATPase in the  gill of Anguilla rostrata.  Bull. Mt. Desert Island
      Biol. Lab. 13: 115-117.

Towill, L.E., J.S. Drury, B.L. Whittield, E.B. Lewis, E.L. Galyan, and A.S.
      Hammons.  1978.  Reviews of the environmental effects of pollutants:
      V. Cyanide.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Cincinnati, Ohio.
      EPA-600/1-78-027.

U.S.  EPA (U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency).  1974.  Methods for chemi-
      cal  analysis of water and wastes.  U.S. Environmental Protection
      Agency, Washington, D.C.  EPA-625/t>-74-003.

U.S.  EPA (U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency).  1980.  Ambient water qual-
      ity  criteria tor cyanides.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
      Washington, D.C.  EPA-440/5-80-037.

Vennesland, B., E.E. Conn,  C.J. Knowles, J. Westley, and F. Wissing.  1981.
      Cyanides  in biology.  Academic Press, London, England.

Wolff, J.   1964.  Transport of iodide and  other anions  in  the  thyroid gland.
      Physiol.  Rev.  44: 45-90.

Zadunaisky, J.A., M.A. Lande, and J. Hafner.  1971.  Further studies on
      chloride  transport in the  frog cornea.  Am. J. Physiol.  221:  1832-
      1836.
                                     71

-------
              PROCESSES OF FORMATION Ot  NATURAL WATER QUALITY

                                     by

                     M.I. Kuz'menko and  A.I.  Merezhko1
                                  ABSTRACT

     This paper develops the notion of a unity in the processes that deter-
mine water quality in bodies of water and water courses.  Relationships are
examined among the productivity of a body of  water,  the processes of self-
purification in it, and the resultant water quality.  Using individual hy-
drobionts, in particular the higher aquatic plants and certain invertebrates,
as examples, an analyis is made of their vital activities in relation to
the processes that determine natural water quality.   Significant attention
is given to a description of gas conditions in the body of water in relation
to photosynthesis in the higher aquatic plants.  The role of individual
hydrobionts in the absorption ana accumulation of biogenic elements and
toxic compounds is shown.   Particular attention was  directed to the role of
the root systems of plants and to the filtration capacity of dreissensia
(.zebra mussel) in these processes.  The conclusion is drawn that water
quality is a product of the functioning of the ecosystem as a whole.
                        INTRODUCTION AND DISCUSSION

     A water reservoir is a complicated ecological system with more or less
marked and, not infrequently,  quite discrete links between its elements.
The linkages are determined by the nature of hydroiogical, physicochemical
and biological processes that  provide tor the function of the ecosystem as
an integral whole.

     The productivity of the body of water and the quality of water in it
are integral indicators of function of aquatic ecosystems.  While reservoir
productivity is closely related to its trophism, water quality is related
to its self-puritication processes.  The latter takes place as a result of
biotic circulation of matter (Vinberg 1976) , which includes formation,
 Institute of Hydrobiology,  Ukrainian Academy of Sciences,


                                      72

-------
conversion, and destruction of organic compounds.  The  quantitative  ex-
pression of these processes and the relationship between  them  determines
the direction of self-purification.

     Formation of an organic substance in water (.photosynthesis) is  re-
lated to carbon dioxide uptake, use of solar energy, and absorption  ot
biogenic elements.  The relationship  between these processes indicates
that the more intensive plant photosynthesis is, the more active is  the
absorption ot biogenic elements.

     An excess or shortage of these elements leads to disturbances of in-
trareservoir processes related to self-purification and tormation ot the
quality of naturally occurring water.

     As a result of photosynthesis by aquatic plants alone, more than 400
billion tons of oxygen is discharged  per year, and it would be difficult
to exaggerate its role in formation of water quality.   According to  our
 data, perfoliate pondweed gives oft  about 50 mg oxygen/h/100 g wet weight
during photosynthesis.  The discharged oxygen is instrumental in reaeration
of water (.Vinberg iy7b) and provides  rheophil conditions for hydrobionts.

     Not infrequently, one observes oversaturation of water with oxygen
in macrophyte thickets, particularly  around noon.  Such conditions provide
tor normal vital function of hydrobionts and supply oxygen tor processes
ot oxidation of organic substances, especially in the summer.  With  ele-
vation ot temperature in thickets ot  macrophytes, there is activation or
microbiological processes.  There is  intensification of vital functions of
periphyton, which also improves oxygen conditions.  Even  if there are in-
stances ol oxygen deficiency in macrophyte thickets, they are local  and
temporary.  According to our data, the oxygen shortage  disappears with the
first rays ot the sun, and by noon to 1 pm one observes oversaturation ot
water with oxygen in thickets of macrophytes.  The prevalence ot processes
ot oxygen uptake by higher aquatic plants over its production is observed
tor only 5-fa h (.Figure 1).

     Analysis of the curves of output and uptake of oxygen by higher aqua-
tic plants warrants the conclusion that the amount of oxygen discharged
by submerged macrophyte species is more than Ib times greater than the
amount taken up.  This can be expressed as  02/1^2 = 3.1 for perfoliate
pondweed and  02/^2 = 16 for hornwort.  Hence, it can  be concluded  that
oxygen given ott during photosynthesis in higher aquatic plants is used
to a significant extent, not only tor plant respiration,  but for formation
of oxygen conditions in the water.

     One also observes a correlation  between photosynthesis of higher aqua-
tic plants and formation ot chemical  composition ol water.  This link is
manifested by a change in carbonate equilibrium and assimilation of  differ-
ent torms ot carbon dioxide by assimilating plants.  Bicarbonates are almost
always present in natural waters.  When there is intensive uptake by plants,
rree carbon dioxide disappears very rapiaiy from water, and the plants
change to assimilation of bicarbonate carbon dioxide, which again leads to
tormation of carbonates.  This is associated with change  in either direction


                                      73

-------
       CM
      o
       OT
      "OT
       o>
      £.
               200 P
               100  -
     CM
    O
    O
    o>
    E
    c
    o
 C  O
 OT  "Q.
 O  OT
"rt  V
J  tr
Q.
              -100  -
                      4      8      12      16     20
                              Time, hour of day
                                                       24
FIGURE 1.  Daily exchange ot  gases  in  the hornwort.
 in concentration of hydrogen ions  (Merezhko  1967,  Shiuyan and Merezhko
 iy/2), which in turn,  atlects  the direction  of processes of formation ot
 water quality.  But the biological  essence ot photosynthesis in processes
 ot formation of quality of  natural water is  not limited to this.

     One of the distinctions ot  all  photosynthetic organisms is their
 capacity to absorb and accumulate in tissues and organs a significant quan-
 tity of various biogenic elements.   The role of this process in the cycle
 ot biogenic elements and in forming  water quality is unquestionable.  The
 figure characterizing  accumulation of biogens by aquatic plants fluctuates
 over a rather wide range, and  it depends on  a number ot biotic and abiotic
 factors.  For this reason,  the participation of higher aquatic plants in
 processes ot formation ot water quality is permanent.

     The direction ot  intrawater processes determining iormation ot water
 quality depends largely  on  the period ot turnover of biogenic elements.
The latter, in turn, is  determined  by the physiological activity ot biogens,
                                     74

-------
intensity of their absorption, and duration ol the period of accumulation
in plants.  Nitrogen, phosphorus, potassium, iron, chlorine, and manganese
are utilized the most actively by plants.  The same elements are deciding
factors in processes ot formation ot water quality (Merezhko 1973).

     Nitrogen and phosphorus accumulate in virtually all plants in the same
amounts (Table 1).  All other  biogens are absorbed and accumulated by dif-
ferent species ot higher aquatic plants in difterent amounts.  There is
particularly distinct demonstration ot ditterences in uptake and accumula-
tion ot potassium, magnesium,  calcium, manganese, and iron.  They are taken
up the most intensively by  the lesser reedmace,  bulrush, flowering rush,
common water plantain and perfoliate pondweed, and to a lesser extent by
the common reed.

     We should dwell in particular on chlorine uptake by plants.  Virtu-
ally all ot the tested plant species absorb and  accumulate it in a rather
large quantity.  The amount ot chlorine in plants ranges from 1.U to 1.8%.
It is absorbed the most by  the common water plantain.

     Absorbed biogens are unevenly distributed in the plant (Table 2).
Thus, in August, maximum levels of nitrogen, iron, and manganese were dem-
onstrated in leaves and reproductive organs of the reed.  There are lower
levels of these biogens in  its stems and rhizomes.  The opposite is ob-
served at the end of the vegetation period.  At  this time, there is efflux
of biogens from leaves and  stems into the root system.  The latter is ex-
tremely important to processes ot formation of water quality, since a
surplus ot biogenous elements  in a reservoir is  bound, to some extent,
with plant root systems and is thus excluded from circulation for a rela-
tively long time.

     Other autotrophic organisms, including algae, play an analogous role
in processes ot circulation ot biogens in aquatic ecosystems.  The gener-
ation period is very short, however, in algae and other autotrophic organ-
isms.

     Alter the plants die otf, absorbed minerals and organic matter return
into water and become actively involved in the cycle ol matter.  The role
ot this group of autotrophs in formation ot water quality, like that ol
higher aquatic plants, is also manifested by their participation in pro-
cesses ot tormation of biologically valuable water.  Probably, algae play
the tirst and foremost role in this process.  Their role in discharging
biologically active compounds, including enzymes, into the environment and
in the tormation ol water quality is well-known  and proven (Telitchenko
1972, Telitchenko and Telitchenko 1972).  Biologically valuable water can
be formed only under the influence of hydrobionts.

     Concurrently with uptake  ot biogenous elements, autotrophs take up,
accumulate, and transform toxic compounds.  The  most importance in this
process is given to higher  aquatic plants (Merezhko et al. 1975).  There
is both passive and active  absorption ot these compounds by aquatic macro-
phytes.  Passive absorption occurs during transpiration, when one cannot
demonstrate translormation  ot  these compounds in plants.  Consequently,


                                      75

-------
TABLE 1.  ACCUMULATION OF SOME EXOGENOUS ELEMENTS IN HIGHER AQUATIC PLANTS, % DRY MATTER

Object of
study
Common reed
Lesser reedmace
-J Bulrush
<7*
Flowering rush
Common water
plantain
Perloliate
pondweed

2.17
+0.04
2.52
+0.06
2.34
+0.00
2.bfa
+0.07
2.oy
+o.oa
2.02
+0.02
p
0.35
+0.02
0.41
+0.01
o.3y
+0.01
0.40
+0.01
0.55
+0.02
0.53
+0.03
K
1.70
+0.03
i.iy
+0.01
2.35
+0.07
4.3b
+o.oy
2. by
+0.0b
2.01
+0.05
Ca
0.38
+0.002
1.07
+0.01
o.t>y
+0.02
1.3(3
+0.0t>
1.20
+0.4
o.y5
+0.02
Mg
0.10
+0.01
0.15
+0.01
0.12
+0.01
0.21
+0.02
O.lb
+0.01
0.33
-rO.02
Na
0.14
+0.02
0.51
+0.02
0.40
+0.03
0.43
+0.01
0.3b
+0.02
0.33
+0.01
Cl
1.36
+0.01
1.20
+0.02
1.5b
+0.04
1.17
+0.02
1.B7
+0.03
1.55
+0.02
Si
1.13
+0.02
0.12
+0.01
0.31
+0.01
0.34
+0.03
0.73
+0.04
0.42
+0.03
Fe,
mg%
0.005
+o.oooy
0.01
+0.001
O.OOb
+0.0007
0.03
+0.002
0.01
+0.0001
O.Ol
+0.001
Mn,
mg/o
0.02
+0.001
O.Ob
+0.001
0.03
+0.0001
o.oy
+0.002
O.Ob
+0.0001
0.03
+0.0001

-------
TABLE 2.  CHEMICAL COMPOSITION OF COMMON REED ORGANS  (.AUGUST;

Composition
Ash
Compound ,
% dry matter
N
P
K
Ca
Mg
Na
Ci
bi
Compound ,
mg% dry
matter
Fe
Mn

Leaves
6.91
2.48
0.26
U.7U
0.96
0.11
O.Ob
0.57
0.24

14.04
4b.b4
Plant
Stems
3.69
0.65
0.13
0.4b
0.2b
0.05
0.05
0.74
0.17

11.56
ll. 6b
Organs
Panicles
7.96
1.45
0.39
0.99
0.35
0.09
0.03
0.73
2.32

21.75
25. 5b

Rhizomes
b.17
1.46
0.19
2.2b
0.15
0.03
0.15
1.17
6.17

6.07
b.20
 passive absorption  ol  toxic  compounds  by  macrophytes  provides,  to  some
 extent, only  for migration o±  toxic  agents  trom  one environment to another
 —in  this  case, from water to  air.   however,  active absorption  ot  toxic
 compounds  by  macrophytes  leads  to  their complete or partial  detoxification.
 This  already  has a  direct bearing  on processes of self-purification and
 formation  ot  water  quality.

      Carbon-labeled DDT and  sevin  are  demonstrable in plants as early as
 1 day atter their introduction into  the environment.   The  highest  concen-
 trations of these agents  have  been found  in the  root  system  of  plants and
 somewhat lower ones in leaves  and  stems  (Table 3).

      The data on presence ot the radioactive  tracer in reed  organs warrant
 the assumption that DDT and  sevin  probably  enter the  plant through its
 root  system.  The arrangement  of the reed's root system is somewhat ditter-
                                      77

-------
 TABLE 3.  UPTAKE AND ACCUMULATION OF 14C-LABELED DDT AND  SEV1N BY COMMON
          REED  (Activity of specimens in thousands  of pulses/min-g)


Pesticide
DDT
Sevin

Plan
Leaves
2.4 + U.05
2.1 -1- 0.9

:s with watei
Stems
5.b + 0.9
2.8 + 0.7
1
r roots (
Water roots J_
!
540.2 +11.0 |
1
29.7 + 2.5 I
— 1
Plants \
water
Leaves
7.3 + 0.5
1.7 + 0.3
without
roots
Stems
8.4 + 0.3
0.9 + 0.2
 ent  from that of other plants.   Part  of  its  roots lie along the bottom of
 the  body of water (water roots).   These  roots are markedly ramitied, and
 they absorb the most actively both biogenous elements and toxic compounds
 (Table  4, Figure 2).  Toxic compounds  are accumulated just as actively by
 reed rhizomes, and this is important  to  processes of formation of water
 quality.  It can be assumed that,  because of this, higher aquatic plants
 can  serve under certain conditions for detoxification of some deleterious
 substances in the water environment (Merezhko 1973).
       CVJ
 E
 •
 c
           200 r
 to
 9>
jo
 •3
 Q.

 o  ,00
T3
 C
 O
 to
       C
       Q)
                                      I, Stem-1 ike water roots
                                      2. Rhizomai water roots
                                      3. Rhizomai soil roots
                                  Time,  min
                                                         60
FIGURE 2.   Intensity  of uptake of 14C of alanine-I—L4C by adventitious
           roots  of common reed.
                                     78

-------
TABLE 4.  DISTRIBUTION OF 14C IN COMMON REED ROOT SYSTEM, THOUS. PULSKS/M1N*G  DRY  WEIGHT



Pesticide
DDT


HCCH*


Control
Pesticide
Concentration
tag/ £
0.50
1.00
2.00
0.50
0.25
1.00
—
Radioactivity

Rhizomes
0.83 + 0.03
O.bl + 0.02
1.01 -t- 0.04
1.20 + 0.03
1.11 + 0.06
1.53 + 0.07
0.98 + 0.01
of leaves,
%
6.7
6.8
10.6
16.9
15.0
24.3
5.9

Water roots
0.45 + 0.00
0.53 + 0.0
0.93 + 0.01
1.02 + 0.01
0.86 + 0.0
1.45 + 0.05
0.37 + 0.0
Radioactivity
ot leaves,
%
3.6
4.4
9.8
14.3
11.6
23.0
2.2

Soil roots
O.Ofa + 0.01
0.12 + 0.0
0.18 + 0.0
0.09 + 0.0
0.06 + 0.0
0.12 + 0.0
0.70 + 0.0
Radioactivity
of leaves,
%
0.69
'i.O
1.9
1.2
0.8
1.9
0'.4
*H.exachiorocyciohexane

-------
     While we wish to stress the roie ol higher aquatic plants, as well as
other autotrophic organisms, in processes of formation of surface water
quality, it must be borne in mind that this roie can be positive only if
plants are promptly harvested from reservoirs (Frantsev 19t>9, 1972).  Thus,
according to some simple estimates, more than 200 kg nitrogen, 60 kg phos-
phorus, over 130 kg chlorine, 60 kg calcium, etc., are removed per hectare
when harvesting reed vegetation from water.

     In describing processes of formation of quality of natural waters as
related to vital functions of hydrobionts, special attention must be given
to microorganisms and invertebrates with respect to uptake and accumulation
of biogenous elements and organic compounds (Kryuchkova 1972, Vinberg 1972).
Mollusks play a special role in these processes as filters and sedimenta-
tors of suspended substances.

     The results ot many years of investigation of Dreissena polymorpha
(Shevtsova and Kharchenko 1981) indicate that this mollusk is a powerful
filter tor suspended particles.  On this basis, some authors believe that
the Dreissena plays an important part in biological self-purification
(Stanezykowska 1975, Kondrat'yev 1977, Shevtsova and Kharchenko 1981).
We cannot help but agree with this, but one should not forget that, in
the absence of a consumer of Ureissena, its roie in both selt-puritication
processes and formation ot water quality could be virtually eliminated
and, in some cases (hyperproduction) it could be negative.  Nevertheless,
the significance ot this moilusk in processes of formation of water qual-
ity in regions where it develops on a mass scale is quite obvious.
According to the data ot Shevtsova and Kharchenko (.1981), 1 m-^ of Dreis-
sena on the bottom ot a canal filters 405.9 nP of water per year.  This
is associated with up to 0.747 kg mineralization and precipitation ot 7.7
kg organic substances in the form of agglutinates.  The role of inverte-
brates in processes ot formation of water quality, like that of plants,
is determined by the direction and intensity ot their metabolic processes.
The role of higher aquatic plants has also been proven in processes ot
precipitation of suspended matter (Figure 3) (Merezhko 1978).

     Equal importance to formation of water quality is attributed to pro-
cesses of destruction and mineralization of organic matter.  It should be
borne in mind, however, that not all organic substances ot autochthonous
and allochthonous origin undergo mineralization.  A significant part of
them accumulates in the form ot inoxidizabie tractions, which otten have
a direct bearing on processes of formation of water quality (Telitchenko
1972).

     Microtlora and chemical oxidation piay the leading role in destruc-
tion and mineralization ot organic matter.  The relative involvement ot
ditterent groups ot microorganisms in destruction and mineralization of
organic matter is not the same, and it is determined by the type 01 reser-
voir and amount ot substance being mineralized (Vinberg 1972).

     Thus, the structural and tunctional organization ot circulation ot
matter in aquatic ecosystems is attected by hydrobionts on ditterent tro-
phic levels by the principle ol waste-tree technology.

                                      80

-------
      o>
      0)
      E
      TJ
      0)
      "5 2

      I I
                                 I. Common reed
                                 2. Perfoliote pondweed
                                 3.Lesser reedmace
VI                  VII
     Time, month
                                                                  VIII
FIGURL, ji.  Precipitation o± suspended matter on higher aquatic piants
           during vegetation period.
     In the case ot intensive operation of water resources for recovery of
the basic product of an aquatic ecosystem—biologically valuable water,
it is necessary to control quantitative and qualitative development ot
biohydrocenoses.  Consideration of specifics ot function and control of
development ot dominant representatives of producers ana consumers as a
function of time and space provides a possibility for selecting optimum
methods ot formation of water quality and improving the efficiency ot oper-
ating marine ecosystems.
                                BIBLIOGRAPHY

Frantsev, A.V.  196^.  One must help nature!  Khimiya I Zhizn'.  No. 4.

Frantsev, A.V.  lb»72.  Some problems of controlling water quality.  In;
    Teoriya'i praktika biologicheskogo samoochishcheniya zagryaznennykh
    vod.  Moscow, USSR.

Frobisher, M.  l^bb.  Osnovy mikrobiologii (.Bases of Microbiology), Moscow,
    USSR.

Kondrat'yev, G.P.  iy?7.  Biofiitration.  In.  Volgogradskoye vodokhran-
    ilishche:  naseleniye, bioiogicheskoye prognozirovaniye i samoochish-
    cheniye (.The Volgograd Reservoir.  Population, Biological Forecasting
    and Seit-Puritication) .  Saratov.. USSR.
                                      81

-------
Kryuchkova, N.M.  1972.  Zooplankton as an agent in self-purification of
    water reservoirs.  In:  eoriya ± praktika biologicheskogo samoochish-
    cheniya prirodnyKh vod (Theory and Practice of Biological Self-Purifi-
    cation of Naturally Occurring Waters).  Moscow, USSR.

Merezhko, A.I.  1967.  Ecological and physiological distinctions of blue-
    green algae.  Abstract of candidatoriai dissertation—biological
    sciences.  Kiev, USSR.

Merezhko, A.I.  1973.  Role of higher aquatic plants in formation of water
    quality.  Gidrobiol. Zhurn.  9(.4).

Merezhko, A.I.  197b.  Ecological ana physiological distinctions of higher
    aquatic plants and their role in formation ol water quality.  Abstract
    o± doctoral dissertation—biological sciences.  Kiev, USSR.

Shevtsova, L.V. and T.A. Kharchenko, T.A.  19ttl.  Role of Dreissena in
    processing suspended organic matter in the North Crimea Canal.  Gid-
    robiol. Zhurn.,  17(5).

Shiyan, P.N. and A.I. Merezhko.  1972.  Effect of concentration of hydro-
    gen ions on photosynthesis and metabolism ol radioactive carbon in
    aquatic plants.  Gidrobiol. Zhurn.  8(2).  Ibid, Vol. tt, No. 2, 1972.

Stanezykowska, A.  1975.  Ecosystem of the Mikolajekie Lake.  Regularities
    of the Dreissena Polymorpha Poll.  (Bivalvia)  Occurrence and its
    function in the lake.  Pol. Arch. Hydrobiol.  No. 22.

Telitchenito, M.M.  1972.  Possibility of controlling self-purification pro-
    cesses using biological methods.  In:  Teoriya i praktika biologich-
    eskogo samoochishcheniya zagryaznennykh vod.  Moscow, USSR.

Telitchenko, M.M. and L.A. Telitchenko.  1972.  The problems of water
    quality and current methods of solving them.  In;  Teoriya i praktika
    biologicheskogo samoochischen iya zagryaznennykh vod.  Moscow, USSR.

Vinberg, G.G.  1972.  Significance of hydrobiology to solution of water
    management problems.  In:  Teoriya i praktika bioiogicheskogo samoo-
    chishcheniya zagryaznennykh vod (Theory and Practice of Biological
    Self-Purification of Polluted Water).  Moscow, USSR.

Vinberg, G.G.  I97b.  Biologicheskiye protsessy samoochishcheniya na
    zagryaznennom uchastke reki (Biological Self-Purification Processes
    in Polluted River Section).  Minsk, USSR.
                                      82

-------
                C02 EXCRETION AND AMMONIA TOXICITY IN FISHES;
                           IS THERE A RELATIONSHIP?
                                      by
                                 T.A. Heming1
                                   ABSTRACT
      The aquatic toxicity of ammonia is pH-dependent and, therefore, may be
modulated by chemical-biological reactions, such as hydration of excreted
C02> which alter the pH of water adjacent to the gill surface.  Effects
of CC>2 excretion on the pH of interlamellar water of rainbow trout (Salmo
gairdneri) were investigated by following changes in the pH of mixed expired
water (pHex) using a stopped-flow apparatus.  The pHex immediately postgill
was approximately the same as inspired water pH, but pHex decreased as a
nonlinear function of time downstream of the gill.  Half-time ot the
acidification reaction was 240 sec, in excellent agreement with the half-time
of uncatalyzed COyiHCOo" equilibrium.  Acetazolamide (0.44 mM) in the bathing
medium had no effect on slow downstream changes in pHex, indicating that
branchial carbonic anhydrase was not available  to catalyse hydration of
excreted CC>2'  Downstream changes in pHex were  abolished by external carbonic
anhydrase (28,080 Wilbur-Anderson units/L).  These results suggest that C02
excretion has little, if any, acidifying effect on water adjacent to the gill
surface.  Measurements of bulk water pH are probably the best possible
indicators of boundary layer pH.  Attempts  to explain the effect of pH on
the LC50 concentration for ammonia in terms of  a significant difference
between the pH of bulk water and gill water are over-simplified to the point
of being erroneous.

                                 INTRODUCTION


      The relative  toxicity of ammonia  solutions  (NH^  + H20  = NH^ + H^O  ,
HoO+ = H+) to fishes increases when environmental pH increases (Lloyd  and
^Department of Zoology, University of British Columbia, Vancouver,  B.C.,
Canada VbT 2Ay.  Present address:  Aquatic Toxicology  Section, Alberta
Environmental  Centre, Vegreville, AB, Canada TOB  4LO.
                                       83

-------
Herbert I960, U.S. EPA 1977).   This pH-de pendency is related to an increase
in the ratio of non-ionized to ionized ammonia (NH^NH^ ) at higher pH values
(Emerson et al. 1975).  Biological membranes, such as the fish gill, are
generally more permeable to non-ionized compounds than to ionized compounds
(Jacobs 1940).  If one assumes, on the basis of this difference in gill
permeability, that NH3 is the  sole toxic species in ammonia solutions then it
follows that the LC50 concentration for such solutions in terms of the
concentration of NH3 should be independent of pH.  Various studies (Lloyd and
Herbert 1960, Tabata 1962, Tomasso et al. 1980, Thurston et al. 1981), how-
ever, have shown that the LC50 concentration for NH3 is positively correlated
with environmental pH, which suggests that NH3 is more toxic to fish at lower
pH values.  There are several  possible explanations for this trend.  Firstly,
the assumption that NH3 is the sole toxic species in ammonia solutions may be
incorrect.  NH,+ may also exert a toxic effect that would become more appar-
ent at lower pH values as the  relative proportion of NH^  in solution in-
creases.  Secondly, past calculations and measurements of the concentration
of NH3 in bulk water may be inappropriate estimates of the concentration of
    at the gill surface.
      The ratio of NHo:NH/   in solution is dependent upon the solution pH,
temperature and ionic strength (Emerson et al. 1975).  Because of heat and
mass transfer across the gill, the chemical characteristics of boundary layer
water at the gill surface must differ from that of bulk water for thermody-
namic reasons (Buysman and Koide 1971).  Such differences in water tempera-
ture and ionic strength probably are extremely minute and have negligible
effects on NH-, :NH^  equilibrium.  More importantly, several authors (Lloyd
and Herbert 1960, Szumski et al. 1982) have suggested that water adjacent to
the gill surface is significantly more acidic than bulk water due to excre-
tion of C02 and a resultant CC>2 gradient normal to the gill surface.  The
proposed differences are as large as 0.31 pH units (Lloyd and Herbert
1960).

      For hydration of metabolic C02 (C02 + H20 = H+ + HC03~) to have such an
appreciable effect on boundary layer pH, the hydration reaction must occur
rapidly enough to alter the proton concentration within the interlamellar
transit time of gill water (0.10 - 10.15 sec, Randall et al. 1982).  This
is much faster than the uncatalysed rate of C02 hydration (Kern 1960).
Szumski et al. (1982), however, have proposed that this C02 reaction is
catalysed by gill carbonic anhydrase.  These authors have developed a model
to estimate the concentration of NH3 at the gill surface taking into account
biological C02 excretion and local water quality.  Depending upon water
quality characteristics, the model of Szumski et al. (1982, see their Figure
6) predicts that the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's criterion for
total ammonia (U.S. EPA 1977) for protection of warm water fishes is 6 to
39 times too restrictive.  O^-induced acidification of water adjacent to
the gill, however, does not fully account for observed effects of pH on the
toxicity of NH3 (Roseboom 1983) or other acids/base (Broderius et al. 1977).
Moreover, there is nothing in the experimental literature that allows one
to quantify the effects of C02 excretion on the pH of interlamellar water.

      The aim of the present study was to investigate the effects of C02
excretion on the pH of water adjacent to the gill of rainbow trout (Salmo


                                      84

-------
gairdneri) by following changes in the pH of mixed expired water.   If  CC>2
hydration at the gill surface occurs rapidly enough  to have  an  appreciable
effect on interlamellar water pH, the pH of mixed expired water  (pHex) will
be lower than inspired water pH (pHin) and no downstream changes in pHex
will occur.  On the other hand, if C02 hydration at  the gill surface occurs
slowly, pHex immediately postgill will be approximately equal to pHin  and
pHex will decrease slowly downstream of the gill due to continued C02  hydra-
tion.  Downstream changes in pHex were followed using a stopped-flow appara-
tus.  Effects of external carbonic anhydrase and acetazolamide,  a specific
inhibitor of carbonic anhydrase, on downstream changes in pHex were also
examined.

                                   METHODS

      Rainbow trout (Salmo gairdneri) weighing between 200 and 400  g were
obtained from Sun Valley Hatchery (Mission, B.C.).  The fish were housed
outdoors in tanks supplied with continuous flows of dechlorinated Vancouver
tapwater (.temperature 6 - 10°C) and were fed to satiation daily with a
commercial trout food.  Fish were starved for at least 48 hours  prior to
and during the experiments.

      Fish were anaesthetized (50 - 67 mg/L tricaine methanesulfonate, pH
adjusted to 7.5 with MaHCOj, temperature 8°G) and fitted with catheters for
sampling of mixed expired water.  Catheters were constructed from polyethyl-
ene tubes (inner diameter 0.86 mm, length 15 - 20 cm) that had been heat-
sealed at one end.  Numerous small holes were made along a 3 to 4 cm length
of the tube near the sealed end.  Catheters were sutured to  the  fish, one
catheter per fish, in such a way that these holes were located immediately
behind the left opercular cover and spanned the entire length of the opercu-
lar cleft, each hole facing anteriorly into the opercular cavity.  Following
surgery, each fish was transferred to a 2-L tank supplied with a 1.5 to 2.0
L/min flow of test water that was recirculated from a thermostated  C8 +
0.5°C) 120-L reservoir.  Test water was renewed at a rate of approximately
25% every 2 days.  The test water was a balanced salt solution consisting of
40 mM NaCl, 1.6 mM KC1, 0.47 mM CaCl2, 0.62 mM MgS04, 5.5 mM NaHC03 and
0.95 mM NaH2?04 in dechlorinated Vancouver tapwater.  The buffering value
of this test water was about 0.508 mM H+/pH unit in the pH range 7.2 to 8.5.
Experiments were conducted in this test water, rather than in normal fresh-
water, because the presence of dissolved salts greatly improved  the stabili-
ty, reproducibility and response time of water pH measurements.  Fish were
allowed 7 to 10 days to acclimate to the test water before experiments were
begun.  This period of time is more than adequate to allow rainbow  trout to
re-establish'ionic, osmotic and respiratory steady-state conditions after
transfer from freshwater to balanced salt solutions  (Perry and Heming
1981).

      Water pH was measured using a polymer body, sealed reference  combina-
tion pH microelectrode (Canlab) and a Radiometer PHM64 meter, and was  simul-
taneously recorded using a chart recorder.  The pH electrode was housed in
an acrylic plastic measurement chamber (measurement volume 0.1 mL)  that was
situated in the test water upstream of the fish (Figure 1).  The inlet port
of this chamber communicated directly with the test water when measurements
                                      85

-------
 Figure 1.   Outline of  experimental  apparatus  used to measure the pH of mixed
            expired water of  trout.   A.  pH meter;  B.  chart recorder; C. peri-
            staltic withdrawal  pump;  D.  reference  combination pH electrode;
            E,  F,  and G,  reservoirs  of  test water  with and without 28,080
            Wilbur-Anderson units/L  bovine carbonic anhydrase or 0.44 mM
            acetazolamide.

 of  inspired water  pH (pHin) were made and was connected  to the opercular
 catheter when  measurements of  mixed expired water pH (pHex) were made.  In
 both situations,  the outlet port of  the chamber was  connected to a peristal-
 tic pump that  withdrew water past the electrode at a rate of  5 mL/min.  At
 that pumping rate,  water  samples required less than  1.8  sec to transit the
 opercular  catheter  and about 1.2 sec to fill  the  measurement  chamber.   Re-
 sponse time of  the  pH-measuring system was determined by rapidly switching
 the inflow to  the measurement  chamber between 20  mM  phosphate buffers  with  pH
 values of  4.05  and  7.00;  half-time  of the resultant  response  was 12.5  sec.
 This response  time  was 10 to 20 times faster  than the expected half-time of
 the uncatalysed C02:HC03  reaction  and so was deemed adequate for my purposes.

       A typical experiment consisted of the following measurements.   In-
 spired water pH was  measured under  continuous-flow conditions for 20 to 30
 minutes.   The withdrawal pump was then switched off,  suddenly stopping water
 flow past  the electrode, and pHin was followed under stopped-flow conditions.
 The  electrode assembly was then connected  to the  opercular  catheter  and pHex
 was measured under  identical continuous-flow and  stopped-flow conditions.
y«t!rn£i°V!lrOUSh the flSh tank WaS subsequently switched  to a thermostatted
 (.B + U.5 C) 4-L reservoir of test water that contained 28,080 Wilbur-Anderson
units/L; bovine carbonic anhydrase,  and pHin and  pHex  were  again measured un-
der continuous-flow and stopped-flow conditions.   Water  flow  through the fish
 tank was then returned to the control reservoir for  a  period  of  1  to 2 hours.
Finally, water flow through the fish tank was switched to  a thermostatted
                                      86

-------
(b + U.5°C) 4-L reservoir of test water that contained 0.44 mM acetazolamide,
and pHin and pHex were again measured under continuous-flow and  stopped-flow
conditions.

      Observed changes in water pH were quantified by two methods.  Firstly,
the value for dpH/dtime was calculated at the point when water flow past the
electrode was first stopped.  The initial rate of HT1" generation  was calcu-
lated as the product of that value and the buffering value of the test
water.  Secondly, the quantity of H+ generated at 1-minute intervals after
electrode flow was stopped was calculated as vBCpHex11 - pHex°),  where pHex°
was the pHex under continuous-flow conditions, pHexc was the pHex at known
time intervals after electrode flow was stopped, v was the measurement
volume, and B was the buffering value of the test water.  These  data were
fitted by the methods of least squares to a double-reciprocal plot, which
allowed calculation of the half-time of the H+ generating reaction.

      The data are presented as arithmetic means + their standard errors
(SE).  Means were compared statistically using paired Students t-tests.  A
5% level of probability (P _< U.05) was adopted as the fiducial level of sig-
nificance .

                                  RESULTS

      The pH of inspired water was unaffected by water flow past the pH
electrode, pHin measurements made under continuous-flow and stopped-flow
conditions were stable with time and did not differ from one another.  The
pH of mixed expired water, on the other hand, was affected by flow conditions
(continuous versus stopped) in control and acetazolamide studies (Figure 2).
In all control and acetazolamide studies, pHex decreased as a nonlinear
function of time once water flow past the electrode was stopped.  Flow con-
ditions had no effect on pHex in carbonic anhydrase studies.

      Kinetics of the changes in pHex under stopped-flow conditions are
summarized in Table 1.  No statistical differences were present  between the
pHex  changes in control and acetazolamide studies.  In these studies, pHex°
(mixed expired water pH under continuous-flow conditions) did not difter
significantly from pHin.  The pHex became progressively more acidic than
pHin, however, once electrode flow was stopped in control and acetazolamide
studies.  The initial rate of acidification in these studies averaged 0.943
nmol H^/min, the half-time of the acidification reaction averaged 240 sec,
and the final equilibrium pHex averaged 0.12 units lower than pHin.  Similar
changes in pHex were not seen in carbonic anhydrase studies.  In carbonic
anhydrase studies, pHex° was consistently lower than pHin by about 0.12
units, and pHex remained stable at that value under stopped-flow conditions.

                                 DISCUSSION

      Mixed expired water of rainbow trout was not in pH equilibrium when
it exited  the opercular cavity.  The pH of mixed expired water immediately
upon exiting the opercular cavity was approximately that of inspired water.
Mixed expired water became progressively more acidic than inspired water
downstream of the opercular cavity at a relatively slow rate.  The half-time


                                      87

-------
     7.64 r
     7.62
     7.60
     7.58
     756
                                                              CONTROL
     7.54
     7.62
     7.60
     7.58
                                                              ACETAZOLAMIDE
     7.56
     7.54
     7.59
                                                                   CARBONIC
                                                                   ANHYDRASE
     7.57
               0
        4

TIME,  min
8
Figure 2.   Typical changes  in  the  pH  of mixed expired water  ot  a  single
           rainbow trout at 8°C, alter water flow past  the pH electrode was
           stopped at  time  0.   The trout was exposed sequentially to  control
           test water, test water  containing 28 ,UbO Wilbur-Anderson units/L
           bovine carbonic  anhydrase, (90  minutes rinse in control test
           water, and  test  water containing 0.44  mM acetazolamide.
                                      88

-------
TABLE 1.  KINETICS OF CHANGES IN THE pH OF MIXED EXPIRED WATER OF RAINBOW
          TROUT AT 8°C, MEASURED UNDER STOPPED-FLOW CONDITIONS.  VALUES
          ARE MEANS + SE (N = 4).  pHin, INSPIRED WATER pH; pHex°, EXPIRED
          WATER pH UNDER CONTINUOUS-FLOW CONDITIONS; NS, NO SIGNIFICANT
          TRENDS IN pH WERE OBSERVED.
   pHin
   pHex
   Final      Initial rate of  Half-time of
equilibrium    H~*~ generation  H+ generation
    pH           (nmol/min)        (sec)
                                    Control
7.64 + 0.03
7.63 + 0.06
7.52 + 0.07
O.fa9 + 0.04
270 + 32
                                 Acetazolamide
7.67 + 0.04
7.66 + 0.01
7.56 + 0.02
1.00 + 0.07
210 + 13
                               Carbonic anyhdrase
7.69 + 0.04
7.57 + 0.03
7.58 + 0.04
0.05 + 0.02
   NS
of the acidification reaction was approximately 240 sec at 8°C and an
average pHin of 7.66.  This value is in excellent agreement with the half-
time for the uncatalysed equilibrium of C02 and HC03~  (Table 2).  Downstream
acidification of mixed expired water indicates that the C02:HC03 equilibrium
was dominated by hydration of excreted C02.  This is consistent with the
model of Cameron and Polhemus (1974) for C02 excretion in fish, which pre-
dicts that molecular C02 accounts for 95%  of total carbon dioxide excretion
while HCOo" efflux accounts for only the remaining 5%.  Assuming the observed
acidification reaction obeyed first-order  kinetics and given the one-for-one
stoichiometry between C02 and H4" in the C02 hydration  reaction, one calculates
from the initial rate of H  generation, the reaction half-time and the C02
solubility coefficient tor water (Boutilier et al. 1984) that the change in
Pco2 (partial pressure of C02) between inspired and mixed expired water of
                                      89

-------
TABLE 2.  HALF-TIME (SEC) FOR UNCATALYSED C02:HC03  EQUILIBRIUM  IN AQUEOUS
          SOLUTIONS AT INFINITE DILUTION, DETERMINED BY LINEAR INTERPOLATION
          OF DATA OF KERN (J. Chem. Educ., 37 :14-23, 1960) AT 0  and  25°C.
                                           Temperature (°C)
pH
4.00
5.00
6.00
7.00
7.64
8.00
9.00
10.00
11.00
0
1.3
10
74
240
—
300
200
47
5.4
8
0.94
7.2
53
172
198
212
139
32
3.7
25
0.18
1.3
9.1
26
—
25
8.7
1.1
0.12
rainbow trout at 8°C was about 0.7 torr*.  This is a reasonable value consid-
ering the arterial-venous difference in blood PcO2 across the trout gill (0.5-
1.0 torr, Heming 1984), C0£ production by gill tissue and the diluting effect
*According to first-order kinetics, reaction velocity (R, mol/L/sec) is re-
 lated to substrate concentration (c, mol/L) as
      R = kc,
 where k is the rate constant.  The half-time (t, sec) of such a reaction is
 calculated as
      t = In 2 / k.
 Given values for R and t, these equations can be rearranged to calculate the
 initial substrate concentration as
      c = Rt / In 2.
 The concentration of C02 determined in this way was converted to its partial
pressure_by division with the appropriate solubility coefficient.  Since (X>2
and HC03  in inspired water were in complete equilibrium and, therefore, did
not contribute to the observed changes in pHex, the above calculations do not
require that the Pco2 of inspired water be known.  Rather, these calculations
yield the increase in Pco£ as water passes over the gills.


                                     90

-------
of inspired water that bypasses the secondary gill lamellae.  This  suggests
that the majority of excreted CC>2 was hydrated at an  uncatalysed  rate  down-
stream of the gill; one would have expected an unreasonably low estimate  of
the difference in inspired:expired water Pco2 if excreted  C02 was hydrated in
a partially catalysed equilibrium at the gill surtace.   The finding that  ex-
ternal acetazolamide had no effect on downstream changes in pHex  indicates
that branchial carbonic anhydrase was not available to  catalyse C02:HC03
interconversions within the boundary layer at the gill  surface.   This  is
consistent with the results of histochemical surveys  of  carbonic  anhydrase in
branchial and opercular epithelia of fish (Haswell et al.  1980, Dimberg et
al. 1981, Lacy 1983).  These studies have shown that  the enzyme is  localized
in the cytoplasm and nuclei of epithelial cells; no evidence of carbonic
anhydrase on the apical surface of branchial or opercular  epithelia has been
found.  Results of  the present carbonic anhydrase studies  provide further
evidence that slow  changes observed in pHex were due  to  continued hydration
of CC>2 downstream of the opercular cavity.  Mixed expired  water attained  pH
equilibrium prior to exiting the opercular cavity only when external carbonic
anhydrase was available to catalyse CC>2 :HC03 interconversions within the
interlamellar and opercular spaces.  Table 2 demonstrates  that, in  the ab-
sence of such an external catalyst, water temperature and/or pH would have
to be outside the lethal limits of many aquatic species  for uncatalysed
CC^iHCOo reactions  to occur rapidly enough to have an appreciable effect  on
water pH within the interlamellar transit time for gill water (0.10 - 0.15
sec, Randall et al. 1982).

      What is the pE of water adjacent to the gill surface?  One  would pre-
dict, given the slow rate of uncatalysed C02 reactions,  that CX>2  excretion
would have little,  if any, effect on boundary layer pH.  Of course, C02 and
HC03  are not the only acia-base relevant molecules transfered across  the
gills.  Movements of NHo, NH^+, H+ and OH~, amongst others, across  the
gills will also influence boundary layer pH.  The net effect of all of these
transfer processes  on boundary layer pH will depend upon the direction and
magnitude of the fluxes, the interlamellar transit time  of gill water, the
uncatalysed rates of COoiHCO^" and NH^NH.^ interconversions, the buffering
capacity of the ambient water, and the volume of the  boundary layer.   As
such, boundary layer pH must be a function of ambient water quality (tempera-
ture, pH, ionic strength and composition), ventilation  rate and volume, and
the mode of ventilation (buccal pumping versus ram ventilation).  The  mass
ratio for branchial excretion of C02:NH3:H+:HC03~ in  rainbow trout  at  rest in
freshwater is about 19:3:3:1, assuming  (a) a ratio for  C02:HC03   excretion of
19:1 (Cameron and Polhemus 1974), (b) a ratio for total C02 production to
total ammonia production of 8:1 at a steady state respiratory quotient of 0^8
(Heisler 1984), (c) a'one-for-one branchial exchange  of  Na+/H+ and  HC03~/C1~
with the rate of Na+ influx being about three times that of Cl~  (Eddy  1982),
and (d) that simple diffusion of NH3 accounts for ammonia  excretion (Cameron
and Heisler 1983).  Protonation of excreted NH3 (NH3  +  H+  = NH^+) within  the
boundary layer will ameliorate acidifying effects of  H   excretion and  C02 hy-
dration; this protonation reaction occurs rapidly enough to be  complete with-
in the interlamellar transit time of gill water.  The precise effect of gill
fluxes on boundary  layer pH will be extremely temporal,  however,  since the
magnitude and even  the direction of these fluxes are  sensitive  to many biotic
and abiotic variables including exercise, respiratory acidosis,  and water

                                      91

-------
ammonia levels and salinity (Eddy 1982, Heisler 1984, Cameron and Heisler
1983).  Moreover, enhanced interlamellar turbulence during periods of rapid
or vigorous buccal pumping may eradicate gill boundary layers and directly
expose the gill surface to bulk water.  Considering the sensitivity limits of
research pH meters (+ U.001 units) and the accuracy of precision calibration
buffers (+ 0.005 units), measurement of bulk water pH is probably the best
possible Tndicator of the pH of water adjacent to the gill surface.  Models
that attempt to explain the observed effects of pH on the aquatic toxicity of
compounds, such as ammonia (Lloyd and Herbert I960, Szumski et al. 1982), in
terms of a large C02~induced acidification of the gill boundary layer must be
regarded as being over-simplified to the point of being erroneous.


                               ACKNOWLEDGMENTS

      Dr. D.J. Randall is thanked for his intellectual and material support
of this work.  Financial support was provided by a University of British
Columbia Graduate Fellowship to the author.  The work described in this paper
was not funded by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency and therefore the
contents do not necessarily reflect the views of the Agency and no official
endorsement should be inferred.
                                  REFERENCES

Broderius, S.J., L.L. Smith Jr., and D.T. Lind.  1977.  Relative toxicity of
      free cyanide and dissolved sulfide forms to the fathead minnow
      (Pimephales promelas).  J. Fish Res. Board Can.  34, 2323-2332.

Boutilier, R.G., T.A. Heming, and G.K. Iwama.  1984.  Physiochemical param-
      eters for use in fish respiratory physiology,  pg. 403-430.  In Fish
      physiology, volume X, in W.S. Hoar and D.J. Randall, editors.  Academic
      Press, New York, New York.

Buysman, J.R., and F.T. Koide.  1971.  Ion concentration profile normal to
      cell membrane.  J. Theor. Biol.  32:  1-23.

Cameron, J.N., and N. Heisler.  1983.  Studies of ammonia in rainbow trout:
      Physico-chemical parameters, acid-base behaviour and respiratory clear-
      ance.  J. Exp. Biol. 105, 107-125.

Cameron, J.N., and J.A. Polhemus.  1974.  Theory of C02 exchange in trout
      gills.  J. Exp. Biol. 60, 183-194.

Dimberg, K., L.B. Hoglund, P.G. Knutsson, and Y. Ridderstrale.  1981.  Histo-
      chemical localization of carbonic anhydrase in gill lamellae from
      young salmon (Salmo salar L.) adapted to fresh and saltwater.  Acta.
      Physiol. Scand.  112, 218-220.

Eddy,  F.B.   1982.  Osmotic and ionic regulation in captive fish with partic-
      ular reference to salmonids.  Comp. Biochem. Physiol.  73B, p. 125-
      141.
                                      92

-------
Emerson, K., R.C. Russo, R.G. Lund, and R.V- Thurston.  1975=  Aqueous
      ammonia equilibrium calculations:  Effect of pH and temperature.  J.
      Fish. Res. Board Can.  32:  2379-2383.

Haswell, M.S., D.J. Randall, and S.F. Perry.  1980.  Fish gill carbonic
      anhydrase:  Acid-base regulation or salt transport?  Amer. J. Physiol.
      238, R240-R245.

Heming, T.A.  1984.  The role of fish erythrocytes in transport and excre-
      tion of carbon dioxide.  Ph.D. thesis, University of British Columbia,
      Vancouver, B.C.

Heisler, N.  1982.  Transepithelial ion transfer processes as mechanisms
      for fish acid-base regulation in hypercapnia and lactacidosis.  Can.
      J. Zool.  60:  1108-1122.

Heisler, N.  1984.  Acid base regulation in fishes,  pg. 315-407.   In Fish
      physiology, volume X, W.S. Hoar and D.J. Randall, editors.  Academic
      Press, New York, New York.

Jacobs, M.H.  1940.  Some aspects of cell permeability to weak electrolytes.
      Cold Spring Harbour Sym. Quant. Biol.  8, 30-39.

Kern, D.M.  i960.  The hydration of carbon dioxide.  J. Chem. Educ.  37,
      14-23.

Lacy, E.R.  1983.  Histochemical and biochemical studies of  carbonic anhy-
      drase in the opercular epithelium of the euryhaline teleost, Fundulus
      heteroclitus.  Amer. J. Anatomy 166, 19-39.

Lloyd, R., and D.W.M. Herbert.  1960.  The influence of carbon dioxide on the
      toxicity of un-ionized ammonia to rainbow trout (Salmo gairdneri
      Richardson).  Ann. Appl. Biol.  48, 399-404.

Perry, S.F., and T.A. Heming.  1981.  Blood ionic and acid-base status in
      rainbow trout (Salmo gairdneri) following rapid transfer from fresh-
      water to seawater:  Effect of pseudobranch denervation.  Can. J. Zool.
      59, 1126-1132.

Randall, D.J., S.F. Perry, and T.A. Heming.  1982.  Gas transfer and acid/
      base regulation in salmonids.  Comp. Biochem. Physiol.  73B, 93-103.

Roseboom, D.P.  1983.  Discussion of:  Evaluation of EPA un-ionized ammonia
      toxicity criteria.  J. Water Poll. Control Fed.  55:  420-421.

Szumski, D.S., D.A. Barton, H.D. Putnam, and R.C. Polta.  1982.  Evaluation
      of EPA un-ionized ammonia toxicity criteria.  J. Water Poll. Control
      Fed.  54, 281-291.

Tabata, K.  1962.  Toxicity of ammonia to aquatic animals with reference to
      the effect of pH and carbon dioxide.  Bull. Tokai Reg. Fish Res. Lab.
      34:  67-74 (Transl. from Japanese).
                                      93

-------
Thurston, R.V.,  R.C.  Russo,  and G.A.  Vinogradov.   1981.   Ammonia toxicity to
      fishes.  Effect on pH on the toxicity of the un-ionized ammonia
      species.   Environ.  Sci.  Techn.   15,  837-840.

Tomasso, J.R. ,  C.A.  Goudie,  B.A. Simco,  and K.B.  Davis.   1980.   Effects of
      environmental  pH and calcium on ammonia toxicity in channel catfish.
      Trans. Amer. Fish.  Soc.   109:   229-234.

U.S. EPA (U.S.  Environmental Protection  Agency).   1977.   Quality criteria for
      water.  Office  of Water  and Hazardous Materials, U.S.  Environmental
      Protection Agency,  Washington,  B.C.
                                    94

-------
               USE OF INDICATORS OF FUNCTIONAL STATE OF BIOTA
                 IN BIOLOGICAL MONITORING OF SURFACE WATERS
                                     by

               V.A,  Bryzgalo, L.S. Fedorova, T.A. Khoruzhaya,
                      L.S. Kosmenko and L.P. Sokolova^
                                  ABSTRACT

     Discussed is the use of various functional characteristics of aquatic
ecosystems in the biomonitoring of surface waters.  A study of the system
as a whole with an assessment of the interaction between the elements of
the system and between the system and the surrounding environment has pro-
vided an opportunity to assess the intensity and direction of the basic
processes involved in the transformation of matter and energy in the com-
munities.  These processes include photosynthesis, fixation of C02, con-
sumption of organic matter, etc.

     Particular attention was given to evaluating the information pro-
vided by the individual physiological and biochemical indicators lor the
state of the biota.  Research was carried out on aquatic objects under
varying conditions ot thropogenic stress.  In addition the main criteria
were established for assessing the trend and intensity of production-
destruction processes.
                        INTRODUCTION AND DISCUSSION

     Biological monitoring of surface waters is done in  the USSR by the
hydrobiologicai network, ot the National Service for Observation and
Monitoring of the Environment (OGSNK) on three levels;   impact, regional,
and background.  At the present time, methods used for this purpose are
based on traditional hydrobiologicai observations ot systematic identifica-
tion ot species, as well as saprobiological analysis (Anon. lS»bJJ)-  Studies
are made ot total number of organisms, biomass, number of  species, marker
significance, etc.
1Hydrochemical Institute, Rustov-on-Don,  USSR


                                      95

-------
     Such an approach makes  it  possible to assess the entire ecosystem
ot a body ot water on the basis ot data concerning the condition of phy-
toplankton,  zooplankton,  bacteriopiankton, periphyton, zoobenthos, and
macrophytes.  Saprobic indexes, Vudiviss's biotic index and several other
procedures,  which permit  comparing both different parts of reservoirs to
one another and different water systems, are used tor a formalized evalua-
tion of these hydrobiocenoses.

     All these methods and approaches make it possible to describe the
structure ot an ecosystem, but  lurnish virtually no information about its
function.  Among the functional methods recommended tor use in the OGSNK
network, we should include those for determination ol primary production
and destruction of organic matter ot phytoplankton, bacterioplankton and
zooplankton, as well as pigments of phytoplankton, that are used by dif-
ferent network hydrobiological  laboratories.

     One of the reasons tor insufticient use of functional indicators in
the system ot biological  labeling of surtace water is the highly dynamic
nature of aquatic communities,  as well as the wide spatial and time heter-
ogeneity of their characteristics, and significant seasonal fluctuations
in development of the different elements ot an ecosystem.  At the same
time, the need to use the functional approach tor biological monitoring
of surface waters is growing increasingly pressing and it is dictated by
a number of factors.  The very  definition ot  the concept of "norm" as a
zone ot optimum function of a system requires use primarily ot functional
characteristics to assess the ecological state ot water systems.  Function-
al parameters are also important from the standpoint ot the basic water
protection tasks, because they  make it possible to turn to evaluation ot
the process ot tormation ot water quality, the capacity ot hydrobiocenoses
to maintain stability ot  quality characteristics of water.

     The speed of functional methods, as compared to structural ones, is
one ot the appreciable advantages ot the former particularly in effective
monitoring (.Israel1
     Successful use ot functional parameters can be made only if distinct
correlations are established between changes in them and changes in the
corresponding parameters ot the environment caused by exogenous factors.
However, even with this formulation of the problem, a number ot difficul-
ties arise,  lor example, it is quite obvious that direct measurement ot
results of the dose-ettect reaction in a water system, particularly in
studies ot plankton communities, is impossible at the present time.  As
tor model experiments, it is hardly valid to extrapolate data to natural
water ecosystems due to the absence or more or less distinct ecological
criteria ot similarity.  Finally, use ot the probabilistic statistical
approach requires comprehensive and detailed analysis ot aquatic ecosys-
tems, which is hardly expedient tor economic considerations.

     One ot the routes ot solving this problem is to tind methods of
evaluating the results ot population (.or even community) activity, pro-
vided there is substantial reduction 01 spatial resolution ot information
This becomes feasible when studies are planned in such a way that  the


                                      96

-------
water system is considered, on  the one  hand,  as  a  unique  ecosystem and,
on the other hand,  as  separate  ecosystems  in  the form ot  contrasting  water
masses characterized by specific physicochemicai conditions  ana  populations,
on the assumption  that there  is relatively little  interaction between them.

     It is possible to implement such an approach  if  we proceed  from  the
following.  Different  physicochemicai conditions determine formation  ot
different ecosystems.   This permits selection of representatives for  a
given type of study ot a  region, which  reduces spatial resolution  of  the
study and increases time  resolution.  And,  using structural  and  functional
parameters, one can gain  an idea about  the extent  and direction  ot ,main
processes of transformation of  matter and  energy in aquatic  ecosystems,
and assess the informativeness  of biochemical parameters  in  biomonitoring
of water quality.

     Properly validated conclusions about  the ecological  state of  water
systems are difficult  to  derive because ot the lack of unified and ade-
quate methodological approaches tor quantitative description of processes
that are of interest from the standpoint ot trophodynamxcs.   To  date,
quite a few tunctional characteristics  ot  state  ot marine ecosystems  have
been proposed and  developed.  A significant number of studies have dealt
with investigation ot  different tunctionai parameters ot  phytopiankton.

     As tar back as the turn  ot the century,  hydrobioiogists began to view
phytopiankton as the main producer of organic matter—and the only one in
vast expanses of ocean—on the  basis of which the  entire  diversity of
aquatic life is tormed.   This was the reason  for the  heightened interest
in investigating not only the species composition  of  phytopiankton and
its quantitative distribution,  but various  parameters characterizing  its
function.  We are  referring,  first of all,  to output', i.e.,  rate of produc-
tion ot organic matter by  phytopiankton.   To  determine this,  one generally
uses physiological methods based on comparing the  results ot determining
intensity of photosynthesis (production) and  respiration  (.destruction) of
communities according  to  oxygen balance (Federov iy?9).

     In spite of the fact  that  the oxygen  method used in most cases has
some flaws, as well as of  the dissatisfaction of many researchers  with
obtained results,  it became possible to formulate  tasks such as determin-
ation of productivity  ot  autotrophic and heterotrophic organisms.  It is
expressly in trying to assess their contribution to overall  production of
an aquatic ecosystem that more  sensitive radioactive  carbon  methods were
developed for measuring phytopiankton output.  Functional methods, which
characterize the state and activity of  phytopiankton  and, in particular,
different parameters or intensity ot photosynthesis,  underwent the great-
est development.   We should mention here tiuorescence and luminescence
techniques, which  are  highly  sensitive  and  permit  use ot  rather  simple
equipment and instruments  (Sirenko i9b3).

     We should also include among the iunctional methods  those used to
investigate processes  of  transformation and utilization ot organic mat-
ter by hydrobionts.  The mechanisms ot  these  processes and conditions
that make them efficient  are  being studied intensively, although we are


                                      97

-------
stiil tar from comprehending the key aspects of the problem (Pursons et
al. 1982).  Of definite interest are studies of heterotrophic  activity
o± aquatic cenoses both to assess their role in forming the qualitative
composition of natural waters and as an informative integral indicator
of the conditon and stablity of aquatic ecosystems.

     Interest in studying bacteriopiankton as related to water systems
differing in trophism was prompted by the substantial contribution of this
community to processes of utilization of organic matter.  Measurement of
uptake of glucose and comparing it to the total quantity of ATP-containing
bacteria, concentration of chlorophyll a, changes in pH, and levels of oxy-
gen, carbon dioxide, nitrogen and phosphorus made it possible  to define the
trophic status of 21 lakes in a mountain province of New Zealand (.Spenser
197tt).  Apparently, one can define the time and space parameters of distri-
bution ot pollutants according to rate of uptake of organic matter.  Thus,
Pearl and Goldman (.1972) obtained encouraging results using the rate of
acetate uptake as an indicator of the condition of the lake's  water masses.

     In recent years, there has been increasing discussion ot  the possi-
bility ot using kinetic parameters of uptake ot organic matter by natural
waters based on examination oi dynamics of assimilation of 1\) from water
samples with addition of labeled organic compound (Wright and  Hobble 19bb).

     By using structural and functional methods of studying aquatic com-
munities, one can gain an idea about the extent and direction  of basic
processes in aquatic ecosystems.  This is possible thanks to the fact that,
by studying the dynamics of functional parameters against the  background
of change in structure of communities, we obtain a description of proces-
ses—in particular, of photosynthesis, fixation of CO^ , uptake of organic
matter, etc.  It is expedient to use various coetficients—tor example,
the ratio of destruction to biomass (.D/B) and production to biomass (.P/B).

     Such estimates bring us to a description of extent of thermodynamic
organization ot the ecosystem or hydrobiocenosis in question (Odum 1975).
Some results of using these coetficients tor biomonitoring were recently
summarized in an article by Vernichenko and Starko (.1902).  It should be
stressed that a more or less distinct range of changes in these coeffi-
cients has not yet been defined due to insufficient development o± both
the methods of measuring primary production and destruction, and biomass.
In the OGSNK network, the P/D coefficient is used to determine the intens-
ity ot production-destruction processes.  The range ot changes in this in-
dicator has been studied more, it is used, for example, by specialists at
the IGB ot the Ukrainian Academy ot Sciences in a plan for a system oi in-
tegrated evaluation ot quality of surface waters (.Zhukinskiy et al. 1976).

     Primary production and destruction, as well as biomass levels, are
very dynamic and subject to substantial time and space changes, they de-
pend on seasonal fluctuations, hydrological conditions in the  reservoir
and other factors.  All this makes it considerably more complicated to
use them for biomonitoring.  The validity ot this statement is well-illus-
trated in the studies we conducted on reservoirs differing in  trophism
using the above-described approaches.


                                      98

-------
     The purpose ot the study included demonstration ot the main structural
and functional indicators ol the state ot the biota, which are  related  to
formation oi quality ot natural waters as related to ditterent  anthropo-
genic loads, as well as determination ot the main criteria tor  assessing
the direction and intensity ot production and destruction processes.

     The studies were conducted in a "conditionally pure" eutrophic reser-
voir, with predominantly natural eutrophication, and an oligotrophic one
with an anthropogenic load, during a period ot natural alternation tor  the
reservoir oi dominant groups ol algae, starting with diatoms and ending
with blue-green algae, covering the entire period ot development ot the
latter (from U to 9b£ ot total phytoplankton biomass).

     In the period ot phytoplankton development we studied, there were
three peak, levels ot total biomass, one ot which was attributable to de-
velopment ot diatoms (7 July), and the two others to biomass ot blue-green
algae (25 July and 15-17 August).  The natural replacement of dominants
(diatoms—blue-green algae) occurs in active competition between green and
blue-green algae, and it is notable for drastic fluctuations in biomass
level and photosynthetic activity per unit phytoplankton biomass (P/B coef-
ficient) (Table 1).  Development ot blue-green algae is associated with
relatively uniform increase in total biomass and production of phytoplank-
ton.  The P/B coefficient also rises, and during the period of drastic
dominance of blue-green algae, it changes by no more than 4 times.  The
changes in primary production are characterized by two maximums, one ot
which corresponds  to the period of diatom "blooming" (7 July),  and the
second, which is more significant, corresponds to the period of marked
"blooming" of blue-green algae (15-19 August).

     Biologically, production is the most important function in the struc-
ture of the community, when the structure is stable, the functional param-
eters, in particular P/B, remain constant.  Any change in structure ot
the community leads to change in production rate.  We found that the in-
crease in phytoplankton biomass is taster at the early stage ot "blooming"
than the increase  in production.  For this reason, there is decline ot
photosyntnetic activity per unit phytoplankton biomass (P/B coefficient).

     While we can judge the status ol an ecosystem as a whole from the  P/B
ratio, the ratio of phytoplankton production to its population  size (P/S)
enables us to turn to a description of the condition ot cells ot individ-
ual specimens, which is determined primarily by presence of nutrients in
their environment.

     Evidently, this ratio could indicate, indirectly, the purpose ot phy-
toplankton activity:  intensive division and increase in number or accumu-
lation ot nutrients in the cell, i.e, increase of its biomass.  Indeed,
during the period  of diatom and green algae blooming, when activity is
directed toward retaining their populations, there is a maximal Pp/S ratio
(U.2-U.b) '1U~3.  Under favorable ambient conditions, the dominant blue-
green algae expend a significant part ot the newly formed organic matter
on cell division and increase in population size.  The Pp/S ratio is then
smaller by a factor of 10 (0.2-0.3)-11T3 -
                                      99

-------
   TABLE 1.  CHARACTERISTICS OF PHYTOPLANKTON (p) ACTIVITY ACCORDING TO SOME PARAMETERS
o
o

Date of
taking
sample
7 Jul
9 Jul
11 Jul
14 Jul
25 Jul
30 Jul
10 Aug
12 Aug
15 Aug
iy Aug
22 Aug
Total number (S) , Biomass
thousands (Bp)
cells/m& mg C/£
2
1
2
Ib
14
50
b2
95
493
706
b
.0
.96
.00
.70
.55
.60
.60
.00
.00
.00
.50
0
0
.145
.047
0.045
0
1
0
0
1
3
5
0
.470
.100
.790
.760
.140
.600
.060
.160
Production
W p) >
mg C/(£ day)
1
0
0
0
0
1
2
2
29
13
1
.60
.30
.47
.49
.32
.25
.3b
.bb
.30
.10
.16
w
mg C/
(mg -day)
11
6
10
1
0
1
3
2
b
2
7
.0
.0
.0
.0
.3
.6
.0
.5
.0
.6
.0
Pp/S, Heterotrophic
yg C/ pyruvate uptake,
(cells -day) yg C/(&-day)
O.bO
0.15
0.24
0.03
0.02
0.02
0.03
0.03
0.06
0.02
0.13
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-3
10-3
—
0.16
0
—
0.12
4.74
0
5.3
14.5
0
0
   The rate ol pyruvate uptake by blue-green algae reached 5-15 yg C/(£-day).

-------
     Hydrochemicai studies revealed that, during  the period of prevalence
ot blue-green algae, levels of mineral  forms  of nitrogen  and  phosphorus
were favorable for their development, and the C:N:P ratio was optimum.
However, the results of measuring heterotrophic activity  ot algae  (assay
of phytoplankton uptake of iZtC-pyruvate) revealed that, even without a
shortage ot mineral nutrients, blue-green algae at the stage of maximum
photosynthetic activity are capable ot  utilizing  readily  available  organic
substances.

     As we know, intensity ot metabolism, i.e, ratio ot respiration to bio-
mass (R/B) determines the extent or thermodynamic organization (Wright
and Hobble 1966), which could characterize  the reaction of the ecosystem
to an exogenous factor.  Most often, one uses the P/B ratio, rather than
R/B, and the former expresses the increment ot production per unit  initial
or mean value.  P/B, the coetticient or its reciprocal B/P-coefticient of
turnover of biomass—are considered by  many researchers to be the most
informative parameters characterizing the production capacities of  a given
species or entire community.

     During the period of intensive phytoplankton blooming, bacterioplank-
ton reacts to its environment by increasing its functional activity (Table
2).  Bactenoplanfcton production reaches a maximum during the period of
maximum development of blue-green algae (15-19 August).   However, it we
calculate averaged activity per cell (ratio of P  to total population size) ,
the result will indicate that, in spite of  the large number of cells,
bacterioplankton is in a relatively depressed state during the period ot
dominance of blue-green algae.  Activity drops from 6-10~* yg C/day to
U.7b-lu~^ yg C/aay.

     The ratio ot heterotrophic ^C-pyruvate heterotrophic uptake to bac-
terial biomass production, as determined from dark assimilation of  CC>2, can
also serve as an indirect indicator of  the  state  of bacterioplankton.  The
higher the activity or bacterial cells, the closer the ratio is to  1.

     These studies enabled us' to conclude that neither total population
size nor biomass, nor even such functional parameters as  production of
phytoplankton and bacterioplankton could yield sufficient information about
the state of the natural population.  It is only  by turning to a descrip-
tion ot activity of the population unit (one  cell) that we come close to
characterizing the actual response of organisms to a change in their en-
vironment, in both the case of its natural  change at the  early stage of the
eutrophication process and in the case  of "severe" anthropogenic pollution.
The seeming "wellbeing" ol the ecosystem, which can be assessed by  the
structural organization of the cenosis, conceals  appreciable changes in
condition of organisms in different trophic chains and the population as a
whole (specific activity, rate of biomass turnover, doubling time,  intens-
ity of respiration, coefficient of energy metabolism, etc.).  These changes
in status of the ecosystem can be detected only if studies are made with
sutticient spatial and time resolution.

     Approaches based on evaluation ot  ditferent  physiological and  bio-
chemical parameters are among promising methods that have not yet  been
                                      101

-------
TABLE 2.  CHARACTERISTICS OF BACTERIOPLANKTON ACTIVITY ACCORDING TO SOME FUNCTIONAL PARAMETERS

Date 01
Taking Sample
9 Jul
11 Jul
14 Jul
25 Jul
29 Jul
j
I 30 Jul
31 Jul
10 Aug
12 Aug
15 Aug
19 Aug
21 Aug
22 Aug
Total number (S) ,
millions
ceils/m&
0.54
0.79
2.01
0.94
13.20
17.60
4.60
—
—
—
—
1.05
2.90
Production (yg
determined by
i'*C-carbonate
tPh)
2
8
8
4
40
10
17
b
35
44
89
5
12
C/ (i 'day} , as
uptake of
•^C-pyruvate
(PE)
1.31
4.68
8.17
2.87
17.30
13.48
4.37
1.50
8.42
32.80
22.46
0.82
3.80
P£/Ph
0.65
0.58
1.02
0.71
0.43
1.35
0.26
0.26
0.24
0.75
0.25
0.16
0.32
Specific production
Pg/S,
yg C/( cells -day)
2.4 10~9
6.0 10~y
4.0 10~y
3.0 10~y
1.3 10^
0.76 10~9
0.95 10~y
—
—
—
—
0.78 10~y
1.30 10~y

-------
sutficientiy developed, which retlect the functional state ot aquatic eco-
systems.  In our opinion, biomonitoring methods  involving use ot  parameters
of enzymatic activity of both individual hydrobionts and populations, and
even aquatic communities merit special attention.  Proceeding from  the key
theses of biology to the effect that a reaction  to environmental  changes
is manifested primarily by change  in rate and nature of enzymatic proces-
ses, it can be assumed a priori that the level of enzyme activity could be
used to assess water quality.  The response  of an enzyme system character-
izes the state or aquatic organisms when there are fluctuations in  physi-
cochemical parameters ot the environment, while  the functional reserves
retlect the degree of adaptation to them.

     This approach is not without  some flaws.  On the  one hand, some en-
zymatic reactions are "universal"  in a sense and provide for basic  meta-
bolic -processes over a rather wide range of  fluctuations ot conditions in
the aquatic environment.  On the other hand, some biochemical parameters
are "specific," i.e., they reflect a response to only  a specific  type of
pollution.

     Thus, use ot biochemical parameters, including enzymatic ones, re-
quires a validated choice of methods that are adequate to the purpose or
observation, as well as determination of the range ot  changes in  a  given
enzymatic tunction in hydrobionts  that are not exposed to a tactor, i.e.,
definition ot the reaction "norm."  The difficulty of  this problem  as it
applies to biomonitoring ot  the quality of natural waters has already
been stressed (Braginskiy 19bl).

     We used the biorhythmological approach  in studies of enzymatic
activity ot naturally occurring populations  ot moliusks exposed to  the
chronic eftect ot sewage from the  paper and  pulp industry.  It was  estab-
lished  that, in gastropod moliusks taken from different biohydrocenoses,
the curves of circadian activity of enzymes—esterases, alkaline  phospha-
tase, succinate, malate and  lactate dehydrogenases—differed.  Depending
on  the  role of the tested enzymatic systems, we  observed prevalence ot
"diurnal" or "nocturnal" activity.

     To compare these data in moliusks taken from different sections of
the reservoir, we calculated the  "parameter  of circadian adaptability"
(.PCAJ for each enzyme.  We found that PGA was positive for virtually all
enzymes in moliusks inhabiting a conditionally pure zone.  In moliusks
taken from a part ot the reservoir subject to the chronic effect  ot sew-
age, PGA was negative tor ail enzymes.  Moliusks living in zones  differ-
ing in  degree of pollution diltered not only in  biorhythms ot enzymatic
activity, but response to an additional  burden— brief change in  tempera-
ture.   Thus, with exposure to change in temperature, the moliusks ot the
"conditionally pure zone" showed some decline in enzyme activity, while
the nature or the circadian rhythm did not change appreciably.  In  mol-
iusks from the zone subject  to the ettect ot sewage, the circadian  rhythms
of all  enzymes studied changed appreciably,  and  their  activity dropped
drastically.  Moreover, we observed much taster  restoration ot initial
rhythms in moliusks 01 the control zone than those exposed to the influ-
ence ot sewage.

-------
     Thus, it should be concluded that organization ot the circadian rhythm
ot enzyme activity in naturally occurring populations ot mollusks can be
used as a characteristic ot functional state of an organism, its capacity
for adaptation under altered physicochemical environmental conditions, as
well as extent ot effect of environmental factors.  Apparently, consid-
ering the significant fluctuations of hydrobionts1 biochemical parameters,
which are a typical feature and reflect adaptation to the aquatic environ-
ment, the biorhythmological approach can be recommended tor studies on
ditterent levels ot organization—cellular, tissular, organic, organism,
population, etc.

     At the present stage ot development of scientific methodological
procedures for evaluating the ecological status ot the naturally occurring
water environment, an integrated approach is needed for analysis of suit-
ability of physiological and biochemical parameters tor biomonitoring of
surface waters.  It should be noted that most ot the methods based on
physiological and biochemical parameters are reterable to biological tests,
and they were developed primarily to assess the toxicity of sewage or
chemical compounds (when setting maximum permissible concentrations).
Trial ot these methods in naturally occurring waters requires concurrent
investigation not only ot hydrobiological parameters characterizing the
structure ot the water ecosystem, but ot hydrologicai-hydrochemical para-
meters.  The latter is particularly necessary when investigating physio-
logical and biochemical parameters on the level of populations and aquatic
communities, due to the complexity and diversity ot links between both
individual trophic levels and between the biota and environment, as well
as the very dynamic nature of these links.

     Viewing enzymatic activity as a function of interaction ot an organism
with the environment, which changes in the time parameter of development
of the ecosystem and trophodynamic processes, we analyzed the informative-
ness of enzymatic parameters ot naturally occurring seston communities in
waters subject to natural eutrophication and anthropogenic influences.  In
these studies we used the following parameters:  species composition, total
number and biomass ot bacterioplankton, phytopiankton and zooplankton,
intensity of production and destruction processes, activity ot alkaline
phosphatase and total esterases ot seston, levels ot biogenous elements
(total, nitrate, and nitrite nitrogen, ammonia nitrogen, total and mineral
phosphorus), and levels of oxygen, hydrocarbonates and pH.

     it was established that the absolute levels ot enzyme activity are low
in an aquatic ecosystem that is not exposed to any signiticant anthopogenic
ractors, while potential activity (Ap) is 3 to 5 times higher than the
level observed (Ao).  Distinct seasonal dynamics ot changes in enzyme activ-
ity can be observed.  In situations related to drastic changes in environ-
mental conditions (pollution, algal "blooming," etc.), absolute enzyme
activity levels rise and there is change in seasonal cycle ot enzyme activi-
ty, as well as in Ap^.  Determination was made of the range ot fluctua-
tions ol enzyme activity during the period of blooming ot blue-green algae
with exposure to sewage trom the paper and^pulp industry, as well as with
salt pollution.  It was shown that the reaction of seston with regard to
enzyme activity during natural eutrophication ot the reservoir is described

                                     1 n/l

-------
by a curve that is synchronized with the developmental  phases  of  bacteria
and algae, as well as changes  in  proportion  of  biogenous  elements contained
in the environment.  With decline of mineral phosphorus level  in  water,
there is increase in esterase  activity  ana the  enzyme activity ratio  (es-
terase;alkaline phosphatase) increases  by a factor of 10.  In  the case of
anthropogenic influences, enzyme  activity of seston  increases  drastically,
which mak.es it possible to differentiate water  zones in the region of waste
dumping according to extent of pollution.

     In conclusion, we should  like to emphasize that there are several
tasks that are of prime importance in the problem of biomonitoring »t
natural waters.  As a result of hydrobiological observations pursued in
the system of state supervision,  information for a period of many years
has been accumulated.  This information is presently being systematized in
order to find the parameters that reflect the basic  trends of  change,
mainly in structural organization of aquatic communities  as a  function of
extent and nature of anthropogenic burden on a  reservoir's ecosystem as a
whole.

     Analysis of the accumulated  information, with consideration  of re-
sults of scientific studies dealing with biomonitoring of natural waters,
including functional parameters, will enable us to undertake development
of the methodology for assessing  the ecological status of water systems
and developing the optimum variant of routine and efficient biomonitor-
ing.

     Introduction of new methods, which permit  evaluation of functional
changes in the ecosystem of a  body of water, offers  vast  opportunities
for both efficient monitoring  and forecasting the state of the ecosystem
and water quality.  Unification and standardization  of  both approaches
and procedures, as well as methods as a whole,  is a mandatory  prerequisite
tor successful use of these methods.
                                BIBLIOGRAPHY

Anon.  19b3.  Rukovodstvo po metodam  gidrobioiogicheskogo  analiza  pover-
    khnostnykh vod i donnykh otiozheniy (Manual or Methods for Hydrobiologi-
    cal Analysis of Surface Waters  and Bottom Deposits).   Leningrad, USSR.
    239 p.

Braginskiy, L.P.  l9bl.  Theoretical  aspects  of the problem  of normal and
    pathology in aquatic ecotoxicology.   In Teoreticheskiye  voprosy vodnoy
    toksikologii (.Theoretical Problems of Aquatic Toxicology).  Leningrad,
    USSR.  pp. 29-40.

Fedorov, V.D.  1979.  0 metodakh izucheniya fitoplanktona  i  yego aktivnosti
    (.Methods of Studying Phytoplankton and Its Activity).  Moscow, USSR.
    Ibb p.

Israel", Yu.A.  1983.  Ekologiya i  kontrol" sostoyaniya prirodnoy  sredy
    (Ecology and Inspection of  the  Environment).  Leningrad, USSR.  376 p.

-------
Odum, J.  1975.  Fundamentals o± ecology.  Moscow, USSR.  740 p.

Pearl, H.W. and C.R. Goldman.  1972.  Heterotrophic assays in the detec-
    tion of water masses of Lake Tahoe, California.  Limnol. and Oceanogr.
    I7(l):145-14tt.

Pursons, T.R., M. Tachakashi, and B. Chargrive.  19tt2.  Biological ocean-
    ography.  Moscow, USSR.  432 p.

Sirenko, A.A.  19fc>3.  Curve of vertical distribution of chriorophyll in
    a body of water as an indicator tor integral evaluation of correlation
    between production and destruction processes.  In Obobshchennyye
    pokazateli kachestva vod—83.  Prakticheskiye voproshy biotestirovaniya
    i bioindikatsii.  Tezisy doki.  (Summaries of Papers Delivered on
    Overall Indicators of water Quality—1963.  Practical Problems of
    Biological Testing and Biological Monitoring).  Chernogolovka, USSR.
    pp. 124-126.

Spenser, M.J.  197b.  The trophic status of 21 lakes of Mountain Province
    in New Zealand.  N.Z. Mar. and Freshwater Res.  12(4):415-427.

Vernichenko, A.A. and N.V. Starko.  19b2.  Prospects of using functional
    indicators in the system of monitoring aquatic ecosystems.  In
    Kontrol' kachestva prirodnykh i stochnykh vod (Monitoring Quality of
    Natural and Run-Off Waters).  Kharkov, USSR.  pp.  14-20.

Wright, R.T. and J.G.  Hobble.  1966.  Use of  glucose and acetate by bac-
    teria and algae in aquatic ecosystems.  Ecology.  47(3):447-464.

Zhukinskiy, V.N., O.P-  Oksiyuk,  G.N. Oleynik,  and S.I.  Kosheleva.   1978.
    Plan tor a system of integral evaluation fo quality of  surface waters,
    Vodnyye Resursy.   (.3):83~93.
                                    106

-------
              LONG RANGE TRANSPORT OF TOXIC ORGANIC CONTAMINANTS
                       TO THE NORTH AMERICAN GREAT LAKES
                                     by

                                       rain1
                                            2
W.R. Swain1
                                 M.D.  Mullin
                                J.C.  Filkins2
                                  ABSTRACT

      Studies of persistent organic contaminants made for the Upper Lakes
Reference Group of the International Joint Commission in 1974-1976 indicated
increased levels of organic contamination in the flesh of fish taken from the
vicinity of Isle Royale in Lake Superior.  These findings led to a prelimin-
ary study of polychlorinated biphenyl (PCB) compounds in atmospheric precipi-
tation deposited in Siskiwit Lake on Isle Royale.

      The subsequent studies reported here support the earlier findings but
show  significant shifts in observed concentrations.  Initially, these alter-
ed values were thought to be the result of increasing environmental concen-
trations of PCBs.  The use of refined analytical procedures suggests, however,
that the apparent changes are a function of the co-occurrence of derivatives
of the pesticide Toxaphene within the analytical spectrum of the PCB frac-
tion.  A comparison of the older data from Siskiwit Lake with those acquired
from contemporary analytical procedures suggests that it is likely that^de-
rivatives of Toxaphene may have been enumerated with PCB peaks, thus being
inadvertently reported as total PCB.  Based on results obtained with high
resolution capillary chromatography, apparent increases in concentrations of
PCB compounds in 1980 packed column chromatography  samples are undoubtedly  a
function of historic analytical limitation, rather  than an absolute change  in
environmental concentrations of the PCB compounds.

      This paper has been reviewed  in accordance with the U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency's peer and administrative review  policies and approved for
presentation and publication.
 l-Vakgroep  Aquatische Oecologie,  Universiteit van Amsterdam, Kruislaan 320,
  1098  SM Amsterdam,  The Netherlands
 2Large Lakes Research Station,  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Grosse
  He,  Michigan 48138 USA
                                     107

-------
                               INTRODUCTION

       In  1974, studies of the accumulation of  selected  persistent organic
 residues  in the fish species of the Lake  Superior  ecosystem were initiated
 under  the auspices of the International Joint  Commission's  Upper Lakes Refer-
 ence Group.  The findings of these studies indicated  substantially increased
 levels of halogenated organic substances  in Lake Superior fish near Isle Royal,
 particularly in lean lake trout, Salvelinus namaycush,  and  in fat lake trout,
 Salvelinus namaycush siscowet.

       As  a check on contaminant levels in Lake Superior fish,  a control site,
 Siskiwit  Lake on Isle Royale, was established.  This  deep,  cold,  oligotrophic
 lake contained indigenous species of fish similar  to  those  in Lake Superior,
 allowing  direct comparison.  The island,  and hence the  lake, was remote from
 inhabited areas, thus being well removed  from  the  industrial and cultural
 influences of man's activities.  Surprisingly,  however, the values for several
 organic contaminants in the flesh of fish from Siskiwit Lake were significant-
 ly  higher than corresponding values in fish from Lake Superior.   Polychlorin-
 ated biphenyl  (PCS) compounds were nearly double the  Lake Superior mean value,
 and p,p-DDE showed a more than 10-fold increase in Siskiwit Lake.   These find-
 ings led  to a preliminary study of the transport of PCB compounds in atmos-
 pheric precipitation.  For a more complete summary of this  work,  the reader
 is  referred to Swain (1978).

       The present study was undertaken as a continuation of the earlier effort,
 with particular interest in the changes in residue levels in ttje fish popula-
 tion of this landlocked, remote island lake.

                            GEOGRAPHICAL  SETTING

       Isle Royale is a rock-strewn conglomerate of a central island mass with'
 associated irregular reefs.  It lies 27.4 km from  the closest  shoreward mar-
 gin of Lake Superior at Thunder Cape, Ontario,  but it is more than 50 km
 to  Thunder Bay, Ontario, the nearest major population center (Figure 1).


       Isle Royale (Figure 2) has an extreme length of 70.8  km,  lying on a
 southwest-northeast axis.  Its maximum width,  14.5 km,  occurs  near the southwest
 end of the island.  The highest point in  the island is  Mount Desor, 242 m
 above  Lake Superior.  The entire island structure,  including its associated
 reefs  and islets, constitutes Isle Royale National Park, established in 1940.
 Efforts from that date have been made to  preserve  the island's  native wilder-
 ness character.  As a result, the only means of access  from one part of the
 island to another is by means of foot trails.   Siskiwit Lake,  accessible only
 in  this fashion, provided a remote aquatic ecosystem  relatively undisturbed
 by  human  activity.

       Siskiwit Lake lies 0.6 km inland from Lake Superior in a depression of
Precambrian Middle Keweenawan flow of the Portage Lakes Volcanics.   The entire
 watershed of the lake also lies in bedrock of  this type.  The long axis of
 Siskiwit  lake follows the same direction  as the long  axis of Isle Royale,
 i.e., northeast-southwest.


                                     10Q

-------
48* -
46°
     _L
                          90-
                                                           88*
                                                                                  1
                                                                        SAULTSTE. MARIE.
                                                                          ONTARIO
                 10O KILOMETERS
                                                                   SAULTSTE. MAHIE.
                                                                     MICHIGAN
             _1_
                                                                                     49»
                                                                                    47°
             91°               89°               87°

 Figure 1.  Geographic  area  of study in Lake Superior.
                                                              85"
         The  length  of  Siskiwit Lake is 11.10 km, the maximum breadth is 2.25 km,
    and  the mean breadth is  1.40 km (Huber, 1975).  The lake area is 15.6 km ,
    exclusive  of islands.   Shoreline development, calculated from the expression
    D  = L/A  ,  is  typical  of subcircular eliptiform lakes, having a value of 2.66.
    Trie  elevation  of  Siskiwit Lake above the mean Lake Superior level is 17.37 m,
    indicating no  direct input from Superior to Siskiwit Lake.  Siskiwit Lake
    drains by  a single  small stream to Lake Superior, the Siskiwit River.  The
    maximum depth  of  Siskiwit Lake is 36.58 m.

                                     METHODOLOGY

          Sample  collection from the remote sites at  Siskiwit  Lake were  made in 1980
    from a  canoe  that was portaged to the  site from  the  Superior  shoreline.   Fish
    samples were  taken by means of a 350-foot  (106.68 m)  section  of  5.72-cm gill net
    that was  backpacked into Siskiwit Lake and set overnight  at a depth  of  24.4 to
    46.5 m  at  the  location shown in Figure 2.  For all collections,  the  catch was
    exclusively lake  trout (Salvelinus namaycush), whitefish  (Coregonus  culpeafor-
    mis),  and  bowfin  (Amia calva).  In each case, only lake trout and  whitefish
    were retained, carried out in a clean mesh bag,  eviscerated,  iced,  and  after
    transport  to  a populated area, immediately frozen in dry  ice  for transport to
    the  laboratory.

         Snow samples  were  taken from the undisturbed surface of the  lake  and were
    transported to the  laboratory in sealed teflon containers.  Because  of  prevail-
    ing  ambient temperatures, further refrigeration was not necessary.
                                          109

-------
                                                                                          — ta-20
                                                                     LEGEND
                                                                     o Fish Sample  *
                                                                     • Water Sample
                                                                       Snow Sample
           89° IS'
                                earoo-
                                                                            88-301
Figure 2.  Location  of sampling sites  for fish,  water,  and snow in the vicinity
            Siskiwit  Lake, Isle Royale.
of

-------
      Samples of atmospheric precipitation in the Lake Huron area were taken
using both event samplers and bulk collectors lined with thin teflon bags.
These bags were suspended within the frame of the bulk collector in such a
manner as to minimize evaporation losses from the collected sample.  In all but
one case, samples were taken from the Michigan side of Lake Huron.  The single
exception was" an August sample taken from the Canadian shore line of Lake
Huron below the Bruce Peninsula.

ANALYTICAL PROCEDURES

     In an effort to minimize analytical error, samples of fish were submitted
to three separate laboratories for analysis.   These analytical efforts includ-
ed the Columbia National Fisheries Laboratory of the U.S. Fish and Wildlife
Service at Columbia, Missouri; the Cranbrook Institute of Sciences at Bloom-
field -Hills, Michigan, and the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's Large
Lakes Research Station at Grosse He, Michigan.

      Initial packed column gas chromatography studies followed accepted analy-
tical procedure.  A detailed description is presented by Swain  (1978).  When it
became apparent that PCB congeners were co-occurring with compounds of Toxa-
phene, however, subsequent analytical efforts utilized high resolution capillary
column chromatography.  The procedures associated with this type of analysis
are summarized below.

      High resolution fused silica capillary gas chromatography was performed
on a VARIAN Model 3700 gas chromatograph equipped with a "%I electron capture
detector.  A 50-m fused silica column (0.2 mm i.d.) coated with SE-54 (Hewlett-
Packard) was used to separate the PCB congeners and the Toxaphene-like com-
pounds.  The oven temperature was programmed at a rate of 1.0 °C min   from
100 to 240 °C.  The injector and detector temperatures were 270 and 330 °C,
respectively.  Sample volume, 6.0 yl, was injected by using an automatic sam-
pler with splitting in the injector (10:1 split ratio, vented from 0.75 to
1.75 min.)  The hydrogen carrier gas was held at a constant pressure of 2.25
kg cm~2 to give the optimized velocity (y) at 100 °C of 45 cm s~ .

ANALYSIS

     The interpretation .of the chromatograms was complicated by the presence,
in all samples, of PCBs as well as the polychlorinated camphene (Toxaphene-
like) components.  The high resolution chromatography used permitted the eval-
uation of both groups of compounds together without additional separation pro-
cedures.  There were more than 110 peaks in the PCB reference standard and 39
of the larger peaks in technical Toxaphene were used in the Toxaphene refer-
ence standard.  Of these approximately 150 different compounds, only about a
dozen co-eluted and, of this number, fewer than six were significant.  Where
co-eluting compounds existed, the following procedure was used:  if other PCB
peaks in the same time portion of the chromatogram were present and other
Toxaphene-like peaks were absent, the peak in question was assumed to be a
PCB; conversely, if other PCB peaks in the same time portion of the chromato-
gram were absent and other Toxaphene-like peaks were present, then the peak  in
question was assumed to be a Toxaphene-like compound;  if both PCB and Toxa-
phene-like peaks were present, then the peak was excluded from both the PCB
and Toxaphene-like calculations.
                                     Ill

-------
      PCB data were determined by comparing the relative retention times  (RRT)
of the individual peaks (octachloronaphthalene as internal standard = 1.000)
in the chromatogram to those generated by a mixture of Aroclors 1016, 1254 and
1260.  If the RRT were within a narrow window of ca 0.0004 RRT units and  the
height of the peak was proportionate to other PCB peaks in the same time  por-
tion of the chromatogram,  then the PCB assignment was made and the amount cal-
culated was based on a comparison of the height of the peak in the standard
for which the concentration was known) to the height of the peak in the sample.

      Toxaphene-like data were calculated differently because of the lack of
individual compound standards against which to compare the sample.  The 39
peaks in the Toxaphene reference standard all were assigned the same value—
the total concentration of the Toxaphene standard—and relative response
factors (RRF) for each peak were calculated.  Summing these concentrations and
dividing by the number of peaks yields the concentration of the solution.
Toxaphene-like compounds from the samples were determined in a similar man-
ner.  After making qualitative assignments based on the same +/- 0.0004 RRT
units exclusion window as used in the PCB determination and comparing the
peak height to other Toxaphene-like peaks in the same time portion of the
chromatogram to ensure that they were proportionate to the same peaks in  the
standard, a concentration was calculated for each peak by comparing its height
to the height of the same peak in the standard.  These concentrations were
summed and the sum divided by the number of Toxaphene-like peaks identified in
the sample.  If fewer than 20 peaks were identified, then the qualitative iden-
tification of the peaks as Toxaphene-like was uncertain and reported as ques-
tionable.

      It should be noted that at the time of preparation of this report, the
precise identification of Toxaphene in biologic tissue is still a matter of
some analytical discussion.  While two laboratories participating in the ana-
lytical portion of this study unhesitatingly refer to the material observed as
"Toxaphene", a third group is concerned that all of the peaks observed are not
entirely co-incidental with pure standards of Toxaphene.  This group observes
that the sample appears to be "environmentally weathered" as a result of passage
through biologic systems.   It is their opinion that the substances should be
labeled  as "chlorinated turpines/camphenes" or as "Toxaphene-like" compounds,
suggesting this analytical uncertainty.  The latter, more conservative approach
has been used for this report.

                            RESULTS AND DISCUSSION

      In 1976, a series of four fresh snow samples  was  collected, melted, ex-
tracted, and analyzed from the Isle Royale site (Figure 2).  PCB compounds
were expressed as an aggregate of Aroclor 1254, the reference mixture  that
Veith et al. (1977) reported as most resembling mixtures observed in Lake
Superior.  This Aroclor mixture was used as an index of airborne movements of
persistent organic compounds, and the levels observed at Siskiwit Lake were
compared with values at Duluth, Minnesota.  The mean value for PCB compounds
observed in precipitation samples from the Duluth, Minnesota, metropolitan
area was 50.0 ng/1, whereas the mean value from Siskiwit Lake was nearly  five
times greater, 230.0 ng/1 (Swain, 1978).  Similar results were reported by
Murphy (1976) and by Murphy and Rzeszutko (1978) in the Lake Michigan area,


                                     112

-------
comparing precipitation in Chicago, Illinois, against that of Beaver Island in
Northern Lake, Michigan.

      Strachan and Huneault  (1979), working in the Province of Ontario adjacent
to the Great Lakes found 86 percent of 50 rain samples to contain an average of
21 ng/1 PCB, with an.observed maximum of 120 ng/1 PCB.  These workers found an
average of 26 ng/1 in 14 rainfall samples adjacent to Lake Superior and a mean
of 38 ng/1 in 4 samples of snow from the Lake Superior area.  In their later
summary of airborne contaminants to the Great Lakes ecosystem, Eisenreich et
al. (1981) report a range of 10 to 100 ng/1 PCB in precipitation over the
Great Lakes with an average content of 30 ng/1.  These workers project total
annual PCB deposition of airborne trace organic compounds to Lake Superior at
9.8 metric tons per annum (MTA), 6.9 MTA for Lake Michigan, 7.2 MTA for Lake
Huron, 3.1 MTA for Lake Erie, and 2.3 MTA for Lake Ontario.

      All of these studies suggested continuing inputs of PCBs to the Great
Lakes ecosystem via the atmosphere, even though usage of these materials in
North America was drastically curtailed in the early 1970s.  For this reason,
it was thought that sampling of the remote Siskiwit Lake site should be con-
tinued because the only source of contaminants to this system is apparently
the atmosphere.  Lake trout from Siskiwit Lake were selected for this study
because of their well known predisposition to accumulate contaminants and
because these fish occur both in Siskiwit Lake and in the upper Great Lakes,
thus enabling direct comparison.  Further, continued use of this species would
permit extension of previous data from the lake and reflect changes in levels
of contamination with time.

      In the 1976 data set (Swain, 1978), a single composite of two lake trout
was reported.  These fish averaged 54.5 cm in body length, weighed an average
of 1.6 kg, and contained 3.5 percent lipid.  Two additional unreported compos-
ites of two lake trout each—1.5 kg and 1.7 kg average weight, and.3.2 and 3.8
percent lipid, respectively—contained 0.9 and 1.3 mg/kg PCB on a wet weight
basis.

      For comparison with these data, 18 lake trout were taken in 1980 and
assigned to five composites as indicated in Table 1.  These composites were
forwarded to three participating laboratories with a request to run standard
packed column gas chromatography analysis for PCBs with methods analogous and
comparable with those used in the 1976 study.  Laboratory 1 reported individu-
al values for each of the five composites.  These values were 3.26, 2.27, 1.57,
1.22, and 2.17 mg/kg PCB on a wet weight basis for composites 1 through 5,
respectively.  The reported mean value was 2.1 mg/kg PCB.  Laboratories 2 and
3 homogenized the five individual composite samples and performed the analysis
on a single grand composite of 18 fish.  Laboratory 2 reported an observed level
of 3.85 mg/kg PCB, and Laboratory 3 reported 4.3 mg/kg PCB.  This yielded an
average value of 3.42 mg/kg PCB for the analysis of the three laboratories.
Although there was a rather large range between the three laboratories, both
the individual values reported and the mean of the analyses were substantially
higher than the average of 1.13 mg/kg observed in 1976.

      Because of the individual variation among laboratories and because of
the availability of newer, more sensitive methodologies, a blind duplicate

                                     113

-------
         TABLE  1.   CHARACTERISTICS  OF  LAKE  TROUT FROM SISKIWIT LAKE,
                   ISLE ROYALE  (LAKE SUPERIOR),  1980


Composite
sample
1
2
3
4
5
Sample
mean
Fish
per
composite
1
4
4
5
4
3.6




Length (cm)
Min.
71.0
54.0
54.0
35.0
52.0
53.2

Max.
71.0
58.0
58.0
53.0
57.0
59.4

Avg.
71.0
55.8
55.0
46.2
53.2
56.24

Avg.
weight
(kg)
4.682
1.784
1.598
1.045
1.412
2.104


Percent
lipid
10.41
9.82
5.85
9.06
7.20
8.486

sample was submitted to each of the three laboratories with a request for anal-
ysis of the identical material using high resolution capillary column gas
chromatography.  The results, shown in Table 2, were surprising.  Not only
were the analyses in excellent agreement, but the mean of the analyses was
well below the levels observed on Siskiwit Lake in 1976, and nearly five times
lower than the packed column analyses.

      To verify these results, the five Siskiwit Lake lake trout were reanalyzed
as individual composites, and in addition, two fillets of lake trout were includ-
ed from outer Saginaw Bay in Lake Huron.   A 1.16-kg fillet was submitted taken
from a 62-dm male lake trout containing 13.7 percent lipid, and the second was
a 1.9-kg fillet containing 12.5 percent lipid taken from a 75-cm female lake
trout.  The results of the comparative analyses are shown in Table 3.  In all
cases, the values determined by packed column chromatography exceeded those
observed with high resolution capillary column chromatography by an average
of more than three times.
               TABLE 2.  ANALYSIS OF PCB IN SISKIWIT LAKE COM-
                         POSITE LAKE TROUT SAMPLES BY PACKED
                         COLUMN AS COMPARED WITH HIGH RESOLU-
                         TION CAPILLARY COLUMN GAS CHROMATOG-
                         RAPHY
                                Sample means   Sample means
                                  total PCB     total PCB
                 Laboratory    packed column  capillary column
               identification	(mg/kg)	(mg/kg)	

                     1              2.10           0.70

                     2              3.85           0.72

                     3              4.30           0.70
                                     114

-------
         TABLE 3.  ANALYSIS OF  PCB  BY  PACKED  COLUMN AS  COMPARED  WITH
                   HIGH RESOLUTION  CAPILLARY  COLUMN GAS CHROMATOGRAPHY

                                    Sample  means      Sample  means
                                     total  PCB         total PCB
                                    packed  column   capillary column
                 Sample                 (mg/kg)          (mg/kg)
Lake trout fillet, male
Saginaw Bay-Lake Huron
Lake trout fillet, female
Saginaw Bay-Lake Huron
Lake trout-Siskiwit Lake
composite number 1
Lake trout-Siskiwit Lake
composite number 2
Lake trout-Siskiwit Lake
composite number 3
Lake trout-Siskiwit Lake
composite number 4
Lake trout-Siskiwit Lake
composite number 5
11.08
5.16
3.26
2.27
1.57
1.22
2.17
5.70
2.30
1.35
0.91
0.57
0.35
0.41*
0.39*
          Sample means                   3.82             1.5

           *Duplicate analysis.

      To answer the obvious question of the reason for the differences,  an
intense study of the individual chromatograms was made.  It quickly became
apparent that a number of non-PCB peaks co-eluted in the same portion of the
gas chromatographic spectrum as the PCB congeners.  Careful resolution and sep-
aration with capillary column chromatography and comparison with known stan-
dards revealed that these additional peaks were derived from chlorinated tur-
pine/camphene products characteristic of technical Toxaphene.  Although, as
noted previously, it was not possible to match all peaks with pure standards
of Toxaphene because of biologic "weathering" of environmental samples,  a con-
sistent match of more than 20 peaks was normally achieved.

      Aliquots of the same samples reported in Table 3 were reanalyzed against
Toxaphene reference standards.  The results of this effort are reported in
Table 4.  In all cases, the absolute quantities of Toxaphene-like materials
exceeded the levels of PCBs observed by a considerable margin; an average dif-
ference of more than 5-fold was seen.  A relatively consistent ratio of Toxa-
phene-like compounds to PCB congeners was observed.  Only in one case, compos-
ite number 4, did this ratio become excessively large.  In this case, the
ratio observed was nearly double the mean of the other samples  (10.6 as compar-
ed with 5.42).

      For comparison with the values observed in lake  trout, two water  samples
were taken at 1 meter of depth at the site  on Siskiwit Lake indicated  in Figure
2.  Two additional samples were taken in Lake Superior form  the 50-meter  strata
of water approximately 5 km southwest of Menagerie Light on  Siskiwit Bay  of

                                      115

-------
  TABLE 4.   PCB AND TOXAPHENE-LIKE COMPOUNDS (TOX) OBSERVED IN LAKE TROUT




Sample location
Fillet, Saginaw
Lake Huron
Fillet, Saginaw
Lake Huron
Siskiwit Lake
composite ho.
Siskiwit Lake
composite no.
Siskiwit Lake
composite no.
Siskiwit Lake
composite no.
Siskiwit Lake
composite no.




Bay

Bay


1

2

3

4

5

Total
PCB
(mg/kg)
5.7

2.3

1.35

0.91

0.57

0.35

0.41*
0.39*
Number
of peaks
utilized
for PCB
26

26

25

25

25

25

25
25

Total
TOX
(mg/kg)
25.84

12.05

6.37

5.14

3.01

3.71

2.57
2.45
Number
of peaks
utilized
for TOX
28

29

31

28

39

27

30
30


Ratio .
TOX: PCB
4.53

5.24

4.72

5.65

5.28

10.6

6.27
6.28
    Sample means
1.49
25.25
7.64
29
6.07
    *Duplicate analysis.

Isle Royale.   The means of these samples are compared in Table 5 with the aver-
age values of samples collected in Lake Huron by staff of the Cranbrook Institute
of Science, and jointly analyzed by this group and the second author.  Again,  a
consistent ratio  of Toxaphene-like material to PCB congeners was observed for
all samples except  those of Siskiwit Lake.   Apparently because of its relative
size,  state of oligotrophy,  and the relatively higher inputs of PCBs received,
the ratio in this lake was reduced to 1.72,  as compared with an average of 3.45
for the other analyses.

      To assess the quantity of PCB compounds in atmospheric precipitation, a
series of bulk collectors and event samplers had been set out along the Lake
Huron shoreline at Hoeft  State Park, Michigan, Sturgeon Point, Michigan, and
Tawas State Park, Michigan.   Additionally, one confirmatory station was estab-
lished on the Canadian shoreline of Lake Huron below the Bruce Peninsula, and
one station was established below Lake Huron at Grosse lie, Michigan.  When
the results of the studies of lake water and lake trout became available, the
precipitation samples were also analyzed for PCB and Toxaphene-like compounds.

      The results of these analyses are shown in Table 6.  Again in every case,
the values observed for the Toxaphene-like substances exceeded those observed
for PCBs.  The mean of the ratios observed for all bulk precipitation samples,
by far the majority of the data, was 3.24, which compares well with  the mean
ratio found for open Lake Huron water, 3.51, and with that of Lake Superior,
3.16.  As was previously noted, the data points that are derived  from peaks
of Toxaphene-like substances of less than 20 in number should be  regarded  with
                                     116

-------
caution.   Although the data have been included for continuity, four such points
exist in the data set—one from Hoeft State Park, two from Sturgeon Point, and
one from the Tawas State Park sampling station.  At best, the values for the
Toxaphene-like substances associated with these samples should be regarded as
a qualitative estimation of the amount of these substances present.

      Although these data are currently being more completely Analyzed, it is
apparent that Toxaphene-like components make up a currently significant portion
of the contaminant burden of Upper Great Lakes water, fish, and precipitation
inputs.  It may even be necessary  to  reconsider  some  of the historic data on
PCBs in the Great Lakes in light of this new  information  to evaluate' the pos-
sible positive interference of Toxaphene-like  compounds in the analysis of
these samples.

      In keeping with  the original purpose of  this sequence of studies, a com-
parison of several other 1980 pesticide levels in lake trout  from Siskiwit Lake
also was made with the earlier data.  The results of  the  associated analyses
are  shown in Table 7.  In all cases for which  comparative data were available,
significant reductions in levels of pesticides were observed.  Compounds show-
ing  such declines included the alpha  isomer of benzenehexachloride   (BHC, also
known as hexachlorocyclohexane), heptachlor epoxide,  p,p'-DDE, and p-p'-DDD. A
group of new materials also was observed among which  were the gamma isomer of
BHC  (also known as hexachlorocyclohexane, or Lindane), Toxaphene-like  compounds,
and  the family of substances related  to chlordane, including oxychlordane, trans-
chlordane, cis-chlordane, and cis-nonachlor.

      Finally, using a 1-kg homogenate of the  18 lake trout comprising composites
1  through 5 of Tables  1 through 4, negative ionization mass spectroscopy analy-
ses were made for polychlorinated  dibenzo-_p_-dioxins  (PCDDs) and polychlorinated
dibenzofurans (PCDFs).  The results of these  analyses are shown in Table 8.
       TABLE 5.   MEAN  VALUES OF ANALYSES OF PCS AND TOXAPHENE-LIKE COM-
                 POUNDS (TOX) IN SELECTED WATER SAMPLES


                                               Numbers of
                              Total    Total    peaks in
                               PCB      TOX       TOX         Ratio
           Location	   (ng/1)   (ng/1)    analysis     PCB: TOX
       Lake Huron
         Southern Lake Huron   0.39     1.50       42          3.85
         Middle Lake Huron     0.46     2.14       39          4.65
         Northern Lake Huron   0.28     1.23       35          4.39
         North Channel        0.77     1.60       25          2.08
         Georgian Bay          0.57     1.48       36          2.60

       Lake Superior           0.31     0.98       38         3.16
         Adjacent to Isle
         Royale

       Siskiwit Lake,  Isle     1.28     2.2        37         1.72
         Royale
                                      117

-------
 TABLE 6.   PCS  AND  TOXAPHENE-LIKE  COMPOUNDS  (TOX)  OBSERVED IN SAMPLES-
           EVENT AND  BULK  PRECIPITATION,  LAKE HURON

Location
Hoeft State
Park
sampling
station



Sturgeon
Point
sampling
station








Canadian
shore
station
Grosse lie
sampling
station
Tawas State
Park
sampling
station


Mean of all
samples
Month Sample
sample volume
taken (1)
1
2
6
8
9
10
12
1
2
5
6
6*
7
8
8*
9
10
10*
11
8


6
8
10
6
8
9
10
11
12


12.65
5.86
11.76
15.25
36.05
9.85
12.10
5.53
7.83
31.05
30.20
5.65
30.44
30.91
5.79
36.75
9.00
1.65
18.30
45.72


28.36
83.73
10.44
24.72
24.29
42.15
12.26
24.24
7.40
21.39

Number of
Total peaks in
PCB PCB
(ng/1) analysis
7.7
11.1
19.9
1.8
2.7
22.9
108.0
87.0
6.9
4.3
7.3
8.6
1.4
2.2
21.0
7.6
19.9
31.6
9.2
2.6


5.0
8.1
22.9
8.5
3.5
5.3
30.0
4.9
46.0
17.9

28
60
40
40
60
49
71
65
54
40
47
59
36
37
42
40
54
65
41
35


43
56
46
42
42
47
51
38
62
47.9

Number of
Total peaks in
TOX TOX Ratio
(ng/1) analysis TOX: PCB
36.3
21.0
55.9
14.5
5.0
51.4
112.0
99.0
16.7
17.7
13.1
17.8
5.58
14.6
37.0
16.3
51.5
40.4
21.3
26.7


16.2
18.9
74.2
15.6
19.9
11.7
52.1
9.7
80.0
33.5

15
31
26
38
31
32
26
22
25
23
19
38
33
34
41
34
15
29
28
22


39
39
32
37
49
36
17
30
21
29.7

4.73
1.88
2.80
8.13
1.89
2.24
1.03
1.14
2.42
4.11
1.79
2.07
3.96
6.59
1.75
2.15
2.59
1.28
2.32
10.38


3.26
2.35
3.24
1.84
5.73
2.21
1.74
1.99
1.74
3.08

Mean of bulk
  precip. samp,

Mean of event
  precip. samp.
23.36   17.5     47.1
 4.36   20.4     55.3
33.7
29.0
31.73   36.0
3.24
                                            1.7
 *Event samples,
                                   118

-------
         TABLE  7-   COMPARISON  OF  RESIDUE-FORMING ORGANIC SUBSTANCES
                    OBSERVED  IN LAKE TROUT  (EVISCERATED WHOLE FISH)
                    FROM SISKIWIT  LAKE,  1974-1976 and 1980

                                            Concentration (ng/g, ppb)
Compound
aBHC
yBHC
HCB
Heptachlor epoxide
Oxychlordane
trans- chlordane
cis-chlordane
p,p'-DDE
p,p'-DDD
cis-Nonachlor
Toxaphene-like compounds
1974-76
11.0
-
5.0
8.0
-
-
-
2370.0
36.0
-
-
1980
3.5
1.5
-
5.2
5.3
8.8
24.4
318.0
25.0
25.0
3200.0
Trace amounts of the 7 and 8 chlorine substituted PCDDs were found,  but the
more toxic 4 chlorine substituted isomers were not observed, nor were the 5
and 6 chlorine substituted groups.  Four chlorine substituted PCDFs  made up
two-thirds of the total PCDFs found, the remaining one-third consisting of the
5 chlorine substituted compounds.  The concentration ratio (PCDFs/PCBs) x 10
yields a value of 21.4 when the high resolution capillary column PCB values
are used.  This ratio may be of particular significance when potential impacts
of PCBs on human health are considered.
                                  CONCLUSION

      The occurrence and distribution of selected persistent organochlorine
compounds has been studied in the Siskiwit Lake, Lake Superior, and Lake Huron
ecosystems.  Although the origins of the more ubiquitous PCB compounds are not
clear, historic use patterns of the pesticide Toxaphene suggest major mechan-
isms for long range transport of derivatives of this material to the Great
Lakes.  Traditionally, the vast majority of Toxaphene compounds have been used
in the deep South of the United States as an agricultural insecticide against
pests of cotton crops, specifically the cotton boll weevil Anthonomus grandis
(Coleoptera: Curculioninae).  Utilization patterns of Toxaphene in other areas
closer to the Great Lakes suggest that only in recent years has application of
this material been made as a herbicide, or as an insecticide in conjunction
with the cultivation of sunflower crops in the mid-western states.  Toxaphene
has never been registered or approved for use in Canada.  Because existing data
indicate Toxaphene-like components  in fish'of the upper Great Lakes as early
as 1974  (Swain and Glass, 1984), and because a loading  rate of more than a metric
ton per year would be required  to observe the burdens of these Toxaphene-like
materials in each of the Upper  Great Lakes, it is highly likely that the major-
ity of these components are derived from extremely long range  transport  (thous-
ands of kilometers) by way of the atmosphere from areas of major  utilization
in the southern United States.  Recent research  (Rice et al.,  1984), utilizing
air and precipitation samples,  and meteorological data, reached the same conclu-

                                     119

-------
sion,  i.e.,  that the probable source of the Toxaphene-like compounds observed
is from the  central-southern United States.
                               ACKNOWLEDGMENTS

      The authors wish to express their appreciation to the men and women of
Isle Royale Division of the National Park Service, U.S. Department of the
Interior  for their continued cooperation and assistance over the several years
of the project period.  The cooperative analytical assistance of Drs. Jim Petty,
David Stallings, Mike Ribick and Dick Schoettger of the Columbia National Fish-
eries Research Laboratory, U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, and Dr. Eliott Smith
of the Cranbrook Institute of Science is acknowledged with gratitude.

      The contributions of A.J."Rusty" Davis to the sampling program are re-
membered with appreciation.

      Ook aan Carolien Schamhardt,  secretaresse Vakgroep Aquatische  Oecologie,
Universiteit van Amsterdam,  die het manuscript heeft geprapareerd, hartelijk
bedankt.
  TABLE  8.  NEGATIVE IONIZATION MASS SPECTROSCOPY ANALYSIS  OF  EVISCERATED
            WHOLE LAKE TROUT FROM SISKIWIT LAKE  ( 1 kg  composite  of  18
  	fish taken in 1980)	

                                   Concentration (ng/kg, ppt)  by  number
                                       of chlorine substitutions
           Compound
                                 Total
   Chlorinated dibenzo-p-dioxins
     (Detection limit)

   Chlorinated dibenzofurans
     (Detection limit)
 ND     ND     ND    Tr.   Tr.   Trace
(1.0)   (1.0)   (2.0)  (2.0) (3.0)
 10       5    ND    ND    Tr.
(0.5)   (0.5)   (0.5)  (1.0) (1.0)
15
   Ratio of four chlorine PCDFs to  total    10:15  =  0.67
   Concentration ratio  (PCDFs/PCBs) X
             Packed  column PCBs
             High resolution  capillary
               column  PCBs
         (15/4.3) X 106 = 3.5
         (15/0.7) X 106 = 21.4
                                      126

-------
                                 REFERENCES

Eisenreich, S.J., B.B. Looney, and J.D. Thornton.  1981.  Airborne organic
    contaminants in the Great Lakes ecosystem.  Environmental Science and
    Technology 15:30-38.

Huber, T.J. 1975.  The geologic story of Isle Royale National Park.  Geological
    Survey Bulletin 1309:1-66.

Murphy, T.J.  1976.  Polychlorobiphenyls in the Atmosphere and in Precipitation
    in the Lake Michigan Basin.  Interim Report to the U.S. Environmental Pro-
    tection Agency, March 17, 1976.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
    Grosse lie, Michigan.  pp. 1-4  (Typescript).

Murphy, T.J., and  C.P. Rzeszutko.   1977.  Precipitation  inputs of PCBs  to Lake
    Michigan.  J.  Great Lakes Res.  3:305-312.

Rice, C.P., P.J. Samson, and G. Noguchi.  1984.  Atmospheric Transport  of Toxa-
    phene  to Lake  Michigan.  Report to  the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
    February 1984.  U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency, Grosse lie, Michigan.

Strachan, W.M.J. and H. Huneault.   1979.  Polychlorinated biphenyls and organo-
    chlorine pesticides in Great Lakes  precipitation.  J. Great Lakes Res. 5:
    61-68.

Swain, W.R.  1978.  Chlorinated organic residues in fish, water, and precipita-
    tion form the  vicinity of Isle  Royale, Lake Superior.  J. Great Lakes Res.
    4:398-407.

Swain, W.R., and G.E. Glass.  1984.  Potential for Pollutant Alteration of the
    Hydrocycle.  International Association for Great Lakes Research.  Abstracts
    of the 27th Conference on Great Lakes Research,  pp. 69.

Veith, G.D., D.W.  Khehl, F.A. Puglisi,  G.E. Glass, and J.G. Eaton.  1977.  Resi-
    dues of PCBs and DDT in the western Lake  Superior ecosystem.  Archives of
    Environmental  Contamination and Toxicology.  5:487-499.
                                      -121

-------
                  BIOLOGICAL TESTING OF INDUSTRIAL EFFLUENT

                                      by
                                  A.M. Beym1
                                   ABSTRACT

     Examined are procedures for biotesting of industrial effluents.  These
procedures include toxicological criteria, field observations, biochemical
diagnosis, and toxicogenetic research.
                                 INTRODUCTION

     Planning and organizational measures, as well as sizable capital in-
vestments, for environmental protection that have been implemented in re-
cent years in the Soviet Union have appreciably slowed pollution of inland
and continental bodies of water while significant growth has occurred in
industrial and agricultural output (Federov 1977).  However, development of
industry, increasing industrialization, and use of chemicals in agriculture
still lead to movement into the environment of a certain amount of chemicals,
including xenobiotics.

     The paper and pulp industry still uses much water.  A trend in all
countries in the 1950s has carried through to a full transition from the
sulfite method to the more progressive and ecologically beneficial sulfate
method of recovering pulp.

     Use of new technological procedures permits maximum utilization of use-
ful timber products for the national economy.  In addition to the main
product, cellulose, modern enterprises are recovering turpentine and other
terpenes, tall oil, methanol, hydrogen polysulfide odorizer, furfurol,
feed yeast and other products.   All these engineering developments have made
it possible to prevent passage of excessive carbohydrates (pentoses and hex-
oses),  terpene hydrocarbons, resin and fatty acids, alcohols, sulfur-contain-
ing agents of the methylmercaptan class, and other chemical compounds into
liquid sewage.
'institute of Ecological Toxicology,_
                                     122

-------
     Treatment plants serve as barriers to prevent pollution of water by sew-
age.  Within a short period of time, 85% of  the enterprises of the paper and
pulp industry were supplied with biological  treatment installations.  Two
combines, the Baykal Paper and Pulp Combine  (BTsBK) and  the Selenginsk Pulp
and Cardboard Combine, have integrated purification processes consisting of
three steps: biological, chemical, and mechanical.  Other plants are equipped
with mechanical purification methods and systems of aerating ponds.  The
treatment installations that have been started up recently were designed on
the basis of progressive water-consumption standards and existence of an effi-
cient intraplant system of purifying liquid  sewage.

     Work dealing with environmental protection and optimum use of natural
resources is acquiring increasing importance with each passing year.  In the
USSR, sanitary-hygienic, water-management, and other environmental protection
requirements imposed on construction and operation of industrial enterprises
are growing increasingly strict.  This requires additional work on problems of
environmental protection at all organizational stages:   scientific research,
designing and building enterprises, and routine industrial work (Tipisev 1984).

     Liquid effluent from different types of plants contain diverse chemical
compounds, the number of which may exceed several tens or hundreds.  It is
possible to identify the chemical composition of this multicomponent flow,
but it is unrealistic to implement thorough  and regular monitoring of these
substances.  For this reason, inspection of  quality of industrial sewage is
effected in our country and abroad mainly by performing hydrochemical analy-
ses of basic overall indicators and so-called priority pollutants.  For exam-
ple, the following mandatory parameters for  hydrochemical monitoring have
been defined for treated liquid sewage of the Baykal and Selenginsk combines:
active medium reaction (pH), temperature, color index, biological oxygen de-
mand (BOD5 and BODfull), chemical oxygen minimum (COM),  total mineralization,
volatile phenols, and total organic sulfides.  In a number of cases, when
treated sewage is discharged into reservoirs of a special category, which are
used for fisheries and have recreational value, additional parameters are
monitored:  levels of iron and turpentine, methanol, volatile fatty acids,
carbohydrates, and others.  In spite of expansion of the list of monitored
parameters, however, it is not feasible to efficiently determine the quanti-
ties of the entire range of chemical compounds, which makes it difficult to
provide a biological assessment of the quality of sewage dumped into bodies
of water.
                    BIOLOGICAL TESTING OF INDUSTRIAL SEWAGE

     In recent times, methods of direct evaluation of  toxicity of  the water
environment are gaining increasing importance, i.e., biotesting of water qual-
ity by means of sensitive hydrobionts.  Biotesting amounts primarily to check-
ing toxicity of industrial waste.  In addition, it is  equally important to
use biotests for determination of toxicity of  polluted natural waters, and
this is already a matter of biological monitoring of their quality.  In par-
ticular, this makes it possible to use biotesting in the  system of monitoring
the quality of natural waters, as is being done in our country and abroad
(Braginskiy 1978, Izrael1 et al. 1978).


                                     123

-------
     Biotesting opens up vast opportunities for monitoring water quality on a
quantitative basis, since it yields concrete figures characterizing  toxicity
of the water environment for hydrobionts.  The results of biotesting are of
considerable interest, not only in the ecological, but hygienic aspects.  On
the one hand, biotesting is used in hygienic studies as a rapid method of
assessing toxicity of the water environment and determining the nature of
change in it under the influence of different factors (Krasovskiy et al.
1983).  On the other hand, hydrobionts are representatives of a complicated
aquatic biocenosis, which is actively involved in processes of spontaneous
self-purification of water to remove pollutants.  Consequently, the  toxic
effect of chemicals on them could lead to decline of self-purifying capacity
of a reservoir and worsening of its sanitary conditions, which is already of
interest from the purely sanitary and hygienic point of view (Beym et al.
1984).
                      TOXICOLOGICAL CRITERIA FOR ASSESSING
                        QUALITY OF TREATED LIQUID SEWAGE

     Studies dealing with biotesting of sewage, in particular the industrial
waste from the BTsBK (Izrael1 et al. 1981), hold an important place in the
set of state measures to protect the flora and fauna of Lake Baykal against
anthropogenic pollution.  Biological studies of liquid waste preceded devel-
opment of a basic industrial plan for integrated purification of industrial
waste at the BTsBK [Baykal Paper and Pulp Combine].  On the basis of model
and semiproduction experiments,  marine toxicologists demonstrated that intro-
duction of methods of biological and chemical treatment of liquid waste leads
to significant decline of water  pollution in reservoirs.

     From the very first days of operation of the BTsBK (1967), a biological
service for monitoring liquid waste quality was organized.  The purpose of
the studies included:

     o  Multilevel investigation of toxicity of untreated and treated liquid
        sewage from sulfate and cellulose plants to aquatic organisms.

     o  Biological assessment of qualitative composition of liquid sewage.

     o  Determination of vital (inactive) concentrations of a number of organ-
        ic and inorganic substances contained in runoff.

     Typical representatives of  plankton and benthos (algae, protozoans, hel-
minths,  mollusks, crustaceans),  as well as fish at different stages of devel-
opment (roe, larvae,  young and adult specimens) were the objects of marine
toxicological studies.   The distinction of the toxicological work done in
Lake Baykal was the difficulty of choice of test objects, since the lake's
ecosystem is unique with respect to presence of endemic species that play
the leading role in processes of transforming matter into energy.

     The following served as indicators of the reaction of test organisms to
presence in water of toxic impurities:  survival rate, poisoning symptoms,  *
changes  in reproduction and fertility, a set of pathophysiological and


                                      124

-------
biochemical changes, and others.  The vital properties of  liquid waste were
evaluated in  acute  (24, 48  and  96  h),  subacute  (30  days)  and  chronic  (6-9
months) experiments.  The results of scientific  research pursued for more
than 15 years revealed  that,  after  combined purification,  liquid waste has
mild toxicity (even  if  not diluted) for most endemic and palearctic aquatic
organisms.  The degree  of toxicity  of industrial waste to  hydrobionts dimin-
ishes substantially  if  it is  diluted unadulterated water (gradually reaching
zero toxicity)  (Table 1 )'.
TABLE 1.  RESULTS OF BIOTESTING TREATED LIQUID WASTE FROM THE BTsBK  (1967-
          1984)                                                      '
          Test Objects	Vital Degree of Dilution

          Algae                                     1:1  - 1:10
             Chlorella pyrenoidosa
             Chara  sp.
             Scenedesmus quadricauda

          Protozoa                                    1:1
             Paramaecium caudatum

          Turbellaria                               1:4  - 1:10
             Baicalobia guttata

          Annelides                                1:1  - 1:4
             Oligohaeta
             Tubifex tubifex
             Lumbriculus variegatus
             Lamprodrilus nigrescens

          Mollusca                                  1:2  - 1:5
             Benedictia baicalensis

          Crustacea                                1:1  - 1=10

          Cladocera
             Daphnia magna
             J). pulex
             I), longispina
             Chydorus sphaericus
             Symocephalus vetulus

          Copepoda
             Cyclops kolensis
             Epischura baicalensis                    1  : 50
                                      125

-------
TABLE 1  (continued)
          Test Objects                      Vital Degree of Dilution
          Amphipoda                                1:1 ~  ^ : 8
             Gammarus lacustris
             Eulimnogammarus verrucosus
             Eulimnogammarus cyaneus
             Acanthogammarus victorii

          Pisces                                   1 : 6 ~  1:20
             Coregonus autumnalis migratorius
             Thymallus arcticus baicalensis
             Paracottus kessleri
             P. kneri
             Cottocomephorus grewingki
             Rutilus rutilus lacustris
             Lenciscus lenciscus
             Phoxinus phoxinus
     Special tracer studies using the gold isotope Au-198 revealed  that
treated liquid waste is diluted by a deep-lying dispersing device to 1/20th
or more at the dumping site and to more than 1/100 at a distance of 500 m
or more (Vetrov and Dekin, 1977).  These data indicate that diluted sewage
in water that is being mixed does not have a devastating effect on repre-
sentatives of the aquatic biocenosis, including such particularly sensitive
species as the endemic little crayfish, Epischura baicalensis Sars.
            FIELD STUDIES AND OBSERVATIONS:  ICHTHYOLOGICAL MAPPING

     In all periods of observation, fishing-crib experiments were performed
with representatives of the ichthyofauna (Baykal cisco—Coregonus autumnalis
migratorius Gorgi,  grayling—Thymallus arcticus baicalensis Dybowski, bull-
head—Cottus Knei Dybowski, Cottus Kessleri Dybowski, minnow—Phoxinus phoxi-
nus Linne)  in the immediate zones of dilution of industrial waste and along
the cone of their distribution in a north-easterly direction along the shore-
line.  The fish in the cribs, which were placed at different depths, survived
in these zones without being fed for 48 days or more.  Control catches in
this region with special fishing gear revealed presence of diverse represen-
tatives of ichthyofauna of Lake Baykal.  Organoleptic studies showed that the
fish had no odor whatsoever.  Concurrently, cytologists, geneticists, and
physiologists investigated cytogenetic changes in the cells of some  fish
tissues, behavioral reactions of fish and gammarids exposed to low doses of
liquid waste.  Electro-physiological monitoring methods were used to observe
changes in the chemo-receptor system of fish and crustaceans, as well as
biochemical criteria for evaluating stress reactions of fish and the basic
parameters of carbohydrate, fat and protein metabolism.

                                      126

-------
             BIOCHEMICAL EVALUATION OF FUNCTIONAL STATE OF FISH IN
                     BIOTESTING OF INDUSTRIAL LIQUID WASTE

     One of the most important indicators that determine the resistance of
living systems to adverse (toxic) factors is their reactivity.

     In biology, reactivity usually refers to the organism's capacity for an
adequate reaction in response to altered endogenous and exogenous conditions.
In other words, the highest levels of reactivity enable a living system to
respond in the most advantageous way to diverse factors and preserve homeo-
static functional parameters of vital systems.

     It should be emphasized in particular that optimum forms of adaptation
to adverse factors do not necessarily provide for maintaining stability of
the organism's endogenous environment as a whole.  Moreover, optimum level
of reactivity also refers to the capacity of higher integrative regulatory
elements of the organism to select the particular systems (which differ when
exposed to essentially different factors), the activity of which must be in
homeostasis.   Deviations in their functional parameters must not exceed the
physiological range.  At the same time, the functional activity of other
systems can change over the widest range without detriment to the organism
as a whole.

     In the light of these conceptions, when conducting toxicological studies
of water, it is necessary to make a more distinct differentiation between the
results of observations of so-called target systems,  i.e., those to which the
effect of a given toxicant is addressed, and purely regulatory changes, which
are necessary to compensate for functional deviations in organs or target
systems.

     When performing biotests on fish, we made an attempt at biochemical de-
termination of the functional state of systems both directly related to de-
toxification of compounds contained in waste from the BTsBK and reactions of
the organism that are instrumental in maintaining optimum levels of reactiv-
ity.

     In this regard, it is of special interest to investigate the system of
enzymes that catalyze oxidative metabolism of hydrophobic compounds  (Kozlov
et al. 1983a, 1983b), localized in membranes of the liver's endoplasmic
reticulum.  This system, which consists of two membrane proteins of NADP'H
cytochrome P-450 reductase and cytochrome P-450, is capable of utilizing
virtually any hydrophobic compounds in toxic agents.   Moreover, these oxy-
genases participate in the metabolism of steroid hormones and fatty acids.
An interesting distinction of this oxygenase system is that a number of
organic compounds (barbiturates, polycyclic hydrocarbons, etc.) are capable
of inducing synthesis of new molecules of cytochrome P-450 in hepatic micro-
somes.

     As a result of the experiments, the following results were obtained  for
concentrations and activity of microsomal oxygenases  (Table 2).  Lake  Baykal
is one of the cleanest bodies of water, and for this reason the demonstrated
low concentrations of cytochrome P-450 in the liver of local fish  is due  to

                                     127

-------
the exceptionally low levels of NADP inductors, on the one hand, and on  the
other hand it enables us to consider the demonstrated level of development of
systems of oxygenases with mixed function to be constitutive, used primarily
for metabolism of endogenous substrates with synthesis of steroid hormones
and bile acids.

     This hypothesis is also confirmed by the fact that we demonstrated  ex-
ceptionally low activity of benz-oi-pyrene hydroxylase, which does not ex-
ceed 0.5 pmol phenol metabolic products of benz-a-pyrene/mg protein/min,
which is 1/50th the activity inherent in warm-blooded animals and 1/1Oth the
activity of the liver of some salt-water fish.
TABLE 2.  LEVELS AND ACTIVITY OF CYTOCHROME P450 IN LIVER OF LAKE BAYKAL
          FISH
             Fish
 Cytochrome P-450,
nmol/mg microsomal
     protein 	
Activity of NADP'H
   cytochrome C
  reductase, nmol
cytochrome C mg/min
Phoxinus Phoxinus Phoxinus           0.8 +^ 0.13
(Linne)

Perca fluviatilisl(Linne)           0.11 ^0.06

Rutilus rutilus (Linne)             0.31 _+ 0.12

Thymallus arcticus baicalensis      0.04 + 0.02
  (Dybowski)

Coregonus autumnalis migratorius    0.04 +_ 0.01
  (Georgi)

Procottus jeitelesi                 0.21 + 0.05
                              2.49 +_ 0.99


                              0.60 +_ 0.20

                              1.17 _+ 0.31

                              0.61 +_ 0.01


                              0.58 + 0.07
     It was of special interest to investigate the effect of waste from paper
and pulp plants on the system of microsomal oxygenases of fish in Lake Baykal.
For these experiments, fish (perch, grayling and Cisco) caught both in the
immediate vicinity of dumping from the BTsBK and other parts of Lake Baykal
were adapted to living in tanks with Baykal water for 5-7 days.  After this,
the adapted fish were exposed to treated sewage in a concentration of 1:20.
We analyzed levels of cytochrome P-450, activity of NADP'H cytochrome P-450
reductase, as well as kinetics of enzymatic peroxidation of  lipids induced
by NADP-H cytochrome P-450 reductase and cytochrome P-450, in microsomal
fractions of che liver of these fish.  The levels of cytochrome P-450 were
the same in microsomal fractions from the liver of fish exposed to treated
sewage and in the liver of control fish.  This indicates that, under these
                                     128

-------
experimental conditions, the liquid sewage apparently  contained  no  polycylic
hydrocarbons in concentrations  sufficient  for  induction of microsomal oxy-
reductases.  This also is confirmed by the fact  that neither  the kinetics
of cytochrome C reduction nor rate of  lipid  peroxidation in microsomal frac-
tions of the liver of fish kept in the run-off from the BTsBK in a  dilution
of 1:20 differed from control values  (Kotelevtsev et al.  1984).

     It also is known that mechanisms of nonspecific adaptation  are well-
represented in cold-blooded animals.   The  system of hormonal  regulation
of physiological functions and hemoglobin  system are the most labile  in
reactions to changes in environmental  conditions.  The nature of physiologi-
cal changes in response to chemical stress indicates that  the  general  adap-
tation syndrome develops in fish  (Luk'yanenko  1967).   There are  no  clearcut
and validated explanations, however, for the mechanisms of  this  phenomenon
due to lack of studies of different aspects  of hormonal physiology of  fish.
This makes it difficult to furnish a biochemical  diagnosis  of  functional
state of fish under stress in aquatic  toxicological studies.   The role  of
adrenocortical hormones in regulation of systemic adaptive  reactions is
known.  The data on glucocorticoid levels  in fish blood are contradictory,
and this is attributable to the flaws in analytical methods (Wedemeyer  et
al.1981).

     The radioimmunological method we use permits very accurate  evaluation
of the system involved in nonspecific  resistance  and choice of optimum  forms
and levels of behavior in teleost fish under normal conditions and with ex-
posure to chemical anthropogenic  factors.  In control  experiments, corticos-
terone was demonstrated in blood plasma of examined fish in the  following
concentrations, ng/ml: grayling—3.3+0.4 (n = 16), cicso—6.2+JD.5 (n =  37),
perch—5.5+0.8 (n = 4) and burbot—2.1jf0.3 (n =  3).  A preliminary series of
studies failed to demonstrate sex-related differences  in levels  of this hor-
mone.  The condition of the system that provides  for nonspecific resistance
was studied with exposure to the set of chemical  factors contained in  treated
liquid waste from sulfate-cellulose plants (BTsBK).  Corticosterone level
constituted 2.4+_0.3 ng/ml (n ~ 14) in experimental grayling, and it did not
differ with statistical reliability from normal  physiological  values.

     At the present time, it has become possible  to develop special systems
adapted for selective detection of steroid compounds in  fish  with mineralo-
corticoid and glucocorticoid activity.  Assays were made of concentrations
of aldosterone, 11-deoxycorticosterone and cortisol in samples of blood
from intact fish—grayling and cisco.  It was demonstrated, in principle,
that factors differing in nature and duration of exposure  (impairment of
abiotic environmental factors) elicit changes in  relative concentrations of
glucocorticoid and mineralocorticoid hormones with an  adaptive effect.  Thus,
the radioimmunological method of assaying adrenocortical hormones permits
more accurate evaluation of the system of  nonspecific  resistance in teleost
fish under normal conditions and in the presence  of chemical  pathology caused
by anthropogenic factors, and it can be used with success  for  biological
testing of industrial liquid waste.

     Studies of different fractions of hemoglobin  (Hb)  were conducted  in the
Baykal cisco caught in a net in the southeastern part  of Lake  Baykal.   During

                                      129

-------
the adaptation period, the fish were kept in tanks with running water  from
the lake (t = 8-10°C).  It was ultimately found that the  levels of  alkali-
resistant Hb differed significantly in different species of fish  (ranging
from 11.9% in the grayling to 25.5% in the cisco).  There was similar  varia-
tion in concentration of carboxyhemoglobin (from 0.86% in the grayling to
1.38% in the burbot) and methemoglobin (MetHb) (from 3.6% in the  cisco to
6.7% in the perch and burbot).  Methemoglobin content depends on  blood levels
of oxidants that change Hb iron to a trivalent state.  In the course of oxi-
dation of Hb to MetHb there is formation of oxygen superoxide anion with high
reactivity.

     One of the most important enzymes of antioxidant protection  of the
organism is superoxide dismutase (SOD), which causes dismutation  of super-
oxide anion.  High SOD activity is demonstrable in the blood of the examined
fish: from 1.18 to 10.93 arbitary units per mg Hb.  On the whole, analysis
revealed that SOD activity is higher in cold-blooded animals than in warm-
blooded.

     Investigation of the effect of liquid sewage on parameters of Hb  compo-
sition in perch and grayling revealed the same direction of changes in met-
hemoglobin and carboxyhemoglobin content:  increase in concentration of oxi-
dized Hb (methemoglobin), with decrease in CO-bound Hb (carboxyhemoglobin).
Evidently, there are substances in liquid waste that are instrumental  in
converting hemoglobin to an irreversibly oxidized form (MetHb).

     As a rule, the amount of alkali-resistant Hb increases under the  effect
of adverse environmental factors.  Under physiological conditions, higher
resistance to the denaturing effect of alkali is inherent in Hb at the early
developmental stages—embryonic and fetal.  It was also found that diluted
liquid sewage from the aerating pond of the BTsBK could not alter signifi-
cantly either the Hb fractions studied or the activity of one of  the enzymes
of the antioxidant system of red blood cells—superoxide dismutase.

     Thus, development of modern biotesting methods requires use  of the re-
sults of basic research in different branches of biology, including biochemi-
cal studies on the membrane and molecular levels.  Indeed, identification of
the intimate mechanisms that protect functional systems of the cell against
the toxic effects of poisons, pollutants and their naturally occurring metab-
olites permits not only development of highly sensitive and specific tests
for biological monitoring of the environment, but prediction of mechanisms
of subsequent effects of xenobiotics and their metabolic products on aquatic
animals.
                             TOXICOGENETIC STUDIES

     A modification of the semiquantitative Ames test—salmonella/microsomes
with use of a system of metabolic activation from the liver of the Baykal
cisco induced by methylcholanthrene—was developed for investigation of the
toxic genetic effect of constituents of waste from the paper and pulp indus-
try.  Preparations of microsomal fractions from the cisco liver are highly
active, as are fractions from the liver of induced rats.


                                     130

-------
     Investigation of a series of samples of sewage from  the  Baykal Paper
and Pulp Combine collected at different  times  from different  stages of pro-
duction and treatment using the Ames test with a system of metabolic acti-
vation from the liver of fish and rats,  revealed that the composition of
liquid waste was heterogeneous, as manifested by the  existence of direct
mutagenic activity in some of the samples taken from  the  first and inter-
mediate stages of production and treatment.  No genetic activity was found
in virtually all samples taken from  the  last stage of sewage  treatment
(Glazer et al. 1984).
                  BIOTESTING OF CONSTITUENTS OF LIQUID SEWAGE

     The waste from paper and pulp  enterprises is  characterized by specific
organic substances that make up the wood, as well  as those formed in the
course of the technological operation  for production of  cellulose and treat-
ment measures.  For this reason, investigations to set the scientifically
validated maximum allowable concentrations  (MAC) of substances that are a
potential hazard to aquatic organisms  acquire importance.

     Experimentation is the principal  method of establishing the threshold
of toxicity of chemical compounds.  MAC is determined for the weakest bio-
logical element that is damaged by  the lowest concentrations of pollutant
and it becomes the minimum factor in assessing reservoirs.  In addition to
the known method of fish samples and survival of other aquatic organisms,
a wide assortment of physiological, biochemical and biological tests is
used as a criterion of toxicity, and together they made  it possible to de-
termine the concentrations of reagents at which the disturbances in vital
functions of hydrobionts are at the stage of prepathological development.
Special attention was devoted to long-term experiments to determine the
chronic adverse effects of low doses of toxicants  and to experiments on
organisms with a short cycle of development in order to  assess the genetic
sequelae of poisoning.

     Many years of toxicological research established the vital permissible
concentrations of a number of deleterious elements in waste from the paper
and pulp industry.  These substances are referable to different classes of
chemical compounds:  aliphatic and  terpene hydrocarbons, organic sulfides,
aromatic hydrocarbons of the phenol class and others.  Taking into con-
sideration the toxicological indicator of deleteriousness, biologically
validated MAC were set for 30 components, including such agents as car-
bolic acid (phenol), ortho-cresol,  meta- and para-cresol, guaiacol and
others.

     For the first time in biological  practice, studies  were made of degree
of harm to hydrobionts of suspended substances  (residue  of cellulose fibers
and lignin).

     The levels of all these substances in liquid  sewage are strictly limited
and monitored on the basis of chemical analyses made by  laboratories of  the
State Committee for Hydrology and Metallurgy [Goskomgidromet].
                                     131

-------
     Toxicometric analysis for hydrobionts is made not only of individual
components, but different combinations (total monatomic phenols,  total
multiatomic phenols, combinations thereof mixed with sulfur-containing com-
pounds of the methylmercaptan class and others).  The MAC are used to assess
the degree of toxicity of formed industrial liquid waste.  Ultimately, these
biological standards determine the extent of capital investments  in planning
and building treatment plants, and they assure purity of lake water.


                 BIOMONITORING AS A COMPONENT AND INTEGRAL PART
                         OF BIOTESTING INDUSTRIAL WASTE

     In order to solve problems of biotesting, it is important to select and
develop "key" or model territories that are exposed to industrial liquid sew-
age.  The area of scattered purified liquid waste from the Baykal Paper and
Pulp Combine is one of these testing areas of permanent monitoring in South
Baykal (Kozhova 1971, Kozhova et al. 1965).  Biomonitoring is performed with
particular thoroughness in a section that is adjacent to the site of dis-
charge of sewage.  Material is collected in sections at distances of 0.05,
0.1, 0.5 and 1  km in the dumping region.   Each section consists of several
stations in different depth zones, i.e.,  different biotopes.

     A control testing area is situated outside the area affected by dumped
sewage.  In addition to chemical composition of the water, studies are made
of both plankton and benthos communities, including water and soil bacteria.
The following are determined in plankton communities:  composition and
quantity of phytoplankton; primary production by the oxygen and radioactive
carbon methods; total quantity of bacterioplankton by the method of ultra-
membrane filtration; basic physiological  groups of bacteria; population of
bacterioplankton by the method of separate tests for total number and dark
assimilation of ^C; and composition,  number, biomass and production of zoo-
plankton determined by indicators of growth and reproduction.  Samples are
taken along the entire column of water from standard hydrological levels
using a (Dzhedi) net and bathymeter.  Benthos is studied with consideration
of vertical zonality of communities and composition of soil at different
depths, with use of scuba divers who determine the projective cover of the
bottom and organisms that are difficult to detect with the usual collecting
gear (Kozhova 1974).

     A comparison of all the communities  studied revealed that an anthropo-
genic effect is manifested in the zone of a small spot of polluted soil
(0.1 km2)  at the lake's bottom (beyond the littoral zone), where there is
accumulation of anthropogenic sediment.  There, microbiological indicators,
total biomass of zoobenthos and proportion of dominant animals in the bio-
mass—gammarids, mollusks and Oligochaetae—undergo substantial change.
For example, at a depth of 5-20 m, the mollusk and Oligochaetae community
of such soil changes to a gammarid community.  In the zone at a depth of
20-50 m,  an Oligochaetae community changes into a gammarid one.  The same
happens in the  zone at a depth of 50-100  m.  Gammarid biomass undergoes the
least change.   However, even in gammarids, as in the other animals studied,
there is  a reduction in species composition.
                                     132

-------
     Alteration of communities also occurs in  less polluted  soil,  where  the
anthropogenic sediment is  less marked.   Interestingly,  at some depths the
macrozoobenthos on such soil is even larger than  in  control  sections.  At a
depth of 5-20 m, this happens due  to increased profusion of  mollusks  and at
20-50 m, Oligochaetae.  But in the 50- to 100-m zone, zoobenthos biomass also
decreases on less polluted ground.  This is particularly noticeable for
Oligochaetae biomass.

     A comparison of the parameters used for ecological  mapping enables  us to
rank them in the following order according to  significance to  water quality
in Lake Baykal:  bacteria at the bottom and zoobenthos  > bacterioplahkton >
primary production > zooplankton > phytoplankton  > littoral  phytobenthos.

     Let us note that the zone of impact of the Baykal  Paper and Pulp Combine
remained at virtually the same level in  the course of a  10-year observation
period (Izrael1 et al. 1978).

     Thus, biotesting of industrial sewage, unlike traditional analytical
methods of monitoring or in addition to  these  methods, makes it possible  to
determine water quality on a quantitative basis and  characterizes  the extent
of toxicity of the aquatic environment for hydrobionts.   It was demonstrated
with laboraory biotests that 24-h water from the  sulfate-pulp industry has
virtually no acute toxicity after  integrated three-step  purification  (bio-
logical, chemical, mechanical) for most of the  endemic and palearctic hydro-
biont species examined.  The results of chronic experiments revealed that
the degree of toxicity of liquid waste for aquatic organisms diminishes when
diluted in natural water (from 2-  to 50-fold).  Vital dilution of  industrial
waste in the lake is obtained over a radius of  100 m from  the heads of the
deep scattering dumping devices.

     Modern methods of physiocochemical and molecular biology hold an impor-
tant place in biotesting, with regard to diagnosing  pathophysiological states.
Studies have been made of mixed function monoxygenase systems of the liver
of Baykal fish, which affect oxidative metabolism of xenobiotics.   It was
shown that the level of microsomal fraction cytochrome P-450 in fish, as
well as level of induction in membranes of the  hepatic endoplasmic  reticulum
of phospholipid peroxidation,can serve as a test  to  evaluate pollution of
the water environment.  Using spectrophotometry and  disk electrophoresis, it
was established that the waste from the BTsBK in  a ratio of 1:20 does not
affect the level of cytochrome P-450 and, unlike  the tested exogenous xeno-
biotics (3-methylcholanthrene), does not elicit synthesis  of cytochrome P-450
isoforms.

     All of the results of integrated studies are used in  routine  work for
experimental evaluation of toxicity of treated  liquid waste from the Baykal
Paper and Pulp Combine, and they serve as the basis  for  determining condi-
tions under which waste is dumped  to preclude  any possible harm to the lake's
biocenosis.

     Biotesting problems are multifaceted, and  they  are  far from being
solved.  One of the tasks for the next few years  is  to develop automated
biotesting systems, which would facilitate considerably  the work of biologist-

                                     133

-------
toxicologists and yield results faster.  It would be useful and desirable  to
specially discuss these aspects of biotesting within the  framework  of  Soviet-
American collaboration.
                                  BIBLIOGRAPHY

Beym, A.M., G.N. Krasovskiy, I.V. Sutokskaya, and L.Ya. Vasyukovich.   1984.
    Hygienic-ecological approaches to biomonitoring of water quality.   In:
    Samoochishcheniye vody i migratsiya zagryazneniy po troficheskoy  tsepi
    (Water Self-Purification and Migration of Pollutants Over the Trophic
    Chain).  Moscow, USSR.  pp. 16-22.

Braginskiy, L.P.  1978.  New system for biomonitoring the aquatic environment
    in the United States.  Gidrobiol. Zhurn.  14(1):77-83.

Fedorov, Ye.K.  1977.  Ekologicheskiy krizis i sotsial'nyy progress (The Eco-
    logical Crisis and Social Progress).  Leningrad, USSR, 176 pages.

Glazer, V.M. , V.M. Savov, S.K. Abilev, et al.  1984.  A test system for bio-
    monitoring based on membrane-bound enzyme complexes.  4:  Evaluation of
    toxicogenetic effects in Ames test system with metabolic activation by
    microsomal monoxygenases from fish liver.  Biol. Nauki,  5:85-89.

Izrael1, Yu.A., N.K. Gasilina, F.Ya. Rovinskiy,  and L.M. Filippova.   1978.
    Osushchestvleniye v SSSR sistemy monitoringa zagryazneniya prirodnoy
    sredy  (Implemention of System for Monitoring the Environment in the
    USSR).  Leningrad, USSR.  67 pages.

Izrael1, Yu.A., Yu.A. Anokhin, B.B.  Chebanenko,  et al. 1981.  Integrated
    analysis of environmental and validation of monitoring in the region
    of Lake Baykal.   In:   Vsestoronniy analiz okruzhayushchey prirodnoy
    sredy  (trudy IV Sovetsko-amerikanskogo simpoziuma, Dzhekson, Vayoming,
    22-27 oktyabrya 1979 g.)  (Comprehensive Analysis of the Environment,
    Transactions of 4th Soviet-American Symposium, Jackson, Wyoming,  22-27
    October 1979), Leningrad, USSR.   pp. 43-59.

Kotelevtsev, S.V., V.M. Glazer, V.B. Ritov, et al.  1984.  Methods of
    physicochemical biology for ecological and toxicological evaluation of
    waste dumped by' enterprises of the paper and pulp industry.  In:  Prob-
    lemy okhrany prirody.  Tezisy dokl (Problems of Environmental Protection.
    Summaries of Papers).  Baykalsk, USSR.  pp.  86-87.

Kozhova, O.M., L.A.  Izhboldina, and G.S. Kaplina.  1965.  Benthos of  littoral
    and sublittoral region along eastern shores of Lake Baykal.  Gidrobiol.
    Zhurn.  1(4):14-21.

Kozhova, O.M.   1971.  Current status of fauna and flora of Lake Baykal in the
    region of dumping industrial waste by Baykal plant.  In:  Issledovaniya
    gidrobiologicheskogo rezhima vodoyemov Vostochnoy Sibiri (Investigations
    of Hydrobiological Conditions in Waters of East Siberia).  Irkutsk, USSR.
    pp. 3-9


                                     134

-------
Kozhova,  O.M.  1974.  Yearly changes in biocenoses of  the  Utulik-Murin region
    of South Baykal.  In:  Produktivnost'  Baykala  i  antropogennyye  izmeneniya
    yego prirody  (Productivity of Lake Baykal and  Anthropogenic Changes in
    It).   Irkutsk, USSR.  pp.  160-171.

Kozlov, Yu.P., V.Ye. Kagan, A.M. Beym, et  al.   1983.   Test systems  for bio-
    monitoring based on membrane-bound enzymatic complexes.   1:   Investigation
    of oxygenases with mixed functions in  liver microsomes of endemic fish of
    Lake Baykal.  Biol. Nauki.   1:20-24.

Kozlov, Yu.P., V.Ye. Kagan, A.M. Beym, et  al.   1983b.   Test  systems for bio-
    monitoring based on membrane-bound enzymatic complexes.   2:   Investiga-
    tion of enzymatic and nonenzymatic systems  of  lipid peroxidation in
    liver microsomes of endemic  fish  of Lake  Baykal.   Biol.  Nauki.   5:18-23.

Krasovskiy, G.N., I.P. Pletnikova, and I.V. Sutokskaya.   1983.  Criterion of
    deleteriousness in evaluation of  toxic effect  of chemical pollution of
    water.  In:   Teoreticheskiye problemy  vodnoy toksikologii  (Theoretical
    Problems of Water Toxicology), Moscow, USSR.   pp.  '42-48.

Luk'yanenko, V.I.   1967.  Toksikologiya ryb (Toxicology of Fish), Moscow,
    USSR.   216 pages.

Tipisev, A.Ya.   1984.  Environmental  protection—a priority  task.   Bumazhnaya
    Promyshlennost'.  5:1-3.

Vetrov, V.A. and  S.A. Dekin.   1977.   Investigation of  distribution  of impuri-
    ties using radioactive  tracer.   In Techeniya v Baykale [Currents of Lake
    Baykal], Novosibirsk, USSR.   pp.  133-143.

Wedemeyer,  G.A.,  P.P. Meyer, and L.  Smith.  1981.  Stress and diseases of
    fish.   Moscow,  USSR.   128  pages.
                                      135

-------
               COMPLEX EFFLUENTS TOXICITY INFORMATION SYSTEM

                                     by

                      R.C. Russo1, A. Pilli2, and J. Crane2
                                  ABSTRACT

      The Complex Effluent Toxicity Information System (CETIS) is a com-
puterized data management system designed to assemble the results of efflu-
ent toxicity tests so that toxicity characteristics of complex effluents
can be determined on an industry-by-industry basis.  Data are obtained
through literature searches of published reports and from individuals who
provide unpublished bioassay data from their state or regional biomonitor-
ing programs.  Before entry into the computer file, the data are evaluated
by reviewers who are experienced in bioassay methods and trained in CETIS
procedures.   In June 1984, data from 500 references for 1500 bioassay tests
were in the CETIS data base.

                                INTRODUCTION

      Toxicity data from bioassays with freshwater and saltwater organisms
are used in assessing the effects of complex effluents on the aquatic
environment.  Such information can be used in setting pollutant discharge
limits for industries and municipalities for wastewaters being discharged
into natural aquatic systems, in determining where to use toxicity testing,
and in interpreting toxicity test results.

      Much of the toxicity data on complex effluents is available in un-
published form, although some information has been included in reports and
journal articles dealing with biomonitoring or with environmental impacts
of specific kinds of wastewaters.  Bioassay methods used for complex
1 Environmental Research Laboratory,  U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency,
 Athens, GA  30613.
Environmental Research Laboratory,  U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency,
 Duluth, MN  55804

-------
ettluent testing are available in the literature (U.S. EPA 1971, Peltier
1978, APHA et al. 1981, Weber and Peltier 1981, Peltier and Weber 1984).

      To make such data widely available to researchers and to those
involved in setting water quality standards, all obtainable published and
unpublished data have been compiled in the Complex Effluents Toxicity
Information System (CET1S).

      The CET1S data base is a computerized data management system de-
signed to assemble the results of effluent toxicity tests so that toxicity
characteristics of complex effluents can be determined on an industry-by-
industry basis.  The information contained in the data base is available
from the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Environmental Research
Laboratory in Duluth, Minnesota, or through the National Computer Center
in Raleigh, North Carolina.
                          DESCRIPTION AND METHODS

      Data to be entered in the data base are obtained in two major ways.
First, literature searches identifying toxicity tests of complex effluents
are performed by computer bibliographic retrieval.  Published reports are
screened tor suitability for CET1S, and those containing useful information
are incorporated into the system.  Second, a coordination network consist-
ing of regional contact persons throughout the United States is in opera-
tion.  These individuals are involved with state or regional biomonitoring
programs and provide unpublished bioassay data for inclusion in the system.

      Published reports and unpublished data are evaluated by reviewers
who are experienced in bioassay methods and trained in the procedures of
the CETIS system.  The bioassay information in a published or unpublished
report or on unpublished data sheets is carefully examined by a technical
reviewer to identify, extract., and record those data suitable for entry
into the data base.  Appropriate information is entered onto data record
forms and entered into computer data files on a PDF 11/70 computer.

      Information extracted from the published and unpublished data reports
is grouped into 12 general categories:  Facility Information, Effluent/
Receiving Water Information, Reviewer Name/Coding Date Information, Sam-
pling Information, Toxicity Test Information, Test Water Information, Other
Water Profile Information, Test Organism Information, Dilution Water Infor-
mation, Test Method Information, Test Result Information, and Remarks.
Data encoded consist of both data elements unique to CETIS and data ele-
ments obtained through cross-reference from other National Computer Center
data systems.

      Information included under "Facility Information" includes the fa-
cility name (.direct or indirect discharger), discharge number, pipe num-
ber, facility type, facility address, receiving water, and basin.

      The types of wastewaters included in the data base are organized
according to the general categories of industry type, such as: ore mining,

-------
coal mining, textile mill operations, timber products processing,
pulp and paper board mills and converted paper product operations, paint
and ink formulating and printing, inorganic chemicals manufacturing,
plastics and synthetic materials manufacturing, miscellaneous chemical
manufacturing, organic chemical manufacturing, soap and detergent manu-
facturing, petroleum refining, paving and roofing material manufacturing,
rubber processing, leather tanning and finishing, iron and steel manufac-
turing, nonferrous metals manufacturing, machinery and mechanical products
manufacturing, electroplating, electric services, laundry operations, and
sewerage system operations.

      Discharge types are identified as to whether a wastewater is a cool-
ing water, process water, or both; or whether it is some other type of
of discharge such as storm water runoff.  Receiving waters are identified
as to name of water body, name of major and minor basin, and river reach.
Other information regarding the receiving water is also included, if
available, such as mean annual flow.  Treatment processes to which a
tested wastewater was subjected are also noted in the encoding process.
These treatment processes are grouped into five categories:  Physical
Treatment (lor example, ammonia stripping, floatation, multimedia filtra-
tion), Chemical Treatment (for example, carbon adsorption, chlorine
disinfection, ion exchange), Biological Treatment (for example, activated
sludge, nitrification-denitrification), Sludge Treatment and Disposal
(for example, aerobic or anaerobic digestion), and Other Processes (for
example, rueuse or recycle of treated effluent).

      Sampling information on the bioassay test sample is recorded, such
as collection date and time, how the sample was obtained (continuous
sampling, grab sample, or composite sample), and whether the sample was
an actual field sample or a spiked or synthetically prepared sample.
If available, the flow from the discharge pipe at time of sampling is
entered.

      Identifying information is provided about the bioassay, such as
test date and time, testing organization, test duration, effluent con-
centrations tested, exposure type, residue analysis, and bioassay type.
Exposure types include static, renewal, flow-through, and diet tests.
Bioassay types include screening tests, acute (short-term) tests, and
partial or full life cycle tests.  Effluent concentrations tested may
be expressed as grams, milligrams, or micrograms per liter, or as per-
cent effluent in the test solution.  Characteristics of the test water
are then entered.  This includes such information as the concentration
ranges for the test water, dissolved oxygen, pH, temperature, alkalinity,
and hardness.  The mean for each of these parameters is recorded if
available.  The range includes any duplications or replications of the
dilution series concentrations.  Test water chemical data for screening
tests are reported for the 0 percent and 100 percent effluent concen-
trations.  If test water data are not reported, diluent or effluent values
may be used.

      If measurements of additional water chemical characteristics have
been reported by the experimenter for the bioassay test water, effluent,

                                     1,38

-------
or diluent (such as, for example, anions, metals, nonmetal cations,
organics), these are briefly identified as to their availability in the
original report.

      Aquatic species used in bioassays included in the CETIS are fish,
macroinvertebrates, amphibians, and aquatic plants.  Table 1 provides a
list of test species for which toxicity data are available in the CETIS.
The lifestage of test organisms is identified as one of the following:
alevin, adult, egg, eyed egg, fertilized egg, fingerling, fry, instars,
juvenile, larval, neonate, nymph, underyearling, young, yearling, or zoea.
The ages, weights, and lengths of test organisms are recorded, and the
source (cultured, field collected, hatchery, etc.) is identified.  Infor-
mation is recorded on acclimation of the test organism to the test
dilution water, and source and pretreatment of the dilution water.  In-
formation is included on use of control test specimens in the bioassay
and on statistical data treatment of bioassay results.

      Bioassay data included in the CETIS are evaluated and assigned a
review code value tor quality, based on the experimenter's description of
bioassay test methods used and on the thoroughness ot the experimenter's
documentation of procedures and results.  Published reports meeting the
following criteria are rated highest:

      - Effluent collected less than 24 hours prior to testing.  The method
        of collection was reported.  Experimental procedures followed pub-
        lished methods.

      - Standard test water chemistry data (that is, D.O., pH, temperature,
        alkalinity, and hardness) were reported.

      - Control mortality (or other adverse effect) was satisfactory (that
        is, equal to or less than 10%).

      - Statistical methodology used to determine the endpoint was reported.

TABLE  .  COMPLEX EFFLUENTS TOXICITY INFORMATION SYSTEM:  TEST SPECIES
Species
  No.
Latin Name
                                    Common Name
  1       PIMEPHALES PROMELAS
  2       LEPOMIS MACROCHIRUS
  3       SALVELINUS FONTINALIS
  4       SALMO GAIRDNERI
  5       DAPHNIA MAGNA
  6       GAMMARUS LACUSTRIS
  7       GAMMARUS FASCIATUS
  8       DAPHNIA PULEX
 10       CARCINUS MAENAS
 11       CRANGON CRANGON
 16       GAMBUSIA AFFINIS
                                    FATHEAD MINNOW
                                    BLUEGILL
                                    BROOK TROUT
                                    RAINBOW TROUT, DONALDSON TROUT
                                    WATER FLEA
                                    SCUD
                                    SCUD
                                    WATER FLEA
                                    SHORE OR GREEN CRAB
                                    COMMON SHRIMP
                                    MOSQUITOFISH
                                      139

-------
TABLE 1 (cont'd)  COMPLEX EFFLUENTS TOXICITY INFORMATION SYSTEM:  TEST SPECIES
Species
  No.
Latin Name
                                    Common Name
 18       SEMOTILUS ATROMACULATUS
 19       LAGODON RHOMBOIDES
 20       ICTALURUS PUNCTATUS
 21       CYPRINUS CARPIO
 22       ONCORHYNCHUS TSHAWYTSCHA
 23       ONCORHYNCHUS KISUTCH
 25       CARASSIUS AURATUS
 27       GAMMARUS PSEUDOLIMNAEUS
 28       POECILIA RETICULATA
 30       LEPOMIS CYANELLUS
 33       FISH
 38       PERCA FLAVESCENS
 39       PALAEMONETES KADIAKENSIS
 49       SALMO TRUTTA
 52       HYALELLA AZTECA
 54       SIMOCEPHALUS SERRULATUS
 56       ASTERIAS RUBENS
 67       CRASSOSTREA VIRGINICA
 68       SALMO SALAR
 69       LABIDESTHES SICCULUS
 70       DAPHNIA SP
 74       PENAEUS AZTECUS
 75       PENAEUS DUORARUM
 77       PENAEUS SETIFERUS
 82       SALVELINUS NAMAYCUSH
 83       STIZOSTEDION VITREUM VITREUM
 85       CHIRONOMUS TENTANS
 86       CYPRINODON VARIEGATUS
 89       MICROPTERUS SALMOIDES
 90       ONCORHYNCHUS NERKA
 94       BARBUS TICTO
 96       LEPOMIS MICROLOPHUS
102       PROCAMBARUS CLARKII
105       UMBRA PYGMAEA
106       MICROPTERUS DOLOMIEUI
110       LEIOSTOMUS XANTHURUS
112       NOTEMIGONUS CRYSOLEUCAS
113       CLARIAS BATRACHUS
133       ICTALURUS MELAS
140       CYMATOGASTER AGGREGATA
142       MYSIDOPSIS BAHIA
202       LABEO ROHITA
205       OSCILLATORIA LIMNETICA
208       MYTILUS EDULIS
211       ALBURNUS ALBURNUS
219       ONCORHYNCHUS GORBUSCHA
224       NEREIS ARENACEODENTATA
                                    CREEK CHUB
                                    PINFISH
                                    CHANNEL CATFISH
                                    COMMON, MIRROR, COLORED, CARP
                                    CHINOOK SALMON
                                    COHO SALMON
                                    GOLDFISH
                                    SCUD
                                    GUPPY
                                    GREEN SUNFISH
                                    FISH
                                    YELLOW PERCH
                                    GRASS SHRIMP, FRESHWATER PRAWN
                                    BROWN TROUT
                                    SCUD
                                    WATER FLEA
                                    STARFISH
                                    AMERICAN OR VIRGINIA OYSTER
                                    ATLANTIC SALMON
                                    BROOK SILVERSIDE
                                    WATER FLEA
                                    BROWN SHRIMP
                                    PINK SHRIMP
                                    WHITE SHRIMP (AMERICA)
                                    LAKE TROUT, SISCOWET
                                    WALLEYE
                                    MIDGE
                                    SHEEPSHEAD MINNOW
                                    LARGEMOUTH BASS
                                    SOCKEYE SALMON
                                    TWO SPOTTED, TIC TAG TOE BARB
                                    REDEAR SUNFISH
                                    RED SWAMP CRAYFISH
                                    EASTERN MUDMINNOW
                                    SMALLMOUTH BASS
                                    SPOT
                                    GOLDEN SHINER
                                    WALKING CATFISH
                                    BLACK BULLHEAD
                                    SHINER PERCH
                                    OPOSSUM SHRIMP
                                    ROHU
                                    BLUE-GREEN ALGAE
                                    COMMON BAY MUSSEL, BLUE MUSSEL
                                    BLEAK
                                    PINK SALMON
                                    POLYCHAETE
                                      140

-------
TABLE 1 (cont'd) COMPLEX EFFLUENTS TOXICITY INFORMATION SYSTEM:  TEST SPECIES
Species
  No.
Latin Name
Common Name
235       CAMPELOMA DECISUM
239       PHYSA INTEGRA
263       COREGONUS CLUPEAFORMIS
283       CATOSTOMUS COMMERSONI
285       ICTALURUS NEBULOSUS
288       CULAEA INCONSTANS
290       LEPOMIS MEGALOTIS
293       ETHEOSTOMA SPECTABILE
302       PALAEMONETES PUGIO
308       MYSTUS VITTATUS
309       SKELETONEMA COSTATUM
346       HOMARUS AMERICANUS
352       HETEROPNEUSTES FOSSILUS
361       ORCONECTES VIRILIS
366       ARTEMIA SALINA
371       CYPRINODONTIDAE
375       MENIDIA MENIDIA
376       ACARTIA TONSA
407       NOTOPTERUS NOTOPTERUS
418       CHANNA PUNCTATUS
422       CIRRHINUS MRIGALA
423       BREVOORTIA TYRANNUS
436       BOWMANIELLA DISSIMILIS
466       NOTROPIS CORNUTUS
482       ALGAE
483       CHAOBORUS PUNCTIPENNIS
486       SELENASTRUM CAPRICORNUTUM
488       INVERTEBRATES
508       CERATOPHYLLUM DEMERSUM
522       RANGIA CUNEATA
540       HYDROPSYCHE SP
549       HIPPOLYTE SP
572       CATLA CATLA
574       ANGUILLA ANGUILLA
575       CRASSOSTREA GIGAS
578       ALOSA AESTIVALIS
602       ORCONECTES PROPINQUUS
639       OPHIOCEPHALUS PUNCTATUS
677       PTERONARCYS SP
713       MYSTUS  SEENGHALA
736       ONCORHYNCHUS KETA
892       ICTALURUS NATALIS
894       CLUPEA HARENGUS PALLASI
964       CHIRONOMUS  RIPARIUS
970       AMBYSTOMA OPACUM
988       BUCCINUM UNDATUM
                                    BROWN MYSTERY SNAIL
                                    POUCH SNAIL
                                    LAKE WHITEFISH
                                    WHITE SUCKER
                                    BROWN BULLHEAD
                                    BROOK STICKLEBACK
                                    LONGEAR SUNFISH
                                    ORANGETHROAT DARTER
                                    GRASS SHRIMP, FRESHWATER PRAWN
                                    CATFISH
                                    DIATOM
                                    AMERICAN LOBSTER
                                    INDIAN CATFISH
                                    CRAYFISH
                                    BRINE SHRIMP
                                    KILLIFISH, TOPMINNOW FAMILY
                                    ATLANTIC SILVERSIDE
                                    CALANOID COPEPOD
                                    FEATHERBACK
                                    SNAKE-HEAD CATFISH
                                    CARP, HAWKFISH
                                    ATLANTIC MENHADEN
                                    MYSID, OPOSSUM SHRIMP
                                    COMMON SHINER
                                    ALGAE, PHYTOPLANKTON, ALGAL MAT
                                    PHANTOM MIDGE
                                    GREEN ALGAE
                                    INVERTEBRATES
                                    COON-TAIL
                                    COMMON RANGIA OR CLAM
                                    CADDISFLY
                                    SHRIMP OR PRAWN
                                    CATLA
                                    COMMON EEL
                                    PACIFIC OYSTER
                                    BLUEBACK HERRING
                                    CRAYFISH
                                    SNAKEHEAD
                                    STONEFLY
                                    CATFISH
                                    CHUM SALMON
                                    YELLOW BULLHEAD
                                    PACIFIC HERRING
                                    MIDGE
                                    MARBLED SALAMANDER
                                    LARGE WHELK
                                      141

-------
TABLE 1 (cont'd) COMPLEX EFFLUENTS TOXICITY INFORMATION SYSTEM:  TEST SPECIES
Species
  No.
Latin Name
                                    Common Name
1022       CTENODRILUS SERRATUS
1074       NOTROPIS HETEROLEPIS
1132       NOTROPIS ANOGENUS
1133       NOTROPIS EMILIAE
1137       TUBIFEX SP
1140       CENTRARCHIDAE
1178       PAROPHRYS VETULUS
1186       BRANCHIURA SOWERBYI
1295       MYSIDOPSIS ALMYRA
1321       DAPHNIA SCHODLERI
1329       HEMIGRAPSUS SP
1369       BALANUS GLANDULA
1407       LEMNA SP
1527       HETERANDRIA FORMOSA
1570       OPHRYTROCHA LABRONICA
1584       BARBUS SOPHORE
1585       CHANNA MARULIUS
1586       ANISOGAMMARUS PUGETTENSIS
1587       LEPOMIS SP
1593       LEMNA PERPUSILLA
1619       POMOXIS SP
1620       HELIODIAPTOMUS VIDUUS
1738       NOTROPIS PERCOBROMUS
1739       NOTROPIS ZONATUS
1905       MACROBRACHIUM KISTNENSIS
1984       MYSIDACEA
1990       HYBOGNATHUS PLACITUS
1991       GLYPTOTENDIPES SP
2052       MERCENARIA CAMPECHIENSIS
2053       DONAX VARIABILIS TEXASIANA
2054       DINOPHILUS SP
2065       PHOXINUS SP
2107       PAGURUS BERNHARDUS
2108       GAMMARUS DAIBERI
2109       NEOMYSIS AMERICANA
2123       ONCHIDORIS FUSCA
2124       CANCER PAGURUS
2143       MENIDIA PENINSULAE
2190       MUDFISH
2191       SALVELINUS ALPINUS
2203       PSAMMECHINUS MILIARIS
                                    POLYCHAETE
                                    BLACKNOSE SHINER
                                    PUGNOSE SHINER
                                    PUGNOSE MINNOW
                                    TUBIFICID WORM
                                    SUNFISH FAMILY
                                    ENGLISH SOLE
                                    OLIGOCHAETE
                                    OPOSSUM SHRIMP
                                    WATER FLEA
                                    SHORE CRAB
                                    ROCK BARNACLE
                                    DUCKWEED
                                    LEAST KILLIFISH
                                    POLYCHAETE
                                    TWO SPOTTED BARB, DOTTED BARB
                                    SNAKE-HEAD CATFISH
                                    SCUD
                                    SUNFISH
                                    DUCKWEED
                                    CRAPPIE
                                    CALANOID COPEPOD
                                    FISH
                                    BLEEDING SHINER
                                    SHRIMP
                                    MYSID OR OPOSSUM SHRIMP ORDER
                                    PLAINS MINNOW
                                    MIDGE
                                    SOUTHERN QUAHOG
                                    COQUINA
                                    BRISTLE WORM
                                    DACE
                                    HERMIT CRAB
                                    SCUD
                                    OPOSSUM SHRIMP
                                    SEA SLUG, NUDIBRANCH
                                    EDIBLE OR ROCK CRAB
                                    TIDEWATER SILVERSIDE
                                    MUDFISH
                                    ARCTIC CHAR
                                    SEA URCHIN
The second highest data quality rating is given to published reports that
contain satisfactory etfluent collection methods and experimental proce-
dures but:
                                     142

-------
      - Standard test water chemistry data (D.O., pH, temperature, alkalinity,
        and hardness) were either only partially reported, or not reported
        at all.

      - Control mortality or other adverse effect was not reported, was high
        (greater than 10 percent) or was high but accounted for statistically.

      - Statistical methodology, used to determine the endpoint was not re-
        ported.

The third highest data quality rating is given to unpublished reports (such as
state and Federal agency studies) that document experimental procedures and
results.  The lowest quality rating is given to unpublished data sheets that
contain the raw test data and include minimal information about experimental
procedures.

      Bioassay test results may have different endpoints, and all of these are
accommodated within the CETTS.  For example, test results may be expressed as
median lethal concentration (LC50), median lethal time (LT50) values, or
median effective concentration (EC50).  EC50 values may be based on such
effects as abnormalities, growth, immobilization, or reproduction.  Effect
endpoints used are listed in Table 2.

      Any additional pertinent and useful information provided by the experi-
menter may be included in the data base as special observations.  This often
includes such items as use of an effluent carrier or solvent, whether test
organisms were fed or unfed, or any observations of unusual behavior or evi-
dence of stress.

TABLE 2.  EFFECT ENDPOINTS USED IN COMPLEX EFFLUENTS BIOASSAYS
ABD - Abundance:   number of organisms of the same species has changed within
      a population
ABN - Abnormalities:   physical deviations observed from normal control organ-
      isms
AVO - Avoidance:   organism avoids or is attracted to certain effluent concen-
      trations.
BEH - Behavior:  quantifiable change in activity that arose from exposure to
      internal or external stimuli
BIO - Biochemical Effect:  physiochemical reactions (e.g., change in glycogen
      levels) occurring within the organism on a cellular level
CYT - Cytogenetic Effect:  genetic mutation on a cellular level
DIS - Disease:  impairment of vital functions observed as a result of efflu-
      ent concentrations, specific infective agents, inherent organism de-
      tects, or a combination of these factors
ENZ - Enzyme Effect:   deviations in enzyme activity
FCR - Food Consumption Rate:  quantifiable change in rate of food consumed by
      test animal
GRO - Growth:  measured increase of animal size in length and/or weight
HAT - Hatchability:  percent hatch


                                     143

-------
 HEM - Hematological Effect:   changes in the blood parameters observed
 HIS - Histological Effect:   indicated by the presence of lesions or other
       damage to tissues
 MOR - Mortality - percentage of dead organisms
 MOT - Motility:   change  in  locomotor behavior
 OC  - Oxygen Consumption:   change in 0-^ uptake in animals
 PGR - Population Growth:   increase or decrease in growth of an algal popula-
       tion (e.g.,  change  in  cell number)
 POP - Population:   change in the species  composition or diversity
 PSE - Photosynthesis Effect:   change in plant productivity
 RES - Respiratory Rate:   change in respiratory rate of vertebrates, inverte-
       brates
 RSD - Residue:   toxicant  uptake by tissues  of test organism
 SS  - Swimming  Speed:  change in swimming speed
 STR - Stress:   observed physiological tension in  animals or plants
 TMR - Tumor  Occurrence: presence of  a mass  of abnormal tissue
                                   RESULTS

      Data from 500 references for 1500 bioassay  tests  are  in  the  CETIS  data
 base as of June 1S)84.  These comprise data from 140  published  papers  (2050
 tests) and from 900 state data sheets (2600 tests).  The  data  currently  in-
 clude intormation from 16 states in  the United States and from Canada.

      Entered data also are transmitted to a larger  computer system at the
 National Computer Center in Raleigh, North Carolina.  These data are  cross-
 reierenced with corresponding data from other data bases  at the National
 Computer Center.  These are the Industrial Facilities Discharge (IFD) file,
 which is linked to the United States Geological Survey  river gage  level  file
 (GAGE) by way of a hydrologic network file (REACH).  By these  linkages,
 cross-reterenced information from the Industrial Facilities Discharge file,
 river gage level file, and hydrologic network file are  included in the CETIS
 data base.  Figures 1 and 2 provide schematic diagrams  of the  overall data
 base management system, showing the ERL-Duluth and National Computer Center
 portions.

      Computer programs have been prepared to search and  sort  through the
 data base to retrieve compiled information.  These template retrievals are
 available to provide data selected by industry, area or receiving  water,
 test, test species, and effluent treatment.  A total data listing  for up to
 eight references can also be obtained.  Table 3 provides  a  summary of re-
 trieval options.  Figure 3 is an example of a template  retrieval output
 sorted by test.   Users can also design and implement specific  retrievals of
 their own design to obtain data from the system.   A user's  guide and pro-
grammer's manual describe these programs in detail (Gueldner et al. 1984).
Development of programs is underway to analyze the effluent toxicity data to
provide comparisons between organisms, effluents,  and bioassay endpoints.
                                     144

-------
REVIEWERS ENCODE
DATA & ASSIGN A
QUALITY REVIEW
CODE
\
/
DATA ENTRY
OPERATORS ENTER
DATA INTO
PDF 11/70 AT ERL-D
                                                                      HARD COPY
                                                                      IS PRINTED
                                                             ERL-D

                                                              POP

                                                             11/70
COMPUTER OUTPUT
IS DOUBLE PROOFED
AGAINST THE CODING
FORMS FOR ERRORS
                                                                      CORRECTIONS
                                                                      OR APPROVAL
                                                                      CODE IS
                                                                      ENTERED INTO
                                                                      THE DATA FILES
                                                                            \L
                                                                  DATA IS FORMATTED FOR
                                                                  TRANSMISSION TO THE
                                                                  IBM COMPUTER AT NCC
Figure 1.  CETIS at ERL-Duluth

-------
      STORET
THE "PRE-SCAN" PROGRAM ON THE IBM COMPUTER
AT NCC COMPARES INCOMING CETIS DATA WITH
EXISTING DATA ON THE GAGE, IFD,  AND REACH
DATA BASES.  BOTH SETS OF DATA ARE STORED
IN A TEMPORARY FILE.
CTi
                                                  TEMPORARY IHS
                                                      FILE
                                                       AT
                                                      NCC
           RECORDS ARE SELECTED
           FOR INCLUSION IN THE
           PERMANENT CETIS DATA
           BASE
                                                                                  HARD COPY REPORTS
                                                                                  ARE PRINTED AND
                                                                                  PROOFED
                   PROGRAM OFFICES,
                   REGIONS, STATES
                   AND OTHER AGENCIES
                   ACCESS THE DATA BASE
                                               THE TEMPLATE SYSTEM IS
                                               USED FOR PACKAGED
                                               RETRIEVALS AND REPORTS
                                                                                             V
                                           SPECIAL PURPOSE PROGRAMS CAN
                                           BE DESIGNED AND WRITTEN TO
                                          PERFORM SPECIFIC RETRIEVALS
                                                    RETRIEVALS CAN
                                                    BE INTERFACED
                                                    WITH SAS
        Figure 2.  CETIS at National  Computer  Center

-------
TABLE 3.  CETIS REPORT SPECIFICATION SUMMARY RETRIEVAL OPTIONS
Report Options
Select Options
Sort Options
Format Options
Industry Report
 Industrial
  Category
 SIC Codes*
SIC Codes b State
State & SIC Codes
 Brief Format
 Expanded Format
 SAS Format Disk
  File
Area or Receiving
 Water Report
 Eight-digit
  Catalog Unit
 Eight-digit
  Catalog Unit &
  three-digit
  Segment Number
 Basin Code
 State
Catalog Unit &
 Segment Number
NPDES Number!
 Brief Format
 Expanded Format
 SAS Format Disk
 Test Report
 Bioassay Type 1
 Bioassay Type 2
 Exposure Type
 Test Duration
NPDES Number
SIC Code
 Brief Format
 Expanded Format
 SAS Format Disk
  File
 Test  Species Report
 Test Species
 Litestage
NPDES Number
SIC Code
 Brief Format
 Expanded Format
 SAS Format Disk
  File
 Effluent Treatment
  Report
 NPDES Number
 SIC Code
 Effluent
  Treatment
NPDES Number
SIC Code
Low Flow
Discharge Flow
 Brief Format
 Expanded Format
 SAS Format Disk
  File
 Total Data Listing
  Report
 Reference
  Numbers
Not applicable
 Full Data Listing
 Format
 *SIC  code =  Standard  Industrial  Classification  Code
 TNPDES  number =  National  Pollutant  Discharge  Elimination System Number
                 (discharge  number)
                                      147

-------

00
Th.SI1 DAfF
EKI.007JB5GOO
/ /
/ /
/ /
/ /

GAFl>00009oou
BM/nh/^b

M0/0b/2b

M1EOOOOI luou
74/1 i/ia
OHEOOOOI7UCJU
7b/0b/30

7S/08/21

73/11/21

/ /

ClHEIHlOO IHHOO
7b/u3/03

OHE000054DOU
73/11/12

73/11/12

OHEDOOObhOOU
73/10/lU

73/IO/ld
.
OlieuOOObToO"
73/10/23

73/1 1 /id

OHEUCuObHuOu
73/10/24

73/1 I/O 1

OHED0005900U
73/lu/ Jo

73/10/30

FXP. Hill.
•*9b2
1 F A




405?
ISA

2 S it

<«4b2
1 F A
4Sb2
1 A

i A

i S A

4 S A

49b2
1 A

4952
1 S A

2 S A

49b,2
1 S A

2 S A

49b2
1 S A

1 S A

4152
1 S A

i S *

49b2
1 S A

2 S A

Bid.
TYC-2

C





C

C


C

C

C

C

C


C


C

C


C

C


C

C


C

C


C

C

nsi
nun.

H4
M
1 1 /
11?


1

1


4

4



4

2


4


4

2


4

2


4

2


4

?


4

2

SHtriF.S

23





1

b


1

I

1

1

a


i


i

7


1

1


1

B


1

H


1

7

CHNC.

1.1
J.b
1 .1
J.b


Jb

47


1.7

45

100

100

100


100


13

2b


100

8b


100

H3


100

100


42

32

CDNC. RANGE; EFFECT
OU FH TEMP ALK





.7 13.7 106.7

LC50
b.4 125
LiCSO
b.4 22 125

LCSO

LC&O
7 21

21

7 21 315

7 21 31S


7.6 21

LCSO
7.5 21
LC50
7.t> 21


7.2 21
LCbO
7.2 21


7.2 21
LC50
7.2 21


7.3 21

7.3 21

LC5U
/ . b 21
LC50
7.b 21
HAR








100

too




260



262

262





242

242


82

82


238

238


200

200


384

384
     Figure 3.   Example of CETIS retrieval system test report—expanded format

-------
                                 ACKNOWLEDGMENT

      Many individuals have been involved with the Complex Effluents Toxicity
Information System, and their contributions are gratefully acknowledged.
Bruce Newton has provided invaluable suggestions on data base development.
Kenneth Carlson, Doretfce Gueldner, Charles Marks, Jeanne Rondeau, Daniel
Sivertson, and Phillip Taylor contributed to programming tasks.  Cay Moriarity,
Beth Nordling, and Eve Katich assisted with reviewing and encoding of data.
Dorette Gueldner and Judy Veith have worked as data entry operators.  PEDCO
Environmental, Inc., assisted with reviewing, encoding, and entering data.

                                  REFERENCES

American Public Health Association, American Water Works Association, and
    Water Pollution Control Federation.  1981.  Standard methods for the
    examination of water and wastewater, 15th ed.  Am. Public Health Assoc.,
    New York.  1134 p.

American Society for Testing and Materials.  1980.  Standard practice for
    conducting acute toxicity tests with fishes, macroinvertebrates, and
    amphibians.  pp. 1-25 in Annual Book of ASTM Standards.

Gueldner, D.R., A. Pilli, J.L. Crane, and D.J. Sivertson.  1984.  CETIS:
    Complex Effluents Toxicity Information System.  CETIS retrieval system
    user's manual.  EPA/600/8-84-030, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
    Duluth, Minnesota.  (In press).  10 p.

Gueldner, D.R., D.J. Sivertson, and A. Pilli.  1984.,  CETIS:  Complex
    Effluents  Toxicity Information System.  Programmer's manual.  U.S. Envi-
    ronmental  Protection Agency, Duluth, Minnesota.  (Unpublished report).
    92 p.

Peltier, W.   1978.  Methods -for measuring the acute toxicity of effluents
    to aquatic organisms.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.  Cincinnati,
    Ohio.  EPA-600/4-78-012.

Peltier, W., and C.I. Weber.  1984.  Methods for measuring the acute toxicity
    of effluents to freshwater and marine organisms.  U.S.  Environmental
    Protection Agency, Cincinnati, Ohio.  EPA/600/4-85/013.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.  1971.  Algal assay procedure bottle
    test.  Nat. Eutrophication Res. Pro.  82 p.

Weber, C.I., and W. Peltier.  1981  Effluent toxicity screening test using
    daphnia and mysid shrimp.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
    Cincinnati, Ohio.  (Unpublished report.)
                                     149

-------
       OPTIMIZING A PROGRAM FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF WATER CONSERVATION
             IN A SYSTEM OF WATER  QUALITY MANAGEMENT  CONSIDERING
                   POINT AND NON-POINT POLLUTION  SOURCES

                                      by

                             G. A. Sukhorukov^
                                  ABSTRACT

     A mathematical model is examined for optimizing a program ot gradual
 and  coordinated development of water conservation measures  for achieving
 standard water quality.  The model includes a unit for the  development of
 new  production methods, a unit for the development of procedures for pro-
 cessing and recovering waste waters,  including the establishing of inter-
 sectorial and regional reusable systems, and a unit for  forming water
 quality.

     For selecting the optimum program tor gradually achieving standard
 water quality, a quadratic criterion has been proposed tor  the accuracy of
 achieving the maximum tolerable effluents.  For considering the impact of
 non-point pollution sources and tor calculating the maximum acceptable
 etfiuents, two approaches have been examined—determined and probability.
 A system and model also have been proposed for calculating  the optimum water
 conservation measures according to the criterion ot the minimum mathematical
 expectation of the loss functions.
                                INTRODUCTION

     Long-term and current forecasting and planning of water-protection
measures are tasks of utmost importance in the control of water quality.
Unlike ongoing control, where such parameters as capacity of industrial and
water sources are considered to be relatively stable,  long-term and current
planning includes such parameters as the basic controllable variables.
Thus, long-term and current planning tasks determine the general task of
controlling development of water protection measures.

     The complexity ot developing water protection measures is the reason
for the urgency and necessity of developing mathematical models for optimizing
 Ail-Union Scientific Research  Institute of Water  Protection,  USSR Ministry
 of Land Reclamation and Water  Resources, Kharkov,  USSR
                                     150

-------
development ot industrial and water protection  complexes,  and  adopting  wide
use of computers.

     Analysis ot the survey literature  (Vavilin and  Tsitkin  1977)  and other
sources shows that formulation  ot  the  tasks  of  optimum development of water
protection was based on optimization ot parameters of  treatment  plants  as
the basic water protection measure.  In a  number of  instances, such tasks
included optimization of water  drawdown.   As  a  rule, such  tasks  were static
(single step) and did not include  units for  optimization of  production
technology, which is the main factor that  influences the quantity  and
composition of diverted water prior  to purification.

     The urgency of the problem ot coordinated  development of  production
technology and treatment  (purification) technology and the use of  diverted
water had been repeatedly discussed in the literature;  several models with
a high unitization level  determining the  correlation between development of
industry and environmental protection  were proposed  (Anon. 19ttZ).   At the
same time, there is still the pressing problem  ot developing mathematical
models and methods of optimizing coordinated  development ot  technology  01
production, processing, and utilization ot diverted  water  and  water-use
tehnology on the level of an individual enterprise or  a set  ot enterprises
united by intersector water management systems.

     It is expressly on this level, for enterprises, that  the  key  parameters
are determined:  maximum  permissible discharge  ot impurities into  water
projects, plans tor development ot industry,  and water protection  measures
consistent with the plans for construction of installations.  On the basis
ot the foregoing, we are  considering models  for optimization of  a  set of
water protection measures as a  set of  models  for optimization  ot industry
and its development (Industry unit), models  for optimization of  treatment
and use ot diverted water (Treatment and  utilization unit),  and  models  ot
processes within water reservoirs  (Water  system).

     The dynamic nature ot development of  industry and water protection, the
multistage nature ot development ot industry  and water protection, and  the
multistage planning ot such development (in  5-year periods)  determine the
need to develop multistep, dynamic models  of  optimizaton ot  programs tor
coordinated development of industrial  and water protection complexes.   The
inherent distinction of such models  is that  there are  intermediate and  end
goals ot development and  criteria  ot optimality for  effectiveness  of
achieving these goals stage by  stage.

     Bearing in mind the  above-mentioned  distinctions  ot optimization of
the set of water protection measures,  we  developed a system  of optimization
models tor coordinated development ot  industry  and water protection, which
is based on the method of building dynamic models of developing  systems
(bukhorukov 1977).

     Such models are designed for  use  in  developing  current  and  future
plans and torecasts.   In  such developments,  the choice ot  methods  ot
considering nonpoint sources ot pollution—surface runoff  from cities  and
farms—is ot  substantial  significance. This must also be  reflected in the


                                     151

-------
models of optimization of programs for development  of water  protection,  and
the problem arises of considering  the random nature of  processes of removal
of. superficial runolt.
             MODELS FOR OPTIMIZATION OF PROGRAMS OF DEVELOPMENT
                            OF WATER PROTECTION

     Let us examine moaels tor optimization of developing  systems  ot  tech-
nological complexes.  We shall use the term,  technological complex (TK) ,  to
reter to the interrelated aggregate of units  (.elements ot  complex)  that
affect physical, energetic, and informational conversion in order  to  obtain
a specified end result 01 production.

     A developing system will be considered given (.specified)  if the  follow-
ing has been determined:

     A.  Finite set of points in time or steps, T = (t) limited by  interval
of development  10, TJ , aggregate of sets, elements ot which are the following
non-negative phase variables (.vectors):  Y(.t) — end results  ot  development,
Y(t=U) = Y(0) — original state Y(t), V(t) --- current control;  Z(.t) — status  of
system determining maximum production capacity and its initial state  Z(.t=U)
= Z(U), u(t) — control of system development,  i.e., control of  development
ot production capacities, $t — external resources, o)t — assignment beyond
purpose of development.

     B.  Model of object of control that determines its "physical"  properties,
as a set ot equations such as:
Criterion ot optimaiity ot development
Set of restrictions on phasic variables:
- resources     t €  j"                                                 (.4)
- goals ot development  V C"t} G  t^C*
(3)
     In these expressions, we use the term, program ot development,  to
refer to the aggregate of vectors of phasic variables X(.t) =  LY(t)   VU)
Z(t), UU)J.
                                     152

-------
    nln essence, optimization ot development programs consists of selecting
set x(t) on te T, with which the system changes from base state Z(U) to
states Z(i)...Z(t)...Z(T) as a result of controlling development—u(l)...
u(t)...u(T)—so that current equations—v(l)...v(t)...v(T)—lead to achieve-
ment of end results—y(l)...y(t)...y(T) , which meet externally given goals
of development (5), provided the extreme is  reached lor the given criterion
of optimality ot development (2).  The set ot restrictions (i, 3, 4) that
determine the correlation between phasic variables and restrictions tor
each of them (3), as well as restrictions on resources (4) allocated for
development (capital investments, etc.)—31...3t...3T—that are considered
given, are also important to choice of optimum program.

     Proceeding from the general model of optimization of development (1-5)
and models of special-purpose programmed planning, let us formulate a typi-
cal problem of optimization of program of development ot technology of  the
complex in the following rather simple form:
                                                      1
                                                            mm  ..    (6)
                                                                       IB)
                                        G U-
 yC-fc)e
 *            •• t               .*                 '   —      -       -)
where fv and fu  are operating and capital expenditures with consideration
of  adduction,  B  is matrix ot direct expenses,  D is matrix of  production
capacity expenses, y is vector of end product, v is vector of total product
(current production control), z is vector of production capacity,  u is
vector of control ot development ot production capacity, fi is the set ot
given end goals,  V and U are sets detemining restrictions on v(t), u(t) and
teT, z(0) is  the initial state of production capacity with consideration
ot  equipment no  longer used.

     Solution  of  problems (b-lU) yields the optimum program for ongoing
control v(t) and development u(t) ot the technological state with consideration
of  its base state z(U) and need to achieve intermediate and end goals wc in
interval [I, TJ.

     Let us turn to construction of a model for optimization ol development
of  a set of water protection measures for a basin (region).  We shall pro-
ceed from the  following premises.
                                     153

-------
     1.  The model defines Che set of measures directed toward improvement
and development of technology of production, technology of  treatment  and
utilization of diverted water with consideration of development of intersector
water-management systems, and technology of water use related  to  increase
in assimilating capacity of the water system in question *.as a result of
drawdown from reservoirs, diversion of run-off, etc.).  Accordingly,  three
units are distinguished in the model — "Industry," "Treatment and utilization,"
"Water system."

     2.  The tasks of releasing the end product and locating the plant are
considered to be given for planning intervals, since their  estimation is
made on a higher level in the hierarachy of national economic planning.

     3.  Standards for water quality considered set and tied in with given
specified check: section lines, which is determined by the type of water use
on a river section.

     4.  The water-consuming enterprise, which is characterized by the
following elements, is an elementary subsystem of the model:  discharge of
liquid waste, unit with given technology of production or treatment of
diverted water.

     5.  The overall task of optimizing development is separated into two
tasks, which are, in general terms, as follows:

         Optimization of development of set of  water protection
         measures for the entire planning period 10, TJ ,  consisting
         of more than one 5-year interval according to criterion of
         minimal adduced expenditures in the absence of  restrictions
         on external resources.

         Optimization of development of set of  water protection measures
         tor the first and subsequent 5-year periods in the presence of
         restrictions on overall capital investments,  according to cri-
         terion of minimal A between given values for maximum permissible
         discharge (MPD) of substances for which standards are set (.in
         each enterprise) and level of obtained discharge of substances,
         values of MPD are found by solving the first problem.

     Each pair of problems is solved every 5 years with a shift made so
that MPD is recalculated in every 5-year period.

     Let us consider the task of optimizing development of  the set of water
protection measures for the period 10, TJ  for a set of enterprises
which contains the following components.
     Criterion of optimality — overall adduced expenses:
                                                                       Ui)
                                                                  H» vnin,
                                                                    ">v
                                     154

-------
     I.   "Industry" unit—Kth enterprise,


                                                                         (12)



                                                                         (13)
where B^l' is the technological matrix of production  balance^ D(^)  is matrix
of coefficients of specific expenditures of unit  output, V^1' =  (vS1') is
total output of the ith type of product on  the S^th unit or by the 0-j_th tech-
nology.   u(U = (U^l') is the vector of buildup of production capacity of the
6-|_th unit, Z^Ho, I) = (z£J )) is the vector of initial status of production
capacity of the 6j_th unit with consideration of removal of capacities from
use, U^D is the set determining specific restrictions on control u^).

     II.  "Treatment and utilization" unit, xth enterprise,  KeK  equations
of balance of consumption of fresh, recycled and  reused water, balance of
water diversion
                                                                        (15)
                          oo
                          K  -

where MK is the matrix of standards of water  consumption  according  to cate-
gory (fresh water, industrial), G^>^' is matrix of standards of water diver-
sion (according to categories of run-off),  e1,  e11, e111,  eIV are zero-unit
[?] structural matrices, V^^ is vector  of  outlay  of  diverted water treated
via different technological routes seS.  Set  SK is broken down into the fol-
lowing nonintersecting subsets:  S]^ treatment and  discharge  into water sys-
tem, Sj recycled and reused for own use, S^ treatment and transfer  to other
enterprises i PK = (P^, P^) is outlay of  consumed fresh  wate_r, including P£
from superficial sources and P1^ from subterranean  sources, PK is limit on
water consumption and m^ is outlay of water coming from other enterprises.
where Kn is set of enterprises situated  in  the  same industrial region or
city where it is feasible to organize intersector water-management  systems,


                                     155

-------
system of inequalities that take into consideration development  of  production
capacity of the "Treatment and utilization" unit.

where D is the matrix of coefficients of specific expenditures  of  production
capacity of units, u(^) = (U^)) is vector of buildup of production capacity,
Z^)(0, T) = Z^?)) is the vector of initial status of production capacity of
  th unit with consideration of capacity no longer used.

     III.  "Water system1" unit.

System of recurrent equations of transfer and transformation of impurities:


                                                                        (20)
where K+l, K are numbers of estimated section lines in stream, A7 and Av are
matrices of coefficients that consider dilution, self purification and  trans-
formation of impurities, which also depend on expenditure increment in  the
section (ic+l, K), YK+i  is vector of concentrations of impurities for which
standards are set in the water system, G     is the matrix of concentrations
of impurities in sewage after treatment, b  is vector of uncontrolled dis-
charge of impurities,
system of restrictions on water quality in control section lines


                                                                        (21)


where Z is goal matrix, w(3) is vector of water quality standards  (.with con-
sideration of LPV [expansion unknown]).

     System of recurrent equations of water balance.


                                                            ~* '         (22)
                                     156

-------
where YOK+1 and YOK are estimated outlay  of water  in section  lines  <+l  and
K; XK is influx in the section  (K+! , K) with  consideration  of  water-manage-
ment balance, 6y.Oi< is increment of  expenses  due to drawdown from reservoirs,
diversion of run-off, etc., YO|C+^ is minimal  environment-protective outlay,
E^ is zero-unit structural  matrix.
     System of equations determining  feasiblity  of  increasing  diluting
capacity of water  system:
                               =y         fcfe                      (23)
where vy3' is additional  outlay  from Jith water-management  system (reservior,
canal) in the &th section line,  aQ' is  coefficient of  influence  ((Ka(3)o.) ?
u|3) is increment of indicators  of production  capacity  of  Jlth water-manage-
ment system, d(3) is coefficient of  specific expenditures  of production capac-
ity of &th system, V^) and u'^) are sets  defining specific restrictions.
                                                                      o
     As a result of solving problems (11-25),  the optimum  values  for  v(T)
and u(T) are calculated,  which determine all  the necessary water-management
characteristics:

     Input of capacities  into  "Industry,"  "Treatment  and utilization" and
     "Water system" units.

     Volumes (expenditures) of fresh,  recycled,  reused  water, volumes of
     water discharged  according  to  type  of treatment  (purification).

     Capital [fixed asset] and operating expenses for implementation  of
     integrated measures.

     Maximum permitted dumping of pollutants  into water systems  of
     different  enterprises.

                           * ^    /•> \     A / * V             »
                                                                        (26)
where E, is  the  type  of  substance for which standard is being set, g    is
concentration of  substance  in sewage after treatment via sth route ^element
of matrix
                                      157

-------
     Calculation of w^  is probably one of the most important  results  of
the problem, which permit in the next step solving the set of local  problems
for the first 5-year planning period in order to define  the  priority water-
protection measures.  Let us consider, in order to describe  formulation of
such problems, a hierarchically organized system with  the following  elements:
a) restrictions on overall capital expenditures in the basin (region) and
global criterion of optimality, b) set of local systems  for  individual  enter-
prises, or set of several enterprises (industrial centers, cities) — neN.

     We shall use the previously introduced definitions  and  designations to
form the optimization problem.

     Global criterion of optimality is the minimum sum of squares of discrep-
ancies determining a mismatch between values and MPD — $(2) ancj  obtained dis-
posal of impurities for which standards are set.
where C K is the vector of discrepancies [ errors] and R is a positively
difined matrix (in particular, R = E) .

     Global restrictions on total capital expenditures for the basin (region
are.
                                                                       (28)


where yn is scalar coordinating parameter.

     Restrictions on overall capital expenditures allocated for development
of the industry and water-protection measures of the nth subsystem are:
'Industry" unit of Kth subsystem,  KeK:

                                          .iV""'*  \
                                                                       (30)



                                                                       (31)



                                                                       (32)
                                        *- K *"'

                                    158

-------
where U^'U) is the set of controls of development, elements of which are
defined by solving the preceding problem for the period  [0, Tj.

"Processing and utilization" unit:

              .CO. .    £?!
a)
                                               c
                                               o
                                                                       (35)

                                                                       (37)
where G  is the matrix,  the elements of which are found b^ dividing concen-
trations of impurities (elements of matrix G^2)) by MPD — WP, U2^!) is
 set of equations of controls of development, elements of which are found from
 solving the preceding problem for the period [0, Tj , and e^ is a unit vector.

     As can be seen from  (27-37), the model of  the water is not considered,
 since restrictions on impurity discharge with sewage is determined by MPD.

     The problem we have  discussed  (27-37) contains neN local subsystems,
 each of which corresponds to an industrial center, city or agglomeration and
 urban centers and industrial enterprises, agricultural enterprises where
 there is a potential possibility of establishing intersector water-management
 systems, including general treatment plants, local and intersector recycling.
 Expressly such a structure of systems of treatment and utilization is in-
 herent in all industrially developed regions, so that planning tasks should
 solve the actually ocurring problems of intersector cooperation.  Of course,
 in the special case, each subsystem can contain only one enterprise.

     The above tasks were defined in continuous (nonintegral) variables,
 which makes it possible to obtain the "absolutely best" result, as compared
 to integral formulation.  Problems  (27-37) can  be solved in integral formu-
 lation, if this is necessary, by different methods.  One method involves
 introduction of integral  variables  in the following manner,  variables UQ
 are replaced with the following expression:
                                     159

-------
where 6 j is the optimizing variable, UQJ is the given numerical series of
unified values for production capacities.

     Another, simpler method with regard to calculations, involves finding
the closest integral solution UQJ _> Ug.

     On the whole, choice of problem solving method depends on the type of
functional and functions contained in the system of restrictions.  In the
case of several simplifications, the problems can be reduced to problems of
mathematical linear (LP) and convex programming with use of standard packages
of applied LP programs in automated control systems.  Problems (27-37) are
solved on two levels using a parametric noninteractive procedure (Sukhorukov
1977).

     It should be noted that, along with use of systems (11-26, 27-37) in
the optimization mode, such systems can be well-used in the direct reading
mode for making forecasts for the period [.0, Tj or any intervals It, t-1).
In addition to obtaining a practical result—for example, forecasting water
quality—such a mode makes it possible to determine some initial approxima-
tion for optimization problems.
     CONSIDERATION OF NONPOINT SOURCES OF POLLUTION WITH DETERMINISTIC
                 AND PROBABILISTIC FORMULATION OF PROBLEMS

     Because of the specific nature of nonpoint sources of pollution of sur-
face run-off in cities and farms, they can be taken into consideration in
optimizing water-protective measures in two ways:  a) removal of impurities
from non-point sources is considered uncontrollable (unoptimizable) in the
general model, depending only on the characteristics of the water catchment
area and precipitation, as components of hydrological calculations, b) re-
moval of impurities also depends on the set of water protection measures for
decontamination of superficial run-off, which are characterized by optimiz-
able variables.  These variables are analogous to those discussed above, and
they are included in the "Industry" unit (for example, change in technology
of agriculture) and "Treatment and utilization" unit (for example, treatment
of a city's surface run-off).

     In both the first and second instances, there can be both deterministic
and probabilistic formulation of the problem.

     With deterministic formulation of the problem, the system of models
described above remains unchanged in structure, merely new elements (opti-
mizable and unoptimizable) are added to the "Water system" unit (2022).  The
difficulty lies in estimating the unoptimizable removal of impurities with
superficial run-off.  In addition to other methods, this can be calculated
by separating the superficial component of run-off in a river section per
month from the aggregate of surface and underground runoff under specified
nominal conditions, for example, in a year of 95% supply.  Then, on the basis
of the charateristics of the water catchment area, determination is made of
mean concentration of impurities in superficial run-off and removal of impuri-
ties in water system averaged for a month.  The advantages of such an approach


                                      160

-------
is that removal of impurities with superficial  run-off  is  tied  in  to nominal
hydrological conditions, and  it  is possible  to  consider the  joint  effect  of
point and nonpoint sources on water quality  under  the same estimated condi-
tions, as well as to build a  deterministic model of  optimization of level
of decontamination of superficial run-of.  A comprehensive method  was devel-
oped on the basis of such an  approach (Pasyuga  1985) and has been  used  in
practice.

     At the same time, the physical nature of such processes as  removal of
impurities with surface run-off  in cities and outlay of water in the stream
is in the nature of random processes  with considerable  deviation frW mean
values, which is why probabilistic approaches are  relevant.   In  this case,
to build models of optimization with  consideration of random processes, an
approach is proposed, in which the criterion of optimum (minimum or maximum)
mathematical expectation of loss function is  used  as the optimality criterion,
which take into consideration the probabilistic characteristics  of the
random process.

     Let us discuss in greater detail the method of building optimization
models with consideration of  the probabilistic  factor.   Let  us add to our con-
sideration the vector of set  of optimizing variables w  = (v,  u), vector of
set of parameters of water quality y  = CyK)  to  Kelt of control section lines,
as well as vector of set of nominal parameters  aeQ, which  determines removal
of impurities with surface run-off.   The same vector may include other nomi-
nal parameters:  nominal debit of river, self-purification coefficients, etc.

     In these terms, the single-step  problem of  optimizing water-protection
measures with given nominal parameters has the  following appearance


                                                                        (38)
                                                                        (39)
where f is a  function  defining  expenses  for water-protection measures  and  is
the set of permissible concentrations of  impurities  (maximum permissible
concentration, MFC), for  example,  ft =  {y^-.y MPC,


                                     161

-------
MFC, when there is infraction of water quality standards and loss  could  be
defined as detriment to water consumers with use of polluted water,  in the
fish industry and other sectors of the national economy (Anono 1982).  On
the other hand, these losses could equal losses related to  the basic industry,
either expenses for compensatory measures (drawdown from reservoirs,  addi-
tional treatment before using water, and finally, enterprise shut-down).

     If the values of z; are such that y(ct)>y(c)
-------
    o Determination of  function of losses of two types:  loss due to in-
      adequate actual level of water-protection measures for the actual
      discharge of  water in the channel [or water course] and loss related
      to implementation of water-protection measures, the efficacy of
      which exceeds the minimum required level for actual discharge of
      water in channel.

     o Determination of  mathematical expectation of overall losses at given
      planned (nominal)levels of water discharge in channel, as well as
      possible variations of water quality.

     o Determination of  optimum nominal discharge of water in channel in
      order to plan water-protection measures on the basis of minimizing
      mathematical  expectation of total loss at given densities of
      probability of random values.

     o Determination is  made of final solutions to problem of selection of
      water-protection measures with optimum nominal discharge.

     Water discharge in a channel (river) was chosen as the sole nominal
parameter for the following reasons.  In the first place, such a parameter
is the basic factor  in forming water quality and it is also a random varia-
ble. The methods of building probabilistic characteristics of discharge
and run-off have been well-studied.  In the second place, surface run-off
and river discharge  are related by balance functions, so that one can con-
struct the characteristics of a one-dimensional random process determining
removal  of an impurity with surface run-off and variations in river discharge.
For this reason, one can select a certain minimal discharge as r^m±n in (40),
and then a is the sought nominal discharge.
                   SOME PRACTICAL RESULTS AND CONCLUSIONS

     Practical studies of the above-discussed models of optimization and fore-
casting of coordinated development of industry and water-protection complexes
remain to be done in order to develpo rather complicated systems of software
for computers, as well as a series of digital experiments,  including those
for actual systems.  For this purpose, a problem-oriented package of variable
programs (PPP) for forecasting water quality and optimizing waterprotection
measures, and some program complexes forming as a whole the OKVOPLAN (optimum
integrated water-protection planning and forecasting) were  developed at the
Ail-Union Institute of Water Protection.

     Calculations on a computer with use of the above-mentioned models yielded
the following results:

     o Determination was made of MPD that are optimum with respect to minimal
       expenditures for water-protection measures for several river basins.
       The "Treatment and utilization" and "Water system" units, and surface
       runoff in the deterministic variant were taken into consideration.
       The variants of development of industrial technology were set on the
       basis of the results of multivariant forecasting  (direct reading).


                                     163

-------
     o A study was made of the etticacy of developing intersector water-
       management systems with optimization of technology for utilization
       of heat of water from heat and electric power plants (TES) to meet
       the needs of the fish industry and agriculture.  The calculations
       revealed that there was substantial reduction of expenditures for
       development of industry and water protection in the intersector
       complex (TES, hothouse, irrigation system, fishery).  The decline
       of expenses constituted about 100% with 1 MW increment in TES
       capacity.

     o A study was made of the efficacy of introduction ot new technolo-
       gies for steel production with out blast furnace in ferrous metal-
       lurgy, and effect on expenditure indicators for the water-protection
       complex.

     o A study was made of probabilistic run-off on choice of optimum
       water-protection measures, with determination of the need to estab-
       lish different nominal river discharge, depending on the concrete
       situation.  Standard nominal discharge at the 95% level is usually
       not the optimum according to the meaning of (40).

     On the whole, our studies lead to the conclusion that coordinated devel-
opment of industrial technology and water-protection technology makes it
possible to reach the production goals and those of environmental protection
at substantially less cost than if they are developed separately.  Further-
more, an optimum combination of rates of development in the "Industry and
"Treatment and utilization" units leads to substantial improvement of pro-
duction efficiency indicators with concurrent solution of problems of water
protection.

     The difficulty of calculating optimum programs of coordinated develop-
ment of industrial and water-protection technological complexes makes it
necessary to develop special methods to design efficient routines tor the
computer.  One method of constructing such routines is described in the
Appendix.
                                BIBLIOGRAPHY

Anon. 1982.  Okhrana okruzhayushchey:   model! sotsiai'no-ekonomicheskogo
     prognoza (Environmental Protection;   Models of Socioeconomic Forecasting).

Korn, G. and T. Korn 1973.  Spravochnik po matematike dlya nauchnykh
     rabotnikov i inzhenerov (Guide of Mathematics for Scientific Workers and
     Engineers).  Moscow, USSR.  831.

Pasyuga, N. P- 1985.  Hydorlogical support of development of set of
     water-protection measures in:  Regulirovaniye kachestva prirodnyich vod
     (Control of Quality of Natural Waters).  Kharkov, USSR,  pp 79-87.

Pervozvanskiy, A. A. 1975.  Matematicheskiye modeli v upravienii proizvodstvom
     (Mathematical Models in Control of Industry).  Moscow, USSR.  bib.

                                    164

-------
Pospelov, G. S. and V. A. Irikov 1976.  Programmno-tselevoye planirovaniye
     i upravleniye.  Vvedniye (Special-Purpose programmed Planning and Control.
     Introduction), Moscow, USSR.  440.

Suk.norukov, G. A. 1977.  Planning production and development in hierarchic
     control systems in:  Modeli i metody analiza ekonomicheskikh
     tselenapravlennykh sistem (.Models and Methods of Analysis of Economic
     Goal-Oriented Systems).  Novosibirsk, USSR,   pp 58-71.

Vavilin, V. A. and M. Yu. Tsitkin 1977.  Mathematical modeling and
     control of water environment.  (5): 114-132.

Volgin, L. N. 1968.  Problema optimal"nostey v teoreticheskoy kibernetike
     (Problem of Optimums in Theoretical Cybernetics).  Moscow,  USSR.   160.
                                  APPENDIX

     Current methods of theory of hierarchic systems make it possible  to
 reduce the complicated task of optimizing the program for development  of
 industrial and water-protection complexes to solving a set of simple local
 problems united by the coordination procedure.  The body of this paper
 described the structure of one of these methods,  in which one first solves
 problem (11-25) for the period LO.TJ, after which one solves problem (27-
 37), which has an hierarchic structure for the first stage, t =  1.  We
 propose below a method of hierarchic optimization that permits determination
 of  the program of development for all t eT.

     The method is based on aggregation in time of controls of development
 u(t) in intervals of T, T-l , etc., and analysis of the problem in these
 intervals with use of aggregation of variables (Vie) = V and methoda of  theory
 of  duality.  Let the initial problem of optimization of development program
 have the following appearance:
 The aggregated restriction variables have the following appearance:
                    , ,V S  ".«),„. ,T-     ft,
                                     165

-------
     Let  us  substitute the solution to the initial  problem  (41) with the
step- by-step solution of sequence of problems at the following  steps:
      U, v) = C L iXT H- cC  V C V J \ -*• w
                                   #        r
                   -<  }
                                                    -                (43)
where u— is the  result of solving the problem at  preceding step T.  The
solution continues analogously (43)  to step  t  = 1.

     It was shown  that, if solution (41) exists an  step-by-step routine has
admissible solutions, solutions (42, 43) coincide with the solutions to the
initial problem  (41).

     Let us turn to solving a problem such as  (42)  or (43) at each step.
In scalar form,  (42) has the following appearance:
                                                                     (44)
        Z!vie  -    EX',
          OL             *L  eeQ
                                                                     (45)
                                                        .            (46)

Decompositon of  (44-46) leads to local problems  such as:
                                                                     (48)
                                   166

-------
                                                                      (49)
                     ^e VLUu) ,
(50)
where y and n. are coordinating parameters  and  h  is  the number of iteration
with formation of y  and  ft.

     The values of y and /z. are calculated  using  the formulas,
where v-j_ is a variable aggregated for 6  e  0j_ ,  B  is aggregated square matrix
for 6 e 9j_ .   The values of aggregated coefficients of matrix B are calculated
using the following formulas:
                                                                   9=6
where  n is length of  steg^ at  hth  iteration, which is determined by the
"golden section"  method,    elO,l],  i*  is  the number of the "leading"
subsystem in the  hth interation, 8 * is the  number of  the  "leading" column,
which is identified with  the formula,
                                    I
                                                                       (51)
where A* y •  are dual evaluations of  (48,
     Some details referable to logic  of  choosing  i* , Q * were omitted in
formula (51).  It was shown in practice  that iterative solution  of  (47-51)
amounts to solution of (44-4b).
                                    167

-------
          GREAT LAKES AGRICULTURAL POLLUTION CONTROL IN PERSPECTIVE

                                     by

                                 V.J.  Saulys1
                                  ABSTRACT

      Major efforts are underway in the Great Lakes area to control environ-
mental pollution, particularly with respect to nonpoint agricultural sources.
Farmers in the Lake Erie Basin have joined with environmental and soil con-
servation experts to institute programs to control these sources.  Their work
has demonstrated the potential of no-till or reduced tillage practices to
reduce phosphorus loadings to streams and lakes.  The potential for increased
pesticide pollution is of growing concern, however.

      This paper has been reviewed in accordance with the U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency's peer and administrative review policies and approved for
presentation and publication.

                                 INTRODUCTION

      The Great Lakes, the "sweet water seas" of North America, have long
served to focus United States' energies on pollution control.  President
Lyndon Johnson, when urging the Congress to pass the Federal Water Pollution
Control Act of 1965, said that Lake Erie, tor all intents and purposes, was
"dead." Some years later, Mr. V/illiam Ruckelshaus, the first Administrator of
the U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), noted that he once met with
officials from the City of Cleveland (Ohio).  They assured him that the pollu-
tion problems of the Cuyahoga River, a major tributary of Lake Erie, had been
solved.  "Next week," Ruckelshaus said, "the river caught tire and burned down
two bridges and a houseboat"  (Lake and Morrison 1977a).  Such incidents,
together with beaches closed by raw sewage and open beaches where rotting mats
of algae and floating rows of dead fish competed with people for sand and
water, stirred the people and their elected officials to action.
 -U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Region V, Great Lakes National Program
 Office, Chicago, IL 60605 USA
                                     168

-------
      The pollution sources in the Great Lakes Basin were quickly identified
and targeted.   These sources could be grouped into classes and categories
(Table 1).
TABLE 1.   POLLUTION SOURCES
                                        Location
 Source
Urban
Rural
 Point
 Nonpoint
Municipal discharges
Industrial discharges
Atmospheric releases
Hazardous waste sites
Municipal waste landfills
Stormwater runoff
Human waste systems
Animal feed lots
Agricultural chemical and
  waste spills

Erosion
Improper land use
Pesticide misuse
Fertilizer management
      A decade ago the problems were highly visible and priorities apparently
simple.  The point sources of pollution, particularly, industrial, were highly
visible.  Thus, they were the first targets.

      Today, many of these pollution sources are under control or have control
programs to address them.  Municipal and industrial discharges must meet
strict federal technology-based requirements and state water quality stand-
ards.  Phosphorus controls were imposed on sewage treatment plants and large
industrial sources in the Great Lakes Basin to slow the rate of eutrophica-
tion.  As a result, the phosphorus loadings to Lake Erie from these sources
decreased from 15,260 metric tons in 1972 to 2,541 metric  tons in 1982 (Figure
1).

      Similar progress was reported for the industrial section.  For example,
the U.S. paper ana pulp industry, once one of the "dirtiest of polluters," is
now one of the exemplary industries (Anon. 1981) (Figure 2).

      Less progress has been achieved with urban nonpoint  runoff.  Many  large
cities with serious problems in this area in the Great Lakes Basin, however,
have programs to capture and treat storm runoff or separate storm runoff from
domestic waste.  The $3.2 billion surface and subsurface capture programs in
Chicago, Illinois, the $1.6 billion project in Milwaukee,  Wisconsin,  and
smaller projects in Rochester, New York, and elsewhere are examples of  such
programs.  Many open municipal and industrial dumps were buried  during  the
1960s and early 1970s to eliminate surface water pollution.  These pro-
grams turned out to be,  in many instances, an example  of sweeping  a problem
                                      169

-------
                             1972 U.S. Load Estimate 13,870 Ml/year
            8000 i-
          _ 7000
          ra
          o>
          o 6000
          — 5000
          c
          T3
          CO
          JO

          ^ 4000
          b
          JZ
          Q.
          C/)
          O
          |- 3000
          "5
            2000
            1000
                                         UNITED STATES
                       U.S. Load at 1 mg/L
                                                Cdn. Load at 1mg/L
                 J	I

                 1972
1975
                 1980
1983
Figure 1.   Lake Erie municipal phosphorus  loads

under a carpet.  Today, a massive  state  and federal effort is underway to
correct the resultant groundwater  and  surface  water pollution created by past
expedient actions.

      Major efforts are underway to  address large atmospheric sources of con-
taminants.  While much of the public's attention is on "acid rain," U.S. and
European research studies are gathering  evidence that the rain may not be  only
an acidic, but also a toxic, cocktail.  Although much remains to be done in
the atmospheric control area, the  basic  technology to reduce sulphur and ni-
trogen oxides has been identified.  Many necessary controls have been put  in
place on mobile (vehicles)  and stationary sources of pollution.  As of April
1983, 106 industrial facilities  and  electric power plants in the United  States
have sulphur dioxide control technology  in place.  An additional 35 have sul-
phur dioxide scrubbers under construction; and 70 more facilities  are under
consideration for sulphur removal  technology (.Personal communication, EPA
Region V, Chicago, IL. July 1984).
                                       170

-------
              1200
              1000
              800
           C
           o
           I  600
              400
              200
Total Combined Loading to the Great Lakes

                          1967     1973
           1977
1980
Figure 2.  BOD5 Discharge trends of paper and pulp mills discharging directly
           into the Great Lakes

      Much progress has been achieved in cleaning up industrial and municipal
sources.  Beaches closed for decades and ignored have been reopened as health
warning signs are removed one by one.  Lake Erie, once pronounced dead, now
supports a renewed walleye sport fishery bringing $100 million per year to the
economy of the State of Ohio alone.  The Cuyahoga River shoreline, once a fire
hazard, is now the site of new restaurants and luxury condominiums.

      Rural point sources also have seen progress in pollution control.  Reg-
ulations have been passed to eliminate large feedlot runoff,  to prevent pesti-
cide misuse, and to contain agricultural chemical and waste spills.  Violators
face large monetary fines.  Small  rural communities are encouraged to  install
water treatment systems designed tor low capital costs and low maintenance.
Monetary assistance is available from state and federal agencies  for design
ana installation of municipal treatment systems.  Regulations have been
tightened by local government bodies to ensure the proper design,  location and
installation of individual household treatment systems.  The  engineering  solu-
tions, tor the most part, have been identified.  Their implementation,  in many
instances, is nearly complete.

      The major remaining pollutant impact upon the Great Lakes ecosystem
comes not from point sources but from nonpoint agricultural  sources.   It  has
been the farmer — not the city dweller or the industrial baron — who has
shaped the Great Lakes ecosystem.  True, the cities have done their  share to
damage the ecosystem, and, industry has contributed much more than  its share
                                      171

-------
of pollutants, particularly those that are toxic.  The farmer, by changing the
face of the land, changed the ecology of the Great Lakes forever.  Unless
agricultural nonpoint sources of pollution are controlled, however, the in-
vestment made in cleaning up urban sources of pollution will not produce the
full benefits.  We have gone past the point where only the engineers will
provide the answers.  We have reached the point of resource management.  To-
day, the agronomists and the ecologists will have to provide the leadership
to complete the cleanup of the Great Lakes and to ensure their proper manage-
ment .

      This situation was foreseen on January 7, 1972, during a conference on
Maumee River pollution problems.  The participants of this conference were
told by the EPA representative that the Maumee River was the major contribu-
tor of silt and associated nutrients to Lake Erie.  The participants were
advised that the initiatives necessary to control industrial and municipal
pollution were underway.  The EPA representative also forecast that "when
these problems are solved, the problems of agricultural pollution will re-
main" (Lake and morrison 1977a).  Among those conference participants were
farmers from the Allen County (Indiana) Soil and Waste Conservation District.
They did not like what they heard and resolved to do something to change
the prophecy.  They held a series of meetings involving agricultural and
environmental agencies at the local, state, and federal levels.  Their
timing was right and, within a few months, agreement was reached to under-
take a research program involving agricultural and environmental special-
ists to answer three questions (Lake and Morrison 1977c).

      Could a conventional program of land treatment, undertaken in
      the Maumee Basin, result in a measurable improvement in the
      water quality in Lake Erie?

      What would the cost be of such a project and could the dollars
      spent be correlated with an improvement in water quality?

      What programs, incentives, and administrative techniques would
      result in the most nearly complete participation by landowners?

      The research program was to take place in Allen County with the full
support of the Allen County Soil and Conservation District.  Thus, the
Black Creek Project was born in 1972.  It was the first detailed look at
the contributions of agriculture to the degradation of water quality in the
United States.

      The Black Creek watershed was chosen because it was representative of
the Maumee Basin's land use and soil types (Table 2).  It was large enough
(4872 hectares) to allow for sufficient studies of the sub-watershed and
the differing land uses.  The Maumee Basin extends into the states of Ohio,
Indiana and Michigan.  It is one of the last of the areas in the Lake Erie
Basin to be settled (mid-19th century) because it was the site of the "Great
Black Swamp," the remains of the glacial Lake Maumee.  Until the arrival of
German settlers with experience in farming heavy clay soils, it was not
considered fit for serious agriculture.  Today, it is one of the most pro-
ductive agricultural areas of the United States.


                                     172

-------
                                          X    x"— —RIVER BASIN BOUND
Figure 3.  Maumee Basin—Black. Creek Location
TABLE 2.  BASIN AND SUB-BASIN LAND USE*
           Maumee River Basin
Black Creek Basin
           1,711,493 hectares
                 73% cropland
                  4% pasture
                 80% woodland
                  9% urban
 4,872 hectares
   80% cropland
    4% pasture
    4% woodland
    9% urban
*Lake and Morrison  (1977a).
                                      173

-------
      The Black Creek scudy consisted of & research program to define the
water quality and biological parameters of Black Creek and an administrative
program to test the pollution control benefits of known soil conservation
technologies.  During a 5-year study period, it was found that the tra-
ditional grab sampling methods were inadequate to accurately show the true
load of sediments and related pollutants discharged by Black Creek to the
Maumee River.  Automated samplers had to be installed at several sampling
locations.  This equipment allowed the scientists to collect more frequent
and, thus more accurate, information on water quality and sediment load fol-
lowing a rainfall event.  The information provided by these samplers showed
that a single rainfall event could deliver as much as &6% of the total annual
sediment load.

      The Black Creek chemical parameters were typical of such agricultural
watersheds:  nitrate-nitrogen runoff of 2 to 20 kg/ha, phosphorus levels
significantly above Lake Erie objectives (0.05 - 0.16 mg/1 versus 0.01 mg/1
target), and an aquatic community dominated by pollutant-tolerant species
(Lake and Morrison 1977a).

      The agricultural portion of this study planned to investiage the cost
and benefits of 30 agricultural soil control practices and combinations.
These were grouped into three categories:

                 Structural practices

                    Diversion structures to reduce length of slope
                    Slope stabilization structures
                    Grassed waterways to convey storm water to streams
                    Holding ponds and tanks for animal wastes
                    Land smoothing
                    Fences to keep livestock away from streams
                    Special livestock watering facilities
                    Ponds
                    Sediment control basins
                    Stream channel stabilizers
                    Stream bank protectors
                    Surface drains
                    Gradient terraces
                    Paralleled terraces
                    Tile drains
                 Cultivation practices

                    Contour  planting
                    Crop residue management
                    Minimum  tillage
                    Pasture  and hayland planting
                    Strip cropping
                    Improved harvesting of woodlands
                    Woodland improvement
                    Woodland pruning
                                     174

-------
                 Combined structural and cultivation practices

                    Farmstead and feedlot windbreaks
                    Field border plantings (hedgerows, etc.)
                    Field windbreaks
                    Reforestation
                    Sediment control during construction
                    Recreation area improvements via plantings
                    Wildlife habitat management

      The study yielded answers in a number of areas.  Of the above listed
structural and cultural practices, nine were chosen as constituting Best
Management Practices tor the Black Creek:

                    Field borders
                    Grade stabilization structures
                    Grassed waterways
                    Fences for • livestock
                    Pasture planting
                    Sediment control basins
                    Terraces
                    Limited channel protection
                    Tillage methods that increase crop residue and
                      surface roughness.

      A mathematical model called ANSWERS (Aerial Nonpoint Source Watershed
Evaluation Simulator) was developed as part of the project.  It was shown to
predict the effect of an actual storm event loading within 15% of that mea-
sured in Black Creek.  The model also was used to identify the most criti-
cal areas within the watershed and simulate the effect of changing from
conventional tillage (using the molboard plow) to minimum tillage (using the
chisel plow).  This simulation showed that 4U% of the reduction in soil loss
could have been achieved by treating 32 hectares in the most "critical"
areas rather than the 728 hectares affected by the project (Lake and
Morrison 1977a).

      Work with rainfall simultors on small plots confirmed that crop resi-
dues and tillage practices, which prevent soil mobilization, were more sig-
nificant in preventing soil loss than those practices aimed at intercepting
mobilized soil.  Once a rain drop's impact mobilized the soil particles, it
was an uphill struggle to keep the soil from the stream.

      Furthermore, the biological studies showed that several of the struc-
tural changes, insisted upon by the local farmers, such as stream channeli-
zation and stream bank protection, did little  to reduce total loss of soil
but significantly damaged the stream's biological community (Lake and
Morrison 1977b).

      At the conclusion of the study, the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers,
which had been  required by the U.S. Congress to  "develop a demonstration
wastewater program for the rehabilitation and environmental repair ot Lake
Erie," took  the findings of the Black Creek project and applied  them to a


                                     175

-------
nearby watershed in Ohio.  The Honey Creek Project focused on no-till and
minimum tillage practices.  As seen in Table 3, the project confirmed that
they were the cheapest and most effective measures to reduce phosphorus and
to rehabilitate Lake Erie.

      The Maumee River and other Lake Erie tributaries are estimated to
deliver an average of 8400 metric tons of agricultural nonpoint phosphorus
per year to Lake Erie (U.S. Army, COE 1983).  Since in 1982 the total phosphorus
input to Lake Erie was estimated at 12,349 metric tons, a reduction in agri-

TABLE 3.  COSTS OF METHODS FOR REDUCING PHOSPHORUS RUNOFF*

Method
Rural nonpoint sources
No-till and conservation
tillage
Cover crops
Critical area seeding
Contour stripcropping
Diversions
Waterways
Vegetative filters
Runoff control structures
Terraces
Tile drains
Manure storage and
spreading
Barnyard runoff control
Fertility management
Fertilizer placement
Total
phosphorus
$/kg
0
276.00
326.00
82.00
2,640.00
97.00
30.00
368.00
73.00
9, 180. '00
4.40
2.20
0
44.00
Biologically
available
phosphorus , %
25
25
25
25
25
25
25
25
25
25
75
75
25
25
$/kg of
Biologically
available
phosphorus
0
1,100.00
1,300.00
330.00
10,600.00
390.00
120.00
1,470.00
290.00
36,720.00
5.90-36.3
2.90
0
176.00
*U.S. Army, COE (1983).
                                      176

-------
cultural contribution is necessary to meet the 11,000 metric ton phosphorus
loading target set by the 1978 Great Lakes Water Quality Agreement between
the United States and Canada (Great Lakes Water Quality Board 1983).  The
results of the Lake Erie Wastewater Management Study indicates that, with
use of no-till and reduced tillage practices, the achievement of this
target is feasible (Table 4).

TABLE 4.  EXISTING AND POTENTIAL ACHIEVABLE REDUCTION OF SOIL EROSION IN
          THE UNITED STATES LAKE ERIE DRAINAGE BASIN* (million metric tons
          per year)
  Conservation
    practices
Western
 basin
Central
 basin
Eastern
 basin
  Total
Lake Erie
  basin
Base year (1975)

Reduced tillage only
  (percent reduction)

No-till and reduced
  tillage (percent
  reduction)
  16.6

   8.3
  (50)

   4.5
  (73)
  6.7

  3.9
 (42)

  2.4
 (64)
  1.8

  1.3
 (28)

  0.9
 (50)
   25.1

   13.5
   (46)

    7.8
   (69)
*U.S. Army, COE  (1983).

      In late 1980, the information available from the Lake Erie Wastewater
Management Study and the reanalysis of  the Black Creek data using the ANSWERS
model made it evident that the no-till  and minimum tillage practices would
significantly reduce the amount of phosphorus reaching Lake Erie.  The in-
formation indicated that there would be little, if any, additional cost to
the farmer, if he was trained in  the use of new equipment and practices.
Therefore, EPA Region V, U.S. Army Corps of Engineers, and Department of
Agriculture representatives  signed an agreement in 1981 to jointly work
toward the acceptance of these practices.  It was agreed that the most effec-
tive way to introduce a change in farming practices would be to  fund the
local soil conservation districts to demonstrate the use of the  new tech-
niques and equipment by trained local members of the farming community.

      This proposal for conservation tillage demonstration funding was en-
thusiastically received by the local soil conservation districts.  Projects
have been funded in 31 counties in the  Lake Erie Basin.  The projects
targeted "critical areas" where erosion would result in the greatest phos-
phorus control.  During 1983, the projects tracked the performance of  1854
demonstration farm plots covering a total of 9472 hectares.  These plots
were analyzed for costs of production (including fertilizer, pesticide,
and machinery use), crop yields,  and estimated  soil loss.  The  preliminary
conclusions from this demonstration program indicate that:
                                      177

-------
      1.  Yields with notill and ridgetill were competitive with yields
          produced under conventional tillage systems.

      2.  Costs of production for conservation tillage systems were less
          than or equal to costs of producing the same crops using con-
          ventional systems.

      3.  Conservation tillage systems reduced phosphorus loadings from
          the project area and did not significantly increase herbicide
          use (4 to 12%).

      Although only 9400 hectares are being closely monitored by the program,
about 22% of the 3,237,500 hectares of farmland was in some form of conserva-
tion tillage in 1983.  The demonstration projects should significantly in-
crease  this percentage in the coming years (U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency  1984).

      One of the principal concerns about encouraging the farmers to switch
to no-till or reduced tillage farming practices is the potential for in-
creased use of pesticides.  There are two conflicting schools of thought on
the subject:

      1.  The chemical usage will increase because the conservation tillage
          practices may rely upon pesticides to control weeds and insects.

      2.  The farmers currently make heavy use of these chemicals, thus,
          conversion to conservation tillage practices with close attention
          to chemical use should result in similar or lower pesticide usage.

      The existing literature reveals little information on current pesticide
usage in the Lake Erie Basin.  The information, which is currently available,
is significantly out of date (1978 and earlier).  Recent work (Baker, 1983)
shows that the amount of pesticides present in runoff from Lake Erie agri-
cultural areas can be significant.

      These pesticide loadings can be contrasted with the organic contami-
nants discharged by industrial and municipal sources to the Niagara River,
which drains Lake Erie into Lake Ontario (Table 6).

      The latter loadings are deemed to be of enough significance as to call
for special cooperative measures between U.S. and Canadian pollution control
agencies to identify and reduce the sources.  Granted, the formulations of the
pesticides measured in Maumee and other rivers are such that they should de-
grade readily in the environment.  However, recent findings by Baker (1983)
of concentrations of atrazine, alachlor, and metolachlor in public water
supplies similar to the stream concentrations indicate that the degradation
mechanisms are not as quick as they were assumed to be.  Sampling of Lake
Erie waters has not indicated a build-up to date of these compounds.  No
attempt has been made, however, to assess the impact of pulsed loadings to
sensitive fishery areas during the annual reproductive cycle.  Nor have
these compounds been assessed as to their synergistic, lifetime exposure
impacts on human health.


                                     178

-------
TABLE 5.  ESTIMATED PESTICIDE LOADS (kg) FOR THE PERIOD BETWEEN MAY 1, 1982,
          AND JULY 31, 1982*

Total loading

Pesticide
Metolachlor
Atrazine
Alachlor
Metribuzin
Cyanazine
Simazine
Linuron
DEA
DIA
Chlorpyrif os
Penoxalin
Ethoprop
Totals
Honey
Creek
241
223
89.2
27.5
24.7
19.7
62.4
29.4
52.0
9.47
2.38
1.06
781.8
Sand.
River
1750
1600
1290
518
226
179
264
168
130
135
19.3
3.86
6,283.2
Maumee
River
2920
4240
2820
1370
1590
1280
571
490
629
226
95.4
34.7
16,266.1
 *Baker  (1983).
 TABLE 6.  CONTAMINANT GROUPS DISCHARGED  INTO THE NIAGARA RIVER*
            Contaminant group
      Total loading
to river, kg/day (Ib/day)
    Acid extractabies

    Poiynuclear aromatics

    PCBs

    Pesticides

    Other  base/neutral  extractabies

    Purgeables
         46 (100)

         17 (38)

       0.11 (0.24)

       1.6 (3.5)

         30 (66)

        140 (310)
 *Anon.  (1984).
                                      179

-------
      In summary,  the Great Lakes have long served as an early warning system
tor the world about environmental problems.  They also have served to demon-
strate that close  international cooperation can reverse trends in existence
for decades and even solve environmental problems.  The control of phosphorus
and eutrophication in Lake Erie is an excellent example.

      The Lakes have shown us clearly that soil and its attendant chemicals
is a major pollutant, destroying the ecological balance of one of the streams
and aging the Lakes.  The consequences of land runoff control strategies are
only now being assessed.   The new challenge is to keep the soil on the farm
as a resource for  future  generations while feeding the increasing population
of the world.
                                   REFERENCES

Anon.  1981.  The response of the pulp and paper industry in the Great Lakes
      Basin to pollution abatement programs.   Report to the Great Lakes Water
      Quality Board:  Pulp and Paper Point Sources Task Force of the Water
      Quality Programs Committee.  68 pp.

Anon.  1984.  Niagara River Toxics Committee  Draft Report.  Unpublished.

Baker, D.B.  1983.  Studies of sediment,  nutrient and pesticide loading in
      selected Lake Erie and Lake Ontario tributaries - draft final report.
      Unpublished.

Great Lakes Water Quality Board.   1983.   1983 report on Great Lakes Water
      quality.  Great Lakes Water Quality Board Report to the International
      Joint Commission.  97 pp.

Lake, J., and J. Morrison.  1977a.  Environmental impact of land use on
      water quality:  Final report on the Black Creek Project - Summary.
      Great Lakes National Program Office, Chicago, Illinois.  EPA-905/
      9-77-007-A, United States Environmental Protection Agency.  94 pp.

Lake, J., and J. Morrison.  1977b.  Environmental impact of land use on water
      quality:  Final report on the Black Creek Project - Supplemental Comments
      Great Lakes National Program Office, Chicago, Illinois EPA-905/9-77-007-D,
      United States Environmental Protection  Agency.  107 pp.

Lake, J., and J. Morrison.  1977c.  Environmental impact of land use on
      water quality - Executive Summary.   12  pp.

U.S. Army,  Corps of Engineers.  1983.  Summary report of the Lake Erie waste-
      water management study.  U.S. Army,  Corps of Engineers, Buffalo District.
      31 pp.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.  1984.   Lake Erie Demonstration Pro-
      jects:  Evaluating impacts of conservation tillage on cost, yield and
      environment.  U.S. EPA, Great Lakes  National Program Office, Chicago,
      Illinois.  17 pp.


                                     180

-------
        MODELING THE FORMATION OF WATER QUALITY IN WATER CHANNELS
                  RECEIVING SURFACE RUN-OFF FROM FARM LAND

                                       by

              Ye. V. Yeremenko, V. Z. Kolpak and N. I. Selyu1
                                  ABSTRACT
     A multicomponent mathematical model is examined for the terming of water
quality in a river considering surface run-off from farmlands entering the
water course in the form of a continuous-in-length lateral influx of water
and matter formed in the watershed.  In using the equations tor the balance
of matter, a system of linear equations has been derived tor a mathematical
model of transforming the nitrogen compounds and the content of dissolved
oxygen in the water.  Proceeding from the supposition that low lateral in-
flux does not substantially change the amount of the average rate of the
water course and using coefficients ot nonconservati,veness within the limits
of the sections into which the water course is divided, a solution has been
obtained for the model's equations in an analytical form that can be used
in optimizing water conservation measures.

     The necessary information on the amount ot lateral influx and the con-
centration of the designated matter in the surface run-oft has been obtained
on the basis ol the elaborated mathematical model tor the water quality ot
surface run-oft.  Here the watershed is represented in the form ot a sys-
tematized aggregate, ol flat slopes.

     Also discussed are the questions ol determining the calculation con-
ditions and requirements that should be satisfied by the surface run-off
models.  As an example, results are given for calculating water quality in
the water course considering the lateral influx from the watershed.


                        INTRODUCTION AND DISCUSSION

      Control of water quality in river basins and  related setting ot  maximum
permissible run-oft (.MPRJ ot drainage water depend  largely  on  conditions  ot
 •'-All-Union  Scientific Research Institute of Water Protection, USSR Ministry
 of Water Management, Kharkov, USSR


                                      181

-------
surface drainage and levels of substances in it for which  standards  are  set.
In the most general case, there is migration into water  channels of  surface
run-off from farmland that occupies large territories, in  the  form of  a
continuous line of influent water and mass of substances for which  standards
are to be set.

      Evaluation of organized dumping of drainage water  and level of surface
run-off on water quality in a river can be made by means of appropriate
models of water quality.  One of these numerous models is  described by
leremenko et al. (1981).  We shall discuss a multicomponent mathematical
model of formation of water quality, which takes into consideration the
role of surface run-off and is aimed at solving water-protection problems.
It permits determination of transformation of substances to be standardized
and development of elements of a transitional matrix to  solve  optimization
problems of controlling the quality of surface waters.   In this model, the
substances to be standardized are the basic forms of nitrogen.

      Without imposing restrictions on the law of change in water discharge
Q in a stream (a linear law of change in water discharge is discussed  by
Aytsom et al. 196b) and on concentration of substances in  surface water
NP , it is considered by Koval'cyuk et al. (1979) that NP corresponds to
background concentration in the stream and using the equation  of balance of
matter in the section x, x+Ax, we shall have:
which, considering expansions to values on the order of O(Ax^) and Ax-H),
leads us to the equation:
                  Orf,-     Q

This equation is the simplest one for consideration of the effect of surface
run-off on concentration of matter N.  Its right part characterizes a
continuous positive (NN?) source of matter coming in
with surface run-off.  Considering the nonconservative nature of matter,
the initial equation is presented as follows:
which yields the following system, as applied to the successive transforma-
tion of nitrogen compounds within a section of the stream;


                                    182

-------
    dx             Q
                                      U   dQ    '  .
where Mj^ , N2 »  N3 >  N4  and  S are concentrations ot organic,  ammonia, nitrite,
nitrate nitrogen and  dissolved oxygen,  6, Y^, Y^ and Y^  are stoichiometric
coef iicients,  Kj^ ,  K2 ,  Kj , ana K^ are coetticients ot nonconservation.

     On the assumption that lateral intlow does not alter appreciably  the
mean fiow rate and that  the coetficients  of nonconservation remain constant
within a section,  the  solution ol system  3 can be expressed as follows.
      = G33 Nfl3 •»• G32 ^02  •*• &31 A/01 *  frj

                j  •»• G-^jA/Qs •**G'«Mu f GV^OI +

 S  =Gss^>o  ^GssA/fli ^GszA/oz  +&Sf A/of *Gs ,

                                   183

-------
where U shows values ot concentrations o± substances at the beginning ol
the section, Gij and Gsj are elements of the transitional matrix, values  o±
which are listed in Appendix 1.

      To determine concentrations of Ni and S,  we need information about
lateral intlow Qp(x) and concentration of substances NP, which is provided
by the model of surface run-off.

      Surface run-oti is termed in the water catchment area as a result.of
rain and it usually contains substances in both dissolved form with liquid
run-otr and on particles ot washed away soil, with solid discharge.  Thus,
the model ot surface run-oft should provide information about both lateral
intiow ot water ana levels in it of soluble agents, as well as agents
carried in with solid discharge.

      At the present time, there are methods in the USSR tor calculating
maximum discharge, rain flood (in water catchments less than 5U km^ in
size) and soil wash-off (Anon. 1975, Anon. 1979).  Maximum discharge ot
rain floods is calculated for water catchment areas up to 5U km^ in size,
while determination ot soil wash-otf with rain run-oft from slopes is made
on areas up to / km^ in size (Anon. 1979).  The restriction on water
catchment area makes it necessary to develop an approach without such a
restriction, and to view a water catchment area ot arbitrary size in the
torm ot a certain set of slopes in order to be  able to use system 3 in
estimating soil wash-off.  Hence, one of the requirements tor a model ot
formation of surface run-oft in a water catchment area is to take into
consideration the structure of the catchment area, gully and ravine network
over which the surlace run-ott tormed on slopes travels without run-oft.

      As a rule, precipitation falling in a catchment area has spatial and
time variability.  For this reason, the second  requirement imposed on the
model is that it must take into consideration the spatial and time varia-
bility of precipitation (as a special case, they could be stationary).

      finally, application ot fertilizers in soil is also performed repeat-
edly on farm tields.  Hence the third requirement of models, that of consid-
eration ot spatial heterogeneity ot distribution ot fertilizers in the water
catchment area.  It should be noted that the requirements imposed on a
model ol tormation ot rain-caused tlood regions and removal ol suspended
dritt trom water catchment areas do not impose  restrictions on applicability
ot the model tor the case where these characteristics are constant in time
and space.

      It these requirements are met, it will be possible to get an answer
to the questions of how and where torrential rain water and solid run-ott
enter the water system (distributed in length or concentrated) when making
estimates ol tormation ot run-otf in a water catchment area.

      By calculating the quality ot surface waters tormed on slopes and tht
gully-ravine network, one can iearn how the concentrations of substances
will change in the run-oft as a function ot meteorological and agrotechnical
tactors, as well as environmental protection measures.  The latter is


                                     184

-------
particularly important in our opinion:  to assess the efticacy ot different
environmental protection measures involving  the  entire  water  catchment area
or some segment of it according to volume o± substances carried out.

      The moael of surface run-off consists  of several  submodels.  Let us
discuss them.

                        SUBMODEL OF RUNOFF FORMATION

     It is known that the equation of Nash (1957;, equation for kinematic
wave (Kuchment et al. 1983) and equations of Saint Venant can be used to
describe flow ot water down a slope (thaiweg).   In our  opinion, Nash's
equation is the most suitable for solving practical problems (.ordinary
first-order differential equation):
where QP is efflux ot water from slope, 1 is influx of water to slope
(including intensity of precipitations) and K is a coef licient .

      However, the equation includes coefficient K, which is difficult to
determine, and although we do know from literature sources its expression
by hydroiic parameters and slope characteristics, its use with reference to
specific water catchment areas requires special validation.  For this
reason, for a model or movement of torrential rain water on a slope, we
obtained an ordinary first-order differential equation that contains no
uncertain parameters.  It is based on  the equation of continuity with
consideration of lateral influx:
                                r.                          •>
where w is flow cross section, mz, QP is water discharge, m-Ys, I(t) and
r(t) are intensity or rain and inriltration, mm/min, & is width of free
surtace of flow, m, q(5oK is lateral intlux  per unit  current length (slope
or stream), m2/s, x is a coordinate read downstream, m,  t is  time, s.

      By integrating equation b for stream  length x  from U to  £c we oDtain.
                  did'
                                                                         (7)

where
                                      185

-------
q  is water discharge in first section of stream with x = U, m Is, Q^b is
water discharge in last section of stream with x =  c, m-Vs,
                             0
w is cross section of stream.
      Since equation 7 has two unknowns,  Qpb and w(.t), let us express Q^ b
as w(,t), using the lormuias of Chezy and Manning, analogously to derivation
of the kinematic wave equation from the equation of continuity:
where R(w) is hydraulic radius averaged for length of  current,  i is mean
slope of current and n is roughness coefficient.

      Substituing equation b in equation "/ , we obtain  an ordinary nonlinear
first-oraer difterentiai equation with reference to w (.the line over the w
was omitted for the sake of simplicity) ;
                                                 rr
The following initial condition is added to this equation;
      Equation ^ is solved mathematically using well-known methods.  As a
result of digital integration,  we obtain discrete values  for current cross
section w^ = jT, j = 1, 2..., T is the time gradation of  integration.  The
value of discharge is calculated using formula 8 with w-,.   The integration
step T [gradation] in equation 9 is chosen from the condition of stability
of the computing process .

                                    186

-------
      In the case ol level run-oft trom a slope,

using the maximum (stationary) value tor w, on the basis ol established
water run-on ,
we obtain trom equation 11


                   f^~ f\
                   ""•"" ^ ,

                                                                        (12;
      Thus, by integration ot equation y one can obtain a hydrograph ot run-
ort trom a slope.  for the calculations i,  n, qbx,  1, r and ic must be known.
                         SUbMUUbiL OJe WATER QUALITY

     Determination ot volume (hydrograph) ot solid run-ott,  which is deter-
mined entirely by liquid run-olf which, in turn, carries ott dissolved sub-
stances, is an important element in a model for quality ot water of  surtace
run-ott .

      In the model developed at the All-Union Scientific Research Institute
of Water Protection for formation ol water quality ol surface run-oil, use
is made ol the basic thesis in the literature (Anon.  ly7y).   Suspended
sediment is estimated using the formula,
n    _
LCH-
                              CH

where Mch is the modulus ot run-off ot sediments with ¥7, coverage, tons/ha,
*'.  is size ol water catchment areas, tun7, W  is volume 01 rain run-ofl, m ,
C .  is concentration ol suspended sediment in run-ofl , g/m .   Parameters We
and M,,^ are expressed as follows.

where h is the layer ot flood run-olt at P/i. coverage, mm, a^ is parameter
of channeling, 3 is a coefficient which considers the inlluence ot the
agrotechnicai background for the preceding year, kj^ is the coefticient of
slope steepness.  Parameters «^ and g are calculated using tables submitted


                                     187

-------
in .the literature (.Anon. iy7b»).  Inserting equation 14 in equation 13, we
shall obtain.
      Tne data on liquid and solid run-ott permit determination  or  removal
ot suspended particles, ammonium nitrogen, and nitrate ol nitrogen.  It is
assumed that nitrate is removed with liquid run-ott and  ammonium nitrogen,
with solid run-oil.

      Removal ot nitrogen in run-oll rrom larmland was measured  by  a method
developed at VNIIVO (.Ail-Union Scientilic Research Institute  ol  water
Protection) (.Anon. 19bi;.  Nitrate concentration in surface run-orl per
area V was calculated using the iormula;

where Kno  is  the  factor for scaling N  to M03 , Kn°3 = 4. 4267,

                      Dc    W*
                      r   =~=r
where pc  is  removal ot nitrates in liquid run-oft, kg, m  is  amount  of
nitrates  in  plowed layer betore rain, kg/ha, hm is depth  of  plowed  layer,
m,  II is porosity ot soil and H is layer of  precipitations with PX coverage,
mm.

      Ammonium nitrogen concentration in surface run-oft  trom the water
catchment area is calculated using the following tormula:
                                                                         U»)
                          mf       —               1


where Kn 4  is  a  factor  ror  scaling M  to NIL and  is  equal  to  1.2b^7.   PT is
removal of  nitrogen with  solid  run-oft, kg.
where  na  is  the  quantity of metabolic-absorbed  forms  of  nitrogen in the
plowed layer  by  the  time rains begin, kg/ha, Mch is the  modulus  ot  sediment
run-ott (.calculated  using  formula  14) and  y  is  volumetric  weight of soil in
tilled layer, tons/in-*-  Thus, the model ot formation  of  quality  ot  surface
run-off from  farmed  land consists of a set ot submodels.   the  run-ott


                                     188

-------
submodels permits determination ol the hydrograph of torrential water run-
ott, while submodels ot water catchment area) ot suspended  sediments,
ammonium nitrogen and nitrates.

      The appropriate programs for a computer were developed tor use 01 the
above described submodels.

      Let us discuss brietly determination ot nominal conditions.  Accord-
ing to the "Rules tor protection of surtace waters against  sewage pollution,"
which are in effect in the USSR, calculation ot volumes of  diversiop of
sewage into water systems should be made for adverse hydrologicai condi-
tions, to which average monthly water discharge with b»5/i coverage is usually
related.  however, the question of layer of rain run-off corresponding to
this water flow rate in the river remained unanswered.

      Analysis ol tormation ot water quality in surface run-otf from tarm
land revealed that the most hazardous concentrations ot pollutants in the
annual cycle are observed during the period ol maximum rain activity.  For
this reason, in developing the nominal hydrologicai conditions tor removal
of pollutants from rarmland, it was necessary to determine  the probability
ol occurrence of two random processes together—maximum layer of raintlood
run-off and mean summer-tall low-water level of discharge in rivers situated
in zones with different moisture factors.

      Studies of concurrent appearance of maximum layer of  rain flood and
minimum discharge ot water with ^5% coverage in the spring and fall low-
water period revealed that a layer of rain run-off with 25% coverage
(.Kovalenko and Karabash 1983) should be taken as the nominal value.

      As an example, let us estimate removal of ammonium nitrogen, nitrates
and suspended particles in surface run-off trom a hypothetical water catch-
ment area (.Figure 1).  This water catchment has the following dimensions:
iU km on the y-axis and 2U km on the x-axis.  The length or the river within
the limits ot the part of the catchment area in question is 27 km, and the
entire river is 5U km long.  Estimates of surface run-off were made using
the tollowing base data.  H—layer of precipitations was considered to be
3D mm, n—coefficient of roughness tor catchment slopes U.2 and for thalwegs
U.U2,  r—rate ol absorption was considered to be U.2U mm/mm and constant
in time, II—porosity ot soil, U.iU, m—nitrate content in tilled layer ttU
kg/ha, hm—depth ot tilled layer U.2 m,  na—ammonium nitrogen content in
tilled layer i> kg/ha, F—size ot water catchment area 2UU km^ .

      On the basis of tne developed programs, a geometrical model ot the
catchment area and run-off forming chains ot triangles on the left and
right banks of the stream, as Weil as run-off of torrential rain on the
basis ol the geometric model of a water catchment area, were constructed.
To simplify input of information in calculating the concentraton ol substances
in the stream, several separate catchments, the run-off hydrographs ot which
are illustrated in Figure 2, were singled out in the model  of the water
catchment area.   Run-oft from the separate catchments 2 and 6 is given as
being concentrated (over girder system) and trom the others, deconcentrated
(.along stream) (.Figure 3).


                                     189

-------
                                               RUN-OFF
                                      RUN-OFF
figure 1.  Fragment of hypothetical water catchment area (.horizontals,  m),
                                  190

-------
                                   -7=CATCHMENT
                                        NUMBERS
                             234
                                Time, hours
iigure 2.  Calculated hyarographs ol rain water runoll trom separate catch-
          ments.
1
1
v 	 >
4
k 	 v
f 	 A
i i
1
i
}
5 6
i
k

'
^
7
^
i
)
~\
i
2
E
1

r
3 1-7 = CATCHMENT NUMBERS
      0    5     10    15    20    25    30    35    40    45    50
                             Distance, km


Figure J.  Line diagram ot river section.
                                 191

-------
      Averaged water discharge oi  surtace run-oti and concentrations ot
suspended substances, ammonium nitrogen and nitrates are listed in Table  1.


TABLE 1.  DISCHARGE OF RAIN RUN-OiF AND CONCENTRATIONS OF AMMONIUM NITROGEN,
          NITRATES AND SUSPENDED SUBSTANCES ENTERING STREAM.

Separate
catchment
number
1
2
3
4
5
b
7
Flow rate,
m-Vs
0.26
0.40
U.3j
u.25
0.64
U.37
U.Ob

Ammonium
nitrogen
0.15
0.17
0.13
U.lb
0.13
O.i3
0.14
Concentrations , mg/
Nitrates
74
bl
67
79
65
65
7U

Suspended
substances
1200
14UO
ibOO
1350
1560
1350
1000
      formulas 3 were used to calculate concentrations oi substances in
river within the limits ot the section studied,  we used the tormulas similar
to the one ror N^ (3) to estimate the concentrations ot suspended substances
(Nu,) under the conditions listed in Table 1,  as  well as with the toilowing
base data.

      background characteristics:

Q = 40 m3/s,  N! = 2 mg/i, NZ  = 0.25 mg/£, N^  = 0.01  mg/£, N4 = 5 mg/ ,

S = 10 mg/£ and N^ = 13 mg/£.
      Characteristics  ot  concentrated  release  E:

         3
Q = 0.3 m/s, Nx = 3.2 ng/A , N2 = 0.5 mg/£, N3 = 0.25

S = U mg/i and Nu,=100 mm/ 1.

      Nonconservation coelticients .
                                                               = 13 mg/£,
          ,-b
   = 1 '  1U ul/s, K2 = 1.2b'10 'l/s, K3 = 1 .25 'l
                                                           = 1 .15 '
Ks =
                s and
2'10 7i/s.
                                    192

-------
      Calculations  were made in two variants.   The first corresponds to
lateral  inllow or water as indicated  in  Table  1,  and the second tripled
lateral  intlow,  which also failed to  lead  to substantial change in concen-
tration  of  substances in the flow of  water.  The  results of calculations
made in  the  first variant are illustrated  in Figure 4,  whereas Table 2
lists comparative'concentrations of substances in typical sites of the
river calculated by the two variants.

                  I. BODs (N|), mg/l          4.Suspended Substances (N5), mg/l
                  2.02(S), mg/l             5. Nitrate Nitrogen (Nil, mg/l       '
                  3. Nitrite Nitrogen (N3), I03-mg/l 6. Amonium Nitrogen (N2),mg/l
          N=  SNL  N,  No N,
                        2.0
173
153
133
1 13
93
73
53
33
13




'lOO









9.0

10

9

8

7

6
5




100

8.0

6.0

4.0
2.0
n?o
                    .027
                    0.26
                    025
                        I 9
                          0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18202224262830323436384042444648
                                           Distance, k'm

Figure 4.   Calculated concentrations of  substances  in river current.

      It must  be  noted that this approach permits not only  consideration of
the effect  on  water quality in the river of surface  run-off, but allows an
approach to optimization of water protection measures in a  catchment provided
the required amount of water is furnished in the  river  due  to presence of
elements of transitional matrix, if the link between intensity of water
protection  measures and cost indicators  is Known.
TABLE 2.  CONCENTRATIONS OF SUBSTANCES IN TYPICAL  SITES  OF  RIVER CURRENT
          WITH  DIFFERENT LATERAL INFLOW

Calcul .
variant
No.
Distance
from 1st
sect. , km N-,
Concentration, mg/ &
N^'IO N..J-100 N4 N3'10 1

S
           10        1.94       2.52      1.27      b.bl      2.b7      9.i>b

           17        i.b7       2.5b      0.42      b.97     10.03      9.4
                                      193

-------
TAB'I.H, 7, Continued
24
2.1
37
50
•L 10
17
24
27
37
5U
1.82
l.bU
1.77
1.73
i.»y
1.7b
l.bb
1 .b2
i.5y
1.57
2.bU
2.5y
2.b2
2.b7
2.50
2.5b
2.b3
2.bU
2.b2
2.b7
o.2y
0.26
U.27
0.28
i.U2
0.40
0.29
0.27
0.2b
0.28
11.26
11.88
11. bb
11. b4
7.b3
ib.iy
22.30
23. b4
23. bO
23.47
15.70
17.07
17.01
16. yu
5.y3
25. by
41.06
43. y8
43.tt2
43.42
y.2b
y.i4
9.12
y .05
y.4b
8.yi
8.67
tt.44
b.54
8.61
Key.  N^) BODs LDiological oxygen demand]        N^)  nitrate nitrogen
      No) ammonium nitrogen                     N^)  suspended substances
      N3) nitrite nitrogen                       S)  dissolved oxygen

Note;  Typical sites in the river were selected at the ends of the catchment
       sections before concentrated releases ana at  the end of the nominal
       section.
                                BIBLIOGRAPHY

Anon. 1975.  Metodicheskiye rekomendatsii po uchetu poverkhnostnogo stoka i
     smyva pochv pri izuchenn vodnoy erozii (.Methodological Recommendations
     on how to Keep a Record of Surface Run-Oft and Soil Wash-Off in Studies
     of Aquatic Krosion;.  Leningrad, USSR,  bb.

Anon. iy79.  Instruktsiya po opredeleniye raschetnykh gidrologicheskikh
     kharatctenstik pri proyektirovanii protivoerozionnykh meropriyatiy
     na Yevropeyskoy territorii SSSR (.Instructions for Determining Nominal
     Hydrological Characteristics in Planning Anti-Lrosion Measures in
     European USSR).  Leningrad, USSR. 63 p.

Anon. lybl.  Metodika otsenki vynosa pestitsidov i biogennykh veshchestv
     neorganizovannym poverkhnostnym stokom sel'skokhozyaystvennykh ugodiy
     Dogarnogo zemleaeliya (.Methods of Evaluating Removal of Pesticides
     and Biogenous Substances in Unorganized Surface Run-Off From Land
     Farmed by the ISionirrigated Method).  Kharkov, USSR. b4 p.

Aytsam,  A. M., Kh. A.  Vel'ner, and L. L. Paal'.  iyb8.  Calculation of
     changes in pollutant concentrations in rivers, Gigiyena 1 Sanitariya.
     11:3-10.
                                     194

-------
Kovalenko , M S. and G. A. Karabash. 1953.  Evaluation ol eilect ot removal
     ot pesticides in surtace run-olt on water quality in streams.  In:
     Okhrana vody ot zagryazneniya poverkhnostnym stokom (.Protection oi
     Water Against Pollution by Surtace Run-Oti).  Kharkov, USSR.  pp bO-y2.

Kovai'cyuk, P- 1., B. A. Akisin, V- L . Pavelko, and A. A. Matveyev.  lS»7y.
     Synthesis oi models ol transformation ot nonconservation substances in
     streams during diversions in a system ot tield observations.  Gidrokh.
     Mater.  72 . il 1-ilb .

Kuchment, L. S., V. N . Demiaov , and Yu. G. Motovilov iyb3.  Formirovaniye
     rechnogo  stoka (Formation ot River Run-Oli).  Moscow, USSR.  2ib.

Nash, J. h. iyi>7 .  The rorm ol the instantaneous unit hydrograph.
     3(45;; 14-121.

Yeremenko, Ye. V., Yu. M. Plis, and N. 1. Selyuk.  iy«l.  Model ot water
     quality in Connecticut and North Donets Rivers.  In: Metodologiya i
     praktika  planirovaniya okhrany vod rechnykh basseynov (.Methodology and
     Practice  ot Planning Protection for River Basin Waters).   Kharkov,
     USSR.  pp 120-170.
                                  APPENDIX
 Values for elements of transition matrices in solutions  of (3)
                                      195

-------
  = 7T
    U
31
     3
                          196

-------
I2 ir-r
U S  5
Q K3-
'V
Q
Q ^-
                197

-------
                                                                 -£,
*  -
                                 X)   \
                                  c

                                   198

-------
                         -a,)
199

-------
                 ^          -O*
where
Translator's note:   Subscript "cp" is Russian abbreviationfor average
or mean.
                                 200

-------
          CONTROL OF URBAN NONPOINT SOURCES IN GREAT LAKES BASIN

                                     by

                    D. Athayde, P. Bubar, and J. Meek1
                                 ABSTRACT

      The Nationwide Urban Runoff Program  (NURP) was conducted by the U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and many cooperating federal, state,
regional, and local agencies which were distributed across the United States.
The program consisted of individual project studies that were overseen by a
technical team at EPA.  The program was managed centrally because it covered
a broad spectrum of technical planning issues at many geographic locations,
several of which were in the Great Lakes Basin.  In 1982, the International
Joint Commission (IJC) established a Nonpoint Source Control Task Force to
review and evaluate the effectiveness of pollution reduction activities recom-
mended by the commission.  An August 1983 report provided an overview of the
extent of implementation and the effectiveness of various nonpoint source
programs in the Great Lakes Basin.  This paper summarizes the results of the
NURP projects in the Great Lakes Basin and compares them to the findings of
the IJC's Nonpoint Source Task Force.

      This paper has been reviewed in accordance with the U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency's peer and administrative review policies and approved for
presentation and publication.

                                INTRODUCTION

      The Nationwide Urban Runoff Program  (NURP) was initiated as part of the
water quality planning process required under Section 208 of the U.S. Clean
Water Act of 1977-   The program began in 1978 and concluded in 1983.  NURP
had six projects in four states within the Great Lakes Basin out of a total
of 28 demonstration projects participating.  Results from five of those six
projects are now available and will be discussed in this paper.
-'-Office of Water, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Washington DC  20460
  USA

                                     201

-------
       The NURP was conducted by the U.S. Environmental  Protection  Agency (EPA)
 and many cooperating federal, state, regional, and  local agencies distributed
 widely across the United States.  The program consisted  of  individual project
 studies that were overseen by a technical team at EPA.   The program was mana-
 ged   centrally because it covered a broad spectrum  of  technical and planning
 issues at many geographic locations, several of which  were  in the Great Lakes
 Basin.

      The program was developed, implemented and managed by the Office of
 Water's Water Planning Division at EPA with additional contributions from
 EPA's Office of Research and Development and the EPA regional offices.  The
 data  summary and analysis was done mainly by a team of consultants  under con-
 tract with  EPA.

      In  1972,  the  Pollution from Land Use Reference Group  (PLUARG) of the
 International Joint Commission  (IJC) was established for the purpose of de-
 termining  the levels and causes of pollution from land use  activities in the
 Great Lakes Basin.  PLUARG reported its findings and recommendations to the
 IJC  in  1978.  Subsequently,  the IJC forwarded a set of recommendations to the
 U.S.  and  Canadian governments in 1980.

      In  January 1982, the Water Quality Programs Committee of the  IJC' s
 Water Quality Board recommended that a Nonpoint Source Control Task Force be
 established.  Consequently,  the Water Quality Board set  up  a 14-member Task
 Force (seven members each from  the United States and Canada) .   The  Task Force
 was  to  review and evaluate the  effectiveness of the activities recommended by
 the  IJC to  reduce nonpoint source pollution.  The Task Force did this and
 prepared  a  report in August  1983.  The report provided an overview  of the
 extent  of  implementation and the effectiveness of various nonpoint  source
 programs  in the Great Lakes  Basin.

      This  paper summarizes  the results of the NURP projects  in the Great
 Lakes Basin and compares them to the findings of the IJC's  Nonpoint Source
 Task  Force.

               BACKGROUND OF NATIONWIDE URBAN RUNOFF PROGRAM

      The NURP was begun in 1978 in an effort to provide  the U.S. government
 with  answers to questions concerning urban runoff including:   (1) Is It a
 problem?  (2) What are its effects on receiving waters? and  (3)  What control
 mechanisms are available?

      The program consisted of 28 projects for collecting and  analyzing data
 in an effort to  answer the local questions that existed  as  well as  to provide
 information to U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency (EPA).   Because there
were local objectives  that had to be met, EPA played a strong  management role
to ensure  that each  project was  not off on its own  tangent.  This role called
for providing  technical  assistance in work plan development, in  data collection
and instrumentation  programs, in data analysis,  and in report writing.   The
result of  this approach was  28 projects working separately  but  also  within
the direction  of  the NURP team.
                                     202

-------
      A major objective of the NURP was the acquisition of data.  The data
would be used to characterize the urban runoff problem, evaluate receiving
water impacts, and evaluate management practices.  Because of this, quality
assurance and quality control were important elements in each project. There
was considerable effort to ensure that the NURP data were valid.  Questionable
data would be of no use.

      NURP collected data on an event basis with anywhere from 12 to 30 events
at one site.  Both discrete samples and composite samples were collected,
usually by an automatic sampler.  Rainfall volume, runoff volume, and runoff
quality data were collected from a number of urban catchments in each city.
The event mean concentration (EMC), defined as the total constituent mass
discharge divided by the total runoff volume, was chosen as the primary mea-
sure of the pollutant load.  EMCs were calculated for each event at each site
in the accessible data base.  If a flow-weighted composite sample was taken,
its concentration was used to represent the EMC.  Where sequential discrete
samples were taken over the hydrograph, the EMC was determined by calculating
the area under the loadograph (the curve of concentration times discharge rate
over time) and dividing it by the area under the hydrograph (the curve of
runoff volume over time).  For the purpose of determining EMCs, rainfall events
were defined to be separate precipitation events when there was an interven-
ing time period of at least 6 hours without rain.

      EMCs were chosen as the primary water quality characteristic subjected
to detailed analysis, even though it is recognized that mass loading char-
acteristics of urban runoff (e.g., pounds/acre for a specified time interval)
is ultimately the relevant factor in many situations.  The reason is that,
unlike EMCs, mass loadings are strongly influenced by the amount of precipi-
tation and runoff, and estimates of typical annual mass loads will be biased
by the size of monitored storm events.  The most reliable basis for charac-
terizing annual or seasonal mass loads is using EMCs and site-specific rain-
fall/runoff characteristics.  In addition, EMCs were chosen because we were
not interested in looking at one storm event but rather many storm events
over long periods of time.  What occurs during one storm event held little
interest to us.

      A statistical approach was adopted for characterizing the properties of
EMCs for standard pollutants.  Standard statistical procedures were used to
define the probability distribution, central tendency  (a mean or median) and
spread (standard deviation or coefficient of variation) of EMC data.  EMC
data for each pollutant from all storms and monitoring sites were compiled
in a central data base management system at EPA.

      The underlying probability distribution of the EMC data was examined
and tested by the NURP team and consultants, by both visual and statistical
methods.  With relatively few isolated exceptions, it was found that the
probability distribution of EMCs at individual sites can be characterized by
log-normal distributions.  Because of this, the log  (base e) transforms  of
all urban runoff data were used in developing the statistical  characteriza-
tions.
                                    203

-------
      In addition to summarizing and analyzing the concentration data,  sever-
al management control practices were evaluated and analyzed.  The management
practices analyzed were the use of detention basins and street sweeping.   De-
tention basins were also analyzed by the Nonpoint Source Control Task Force.

                 SUMMARY OF NURP PROJECTS IN GREAT LAKES BASIN

ASSESSMENT OF CONCENTRATIONS AND LOADS IN NURP PROJECTS

      As mentioned previously, six projects participating in the NURP were
located in the Great Lakes Basin.  Five of the six project's data have  been
analyzed by the NURP.  These five areas were Ann Arbor, Michigan; Lansing,
Michigan; Glen Ellyn, Illinois; Milwaukee, Wisconsin; and Rochester, New
York  (see Figure 1).

      The data analysis focused on ten pollutants, which were selected  after
initial screening of the data.  The pollutants were total suspended solids
(TSS), biochemical oxygen demand (BOD), chemical oxygen demand(COD), total
phosphorus (as P)(TP), soluble phosphorus (as P) (SP) , total kjeldahl nitro-
gen  (as N) (TKN), N - nitrite + nitrate (as N) (N02+3), total copper (Cu) ,
total lead (Pb), and total zinc (Zn).
Figure 1.   Nationwide  Urban Runoff  Program locations  in United States
                                   204

-------
      The NURP analysis summarized the statistical parameters—mean, median,
and coefficient of variation.  The data from the 22 sites in the 5 representa-
tive NURP projects are shown in Table 1.

TABLE 1.  STATISTICAL PARAMETERS FOR 22 SITES IN GREAT LAKES NURP
-
Pollutant No.
and Project observ.
Total Susp .
Solids (yg/1)
NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WI1
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI 3
Mil
Mil
MI 3
MI 3
Mil
MI 3
WI1
WI1
WI1
NY3
WI1
Mil
Mil
Total Phos-
phorus (yg/1)
NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WI1
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI 3
Mil
Mil
MI 3
MIS
Mil


10
7
45
33
23
27
11
9
5
35
23
6
6
23
5
47
58
42
12
29
18
20


13
8
45
35
23
26
13
12
5
35
22
6
6
23
Coeffic.
Mean variation


134
294
266
170
251
250
154
63
33
85
158
46
68
172
80
383
212
202
141
412
•92
188


301
448
229
258
453
506
193
195
91
198
458
103
268
394


1.15
1.12
0.44
0.68
0.69
0.75
0.92
0.74
0.77
1.28
1.26
0.37
0.47
0.85
0.91
0.78
0.86
0.68
0.76
0.97
0.82
0.94


0.54
0.47
0.45
0.51
0.69
0.79
0.46
0.47
0.38
0.64
0.65
0.50
0.47
0.54
90 percent
Median confidence limits


88
196
243
141
206
200
113
51
26
52
98
43
61
131
59
302,
161
167
112
296
71
137


265
405
209
230
373
397
175
177
85
167
384
93
243
347


52-150
85-263
219-270
117-169
165-258
161-249
74-173
34-77
14-50
39-69
69-139
32-58
42-88
101-171
28-124
255-357
131-197
142-196
79-159
229-382
53-95
101-186


206-340
300-456
188-233
201-264
298-466
314-501
141-217
140-223
60-121
141-197
309-477
63-137
168-351
285-410
                                     205

-------
TABLE 1 (cont'd).  STATISTICAL PARAMETETERS FOR 22 SITES IN GREAT LAKES NURP

Pollutant
and Project
MI 3
WI1
WI1
WI1
NY3
WI1
Mil
Mil
Soluble Phos-
phorus (yg/1)
NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WII
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI 3
Mil
Mil
MI 3
MI 3
Mil
MI3
WII
WII
WII
NY3
WII
Mil
Mil
TKN (yg/1)
NY3
NY 3
WII
WII
WII
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI 3
Mil
No.
observ.
5
47
60
44
12
29
18
17


0
0
0
0
0
24
0
0
5
32
20
6
6
21
5
0
0
0
0
0
14
16

13
7
45
15
1
0
13
10
5
35
Mean
134
289
108
105
216
511
546
435


-
-
-
-
-
98
-
-
33
43
68
13
59
47
39
-
—
_
_
_
127
59

1492
3246
1260
1102
_
1099
1111
889
1490
Coeffic.
variation
0.56
0.59
0.56
0.79
0.26
1.19
0.58
0.71


-
_
-
-
_
1.21
_
_
0.55
0.76
0.68
0.37
0.88
0.47
0.46
_
_
_
	
	
0.72
1.24

0.45
0.90
0.50
0.54
_
0.50
0.36
0.11
0.53
Median
117
249
94
82
209
330
472
355


—
_
_
_
_
63
_
_
29
34
56
13
44
42
35
	
_



103
37

1358
2411
1125
969

982
1045
883
1316
90 percent
confidence limits
71-193
218-284
84-105
69-98
183-239
245-443
378-589
271-465


-
_
_
—
—
45-88
	
	
18-47
28-42
44-71
10-17
24-82
45-50
23-53





76-140
24-56

1098-1679
1369-4245
908-1395
801-1173

778-1240
854-1279
796-981
1142-1516
                                   206

-------
TABLE 1 (cont'd).  STATISTICAL PARAMETERS FOR 22 SITES IN GREAT LAKES NURP

Pollutant No.
and Project observ.
Mil
MI 3
MIS
Mil
MI3
WI1
WI1
WI1
NY3
WI1
Mil
Mil
Nitrite plus
nitrate (yg/1)
NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WI1
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI 3
Mil
Mil
MIS
MIS
Mil
MI 3
WI1
WI1
WI1
NTS
WI1
Mil
Mil
Total copper
(yg/l)
NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WI1
23
6
6
23
5
16
27
25
13
8
18
18


0
0
18
24
3
21
0
0
5
35
23
6
5
23
5
17
28
26
0
12
18
17


0
0
0
0
0
Mean
1631
845
1056
1988
1116
1452
1023
1073
1256
1656
1274
1713


-
-
775
625
-
796
-
-
1108
775
883
284
469
875
1033
751
708
781
-
783
686
742


-
-
-
-
-
Coeffic.
variation
0.42
0.29
0.22
0.47
0.15
0.35
0.44
0.61
0.45
0.65
0.57
0.56


-
-
0.48
0.39
-
0.55
-
-
0.17
0.49
0.44
0.48
0.24
0.43
0.76
0.69
0.68
0.69
-
0.50
0.40
0.52


-
-
-
-
-
Median
1506
811
1031
1802
1104
1369
936
916
1144
1389
1107
1493


-
-
699
582
-
699
-
-
1092
696
807
256
456
803
821
618
584
642
-
702
637
657


—
-
-
-
-
90 percent
confidence limits
1304-1740
642-1025
862-1233
1536-2115
958-1273
1180-1589
815-1075
755-1110
925-1414
933-2068
891-1376
1205-1850


-
-
580-843
510-664
-
576-848
—
-
930-1283
192-558
694-938
176-372
364-571
693-931
431-1563
474-805
479-712
520-791
—
549-897
544-746
534-808


~
—
—
—
-
                                      207

-------
TABLE 1 (cont'd).   STATISTICAL  PARAMETERS  FOR 22  SITES  IN GREAT LAKES NURP

Pollutant
and Project
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI3
Mil
Mil
MIS
MIS
Mil
MIS
WI1
WI1
WI1
NY3
WI1
Mil
Mil
Total lead
(Mg/1)
NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WI1
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI 3
Mil
Mil
MI 3
MI 3
Mil
MIS
WI1
WI1
WI1
NY3
WI1
Mil
Mil
No.
observ.
26
0
0
0
16
13
0
0
9
0
0
0
0
0
0
6
7


13
87
44
35
22
24
10
12
0
24
18
6
5
18
4
45
59
44
13
27
13
13
Mean
49
-
-
-
15
30
-
-
14
-
-
-
-
-
-
36
25


34
193
95
108
303
322.
12
35
-
Ill
122
21
61
170
582
193
121
47
409
116
115
Coeffic.
variation
0.53
-
-
-
0.54
0.63
-
-
0.31
-
-
-
-
-
-
0.53
0.65


0.77
0.89
0.72
0.67
1.14
1.01
0.42
1.65
_
1.09
0.90
1.63
0.71
1.39
0.94
0.83
0.73
0.50
0.86
0.77
0.76
Median
43
-
-
-
13
26
-
-
13
-
-
-
-
_
-
32
21


27
144
77
90
200
227
11
18
_
75
91
11
50
99
424
148
98
42
310
92
92
90 percent
confidence limits
36-51
-
-
-
10-16
20-35
-
-
11-16
-
-
_
_
_
_
21-48
14-32


19-38
86-240
65-91
75-107
143-280
169-304
9-14
10-33

55-102
66-125
4-28
27-92
65-151
348-517
126-173
83-115
33-53
243-396
66-129
66-128
                                    208

-------
TABLE 1 (cont'd).  STATISTICAL PARAMETERS FOR 22 SITES IN GREAT LAKES NURP

Pollutant
and
No.
Coeffic.
Project observ. Mean
vari
ation Median
90 percent
confidence limits
Total zinc
(yg/D










































NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WI1
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI 3
Mil
Mil
MI3
MI 3
Mil
MI 3
WI1
WI1
WI1
NY3
WI1
Mil
Mil
*Site

Proj.
NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WI1
IL2
NY3
NY3
MIS
Mil
Mil
MI 3
MI 3
Mil
MI3
WI1
WI1
9
8
18
21
0
27
9
9
2
17
14
4
4
9
2
27
32
19
9
7
7
27
description:








415
488
106
108
_
230
792
1063










-
121
245
-
-
149
-
476
145
156
1416





280
244
223


Site Land use %
Cranston
E. Roch.
Bur bank
Hastings
Lincoln
Comb . Inl
Thornell
Thomas Cr
Traver
Waverly
Grand R.
Pitt AAS
Pitt AAN
Grace N
Swift Run
Wood Ctr
Post Off
100% Res
100% Res
100% Res
100% Res
97% Res.
85% Res.
.
.
.
.


100% Open
91% Open
90% Open
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed









100% Comm
0.
1.
1.
1.
_
0.
2.
3.
-
0.
0.
-
-
0.
-
1.
1.
0.
2.
0.
0.
0.

Area
(acres)
166
346
63
33
36
524
28,416
17,728
2,303
30
453
2,001
2,871
164
1,207
45
12
88
10
34
20

69
39
14

45
71


35

21
16
75
55
66
42
54

Pop
(no








































. Dens .
. /acre)
5
18
15
17
18
8
-
1
-
11
5
2
7
5
2
12
0
312
327
63
69
	
189
306
322
-
110
200
-
-
140
-
303
94
125
517
234
225
196


%








































Im
22
38
50
51
57
17
4
11
6
68
38
21
26
28
4
81
195-499
180-594,
42-95
49-99
_
154-232
130-720
124-839
_
92-132
148-271
-
-
113-173
-
222-414
71-124
96-163
214-1247
150-363
167-303
135-284



















100
                                     209

-------
  TABLE 1  (cont'd).  STATISTICAL PARAMETERS FOR 22 SITES  IN  GREAT  LAKES  NURP

Site description (cont'M) :
Pro j .
WI1.
NY3
WI1
Mil
Mil
Site Land use %
Rustler 100% Comm
Southgate 100% Comm
State Fr 74% Comm
Indus Dr 100% Ind
Grace S. 52% Ind
Area
(acres)
12
179
29
63
75
Pop. Dens.
(no. /acre)
0
2
10
0
5

% Imp.
100
21
77
64
39
        The  runoff  coefficient statistics also were calculated for the repre-
  sented sites  (Table  2).

  TABLE 2.   RUNOFF  COEFFICIENT STATISTICS FOR GREAT LAKES NURP SITES

Proj .
NY3
NY3
WI1
WI1
WI1
IL2
NY3
NY3
MI3
Mil
Mil
MI3
MI 3
Mil
MI3
WI1
WI1
WI1
NY3
WI1
•Mil
Mil
Site
Cranston
E. Roch.
Burbank
Hastings
Lincoln
Comb. Inl
Thornell
Thomas Cr
Traver
Waverly
Grand R.
Pitt AAS
Pitt AAN
Grace N
Swift Run
Wood Ctr
Post Off
Rustler
Southgate
State Fr
Indus . Dr
Grace S.
Land
use
%
100% Res.
100% Res.
100% Res.
100% Res.
97% Res.
85% Res.
100% Open
91% Open
90% Open
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
Mixed
100% Comm
100% Comm
100% Comm
74% Comm
100% Ind
52% Ind
Drainage
area
(acres)
166
346
63
33
36
524
28,416
17,728
2,303
30
453
2,001
2,871
164
1,207
45
12
12
179
29
63
75
Pop.
dens.
(no. /acre)
5
18
15
17
18
8
_
1
-
11
5
2
7
5
2
12
0
0
2
10
0
5
% Imp.
22
38
50
51
57
17
4
11
6
68
38
21
26
28
4
81
100
100
21
77
64
39
No.
obs .
13
9
44
33
19
29
13
13
5
35
23
6
6
23
5
44
54
39
13
27
18
20
Runoff
Median
0.16
0.20
0.27
0.27
0.38
0.17
0.06
0.04
0.11
0.36
0.11
0.19
0.10
0.11
0.21
0.76
0.90
0.79
0.20
0.62
0.10
0.11
Coeffic.
Coeff
variation
0.33
0.42
0.92
0.37
0.55
0.48
0.93
0.56
1.07
0.25
0.50
0.46
0.43
0.41
0.38
0.42
0.19
0.19
0.28
0.24
0.71
0.43
      The site mean EMC values are useful but the loading values are usually
what get published in the literature.   Using the event mean concentrations and
assuming 100 events per year,  annual loads from the Great Lakes projects were
calculated by the NURP team.   We used 100 events per year basically because it
                                     210

-------
simplified our analysis.  The number of storm events that occur annually in
the Great Lakes Basin, however ,  ranges  from 90  to  120.   Loadings  from  the  NURP
Great Lakes sites are summarized in Table 3.

TABLE 3.  LOADINGS FROM NURP GREAT LAKES SITES

Pollutant Mean event load (kg/ha)
Total suspended solids
Total phosphorus
Soluble phosphorus
TKN
N02 + N03
Total copper
Total lead
Total zinc
4.7658
0.007836
0.000979
0.037096
0.019934
0.000597
0.004245
0.006399
Annual load (kg/ha/yr)
477
0.78
0.10
3.7
2.0
0.06
0.42
0.64
      Table  3  includes  all  land  uses  taken  together.  We found, at the 95%
 confidence level,  that  there  is  no  significant difference in pollutant load-
 ing values between the  various land uses.

      The Nonpoint Source Control Task  Force  of  the IJC also published load-
 ing values based  on their pilot  watershed studies.  Table 4 shows that the
 NURP numbers compare well with the  PLUARG data.

      Annual urban runoff loads  for total phosphorus  from the  entire Great
 Lakes Basin  were  compared between the two studies.  Both showed that urban
 runoff  accounted  for approximately  7% of the  nonpoint load and 3% of the
 total load.

 ASSESSMENT OF  CONTROL PRACTICES  IN  GREAT LAKES BASIN

      In addition to assessing the  concentrations  of  urban runoff, the Michi-
 gan, Illinois,  and Wisconsin  projects all evaluated the effectiveness of
 either  street  sweeping  or detention basins.  In  fact, control  practice evalu-
 ation was the  focus of  these  projects.  Milwaukee, Wisconsin,  evaluated  street
 sweeping.  The primary  purpose of this  project was to evaluate the potential
 improvement  in stormwater quality caused by an accelerated street  sweeping
 program.  The  project selected pairs  of small, homogeneous watersheds.   One
 basin served as the test area and one as  the control  area.   The control  area
 was  swept using the same baseline frequency at which  it had  customarily  been
                                     211

-------
TABLE 4.  SUMMARY OF RANGES OF UNIT AREA LOADS OF SELECTED MATERIAL BY LAND USE FROM PILOT WATERSHED STUDIES
          DONE BY PLUARG

Annual unit area loads (kg/ha/yr)

Land uses
I Rural
General agriculture
Cropland
Improved pasture
Forest/wooded
Idle/ perennial
Sewage sludge
Waste water spray
Irrigation
II Urban
General urban
Residential
Commercial
Industrial
Developing urban
Suspended
solids
3-5600
20-5100
30-80
1-820
7-820
-

-

210-1750
620-2300
50-830
400-1700
27.500
Total
phosphorus
0.1-9.1
0.2-4.6
0.0-0.5
0.02-0.67
0.02-0.67
0.02

0.2-1.4

0.3-2.1
0.4-1.3
0.1-0.9
0.9-4.1
23
Filtered
reactive
phosphorus
0.01-0
0.05-0
0.02-0
0.01-0
0.01-0
0.01

0.1-1.

0.05-0
0.2
0.02-0
0.3
0.1
.6
.4
.2
.10
.07


3

.3

.08


Total
nitrogen
0.6-42
4.3-31
3.2-14
1-6.3
0.5-6.0
11

2-2.37

6.2-10
5-7.3
1.9-11
1.9-14
63.0


0
0
0
0
0
0

-

0
0
0
2
-

Lead
.002-0.08
.005-0.006
.001-0.015
.01-0.03
.01-0.03
.01



.14-0.5
.06
.17-1.10
.2-7.0


Copper
0.002-0.09
0.014-0.064
0.021-0.038
0.02-0.03
0.02-0.03
0.005

-

0.05-0.13
0.03
0.07-0.13
0.29-1.3
-



Zinc Chlorine
0.
0.
0.
0.
0,
0,



0
0
0
3
-
005-0.3
,026-0.083
,019-0.172
,01-0.03
,01-0.03
.2



.3-0.6
.02
.25-0.43
.5-12.0

10-120
10-50
-
2-20
20-35
10

40-160

130-380
1.050
10-150
-
75-160

-------
been swept.  The test areas were swept at frequencies that  were  higher  than
in the control areas.  The accelerated sweeping frequencies were selected  to
represent the possible range of sweeping frequencies that might  be  socially
and economically acceptable.

      A summary of street sweeping performance for the two  Wisconsin basins
is shown in Figure 2.



	
	









State Fair,
Wisconsin
Rustler,
Wisconsin
                                                                        Pb
                                                                        TKN
                                                                        TP
                                                                        COD
                                                                        TSS
 100     -50        0      +50     +100

           % EMC  Reduction

 Figure  2.   A summary  of  street  sweeping performance.
     As shown in  the figure, the mean concentrations are as likely to  be  in-
 creased as  decreased by street sweeping.  Also, it is shown that street
 sweeping never produced a dramatic  (i.e., >50%) reduction in concentrations.

     The analysis of the NURP street sweeping data base indicated that there
 is generally no significant difference between median EMCs for swept and  un-
 swept  conditions.  This is shown in Figure 3.
       Ann Arbor, Michigan, Lansing, Michigan, and Glen Ellyn, Illinois^evalua-
 ted  the  effectiveness  of  detention basins.  The basins monitored were "wet"
 basins— that  is, they  maintain  a permanent pool of water.  The ponds were
 designed such that  runoff from  an individual storm displaces all or part of
 the  prior volume, and  the residual is  retained until the next storm event.

       The data from the basins  were  analyzed  and  it  was  determined  that  the
 basins were  fairly  effective  in removing  pollutants.  The performance efficiency
 was  determined on the  basis of  the total  pollutant mass  removed over all
 storms  Table 5 summarizes detention  basin performance  in terms of reduction
 in pollutant  mass loads over  all monitored storm  events.  The analysis method-
 ology  used  suggests that  performance  should be expected  to improve  as the
 overflow rate (QR/A=mean  runoff rate/basin surface area) decreases  and as  the
 volume ratio  (VB/VR=basin volume/mean  runoff volume) increases.  The basins
 in Table 5 .are listed  in  increasing  order of  expected  performance  capabilities.
                                     213

-------
TSS (mg/l)

1 ?
O V |—
£ <
[P u
,_,

-1


Rustler. State Fair.
Wisconsin Wisconsin
                               400

                               300

                               200

                               100
Total Phosphorus
(mg/l)


1 -
o "5
c <
E^
Rustler. Stt
Wisconsin Wl
-

1 — I
]te Fair,
sconsin
                             0.8

                             0.6

                             0.4

                             0.2
   Street Sweeping Performance
         Site Median EMC
Street Sweeping Performance
      Site Median EMC
TKN (mg/l)

S .
^ >
° 5
c •<
fh
4j
Rustler,
Wisconsin








State Fair,
Wisconsin





   Street Sweeping Performance
         Site Median EMC

  Figure 3.  NURP street sweeping data.
                                                   Total  Lead (mg/l)
  s  I
  c  <
                                                  Rustler,
                                                 Wisconsin
                State Fair,
                Wisconsin
Street Sweeping Performance
      Site Median EMC
                                                                           0.8

                                                                           0.6

                                                                           0.4

                                                                           0.2
      An  alternative  approach  for  characterizing the performance of detention
basins was  developed  by  the NURP team.   This  approach concentrates on the
variable  characteristics of individual  storm  events and how these are modified
by  the _ detention device.  A comparison  of  the mean and coefficient of variation
o±  basin  inflow and discharge  concentrations  provides a measure of the perfor-
mance of  the device.
Great Lak          I ^°^& a/ummary of detention basin  performance in the
Great Lakes Basin when assessed in this manner.  In most cases,  more inlet
storm events were monitored than discharge events, and  some  inlet events do not
                                     214

-------
TABLE 5.  DETENTION BASIN PERFORMANCE
Pollutant and No. of
site storms
Lansing
Grace St. N. 18
Lansing
Grace St. S. 18
Ann Arbor
Pitt-AA 6
Ann Arbor
Traver 5
Ann Arbor
Swift Run 5
^ansing
Waverly Hills 29
NIPC
Lake Ellyn 23
Size
QR/A
8.75
2.37
1.86
0.30
0.20
0.04
0.10
ratios
VB/VR
0.05
0.17
0.52
1.16
1.02
7.57
10.70
Average mass removals-all monitored storms (percent)
TSS BOD COD TP Sol.P TKN NO 2+3 T. Cu T.Pb T. Zn
_14-____ - 9
32 3 - 12 23 7 1 26
32 21 23 18 - 14 7 nm 62 13
5 - 15 34 56 20 27 nm nm 5
85 4 2 3 29 19 80 nm 82
91 69 69 79 70 60 66 57 95 71
84 nm nm 34 nm nm nm 71 78 71
k- indicates apparent negative removals, nm indicates pollutant was not monitored.

-------
have a matching discharge event and vice-versa.   For the larger basins where
storm inflow displaces only a fraction of the basin volume, it is unlikely
that influent and effluent for a specific event  represent the same volume of
water.  The assumption used in this analysis is  that the inflow events that
were monitored provide a representative sample of the total population of all
influent EMCs.   Similarly, it is assumed that the monitored effluent events
are a representative sample of all basin discharge EMCs.
TABLE 6.  DETENTION BASIN PERFORMANCE*
Project and
site
Lansing
Grace St. N.
Lansing
Grace St. S.
Ann Arbor
Pitt-AA
Ann Arbor
Traver
Ann Arbor
Swift Run
No. of Percent reduction in mean EMCT
storms TSS BOD COD Tot.P Sol.P TKN N02+3 Tot.Cu Tot.Pb
23/20 (6) (26) 15 (10) (26) 11 (1) (9) 39
18/17 22 4 (3) 6 0 (5) (20) 25 14
6/6 38 17 23 28 (2) 11 8 n 59
5/5 0 (66) 12 37 63 19 28 n n
5/5 83 11 (3) (38) 21 25 77 n 86

Tot.Zn
(9)
7
22
19
n
Lansing
  Waverly Hills 35/30    87  52    52   69    56   30   54    53    93      58

NIPC
  Lake Ellyn    25/20    92   n    64   61    62    n   82    88    91      87


  In/Out: numbers are approximate and vary with pollutant.  Removals in paren-
  theses indicate negative removal.
 t"n" indicates pollutant either not monitored or  number of observations is
  too small for reliable estimate of percent reduction.

     For each basin influent and effluent, the arithmetic mean and variance were
computed based on the relationships  for lognormal  distributions.  The percent
reduction in the mean concentration  and the coefficient  of variation are tabu-
lated.

      Performance characteristics are generally consistent using either approach,
Performance improves with detention  basin size relative  to catchment size.  (It
is important to note that the Ann Arbor-Traver site had  an unstabilized bank at
the outlet of the newly constructed  basin.  This accounts for the poor suspen-
ded solids removal.)
                                     216

-------
TABLE 7.  DETENTION BASIN PERFORMANCE

Project and
site
Lans ing
Grace St. N.
Lansing
Grace St. S.
Ann Arbor
Pitt-AA
Ann Arbor
Traver
Ann Arbor
Swift Run
Lansing
Waverly Hills
NIPC
Lake Ellyn
No. of Percent reduction in coeff. of var. of EMCs
storms TSS BOD COD Tot.P Sol.P TKN N02+3 Tot.Cu Tot.Pb
23/20 14 49 35 (7) (13) 30 0 0 45
18/17 (7) (59) 39 13 0 20 21 17 18
6/6 17 (6) 10 28 (84) 37 0 n 53
5/5 14 (109) 58 (3) 42 (150) (82) n n
5/5 (5) 39 50 (150) 0 20 (150) n 26
35/30 38 5 69 34 26 (8) (198) (22) 34
25/20 44 n 41 71 48 n (115) 60 19

Tot .Zn
(31)
15
(5)
0
n
(36)
41
  *In/Out:   numbers  are approximate and  vary  with  pollutant.  Removals in paren-
  theses  indicate negative removal.
  i~"n"  indicates  pollutant either not monitored or number  of  observations is too
  small for reliable estimate of percent reduction.


     The  urban component of nonpoint sources received relatively  little atten-
 tion in the PLUARG  studies.  The PLUARG studies centered  mainly on  problem
 characterization, watershed planning, technology  demonstrations and policy
 development.  Therefore, it is not possible  to compare the results  of the con-
 trol practice evaluation done in NURP with the IJC Nonpoint Source  Task Force
 evaluation.

                                  CONCLUSIONS

     The  NURP team, with the assistance of the technical consultants,  analyzed
 and summarized the  data from 22 of the 28 participating projects.  Five  of
 these  projects were located in the Great Lakes Basin.

     The  data from the NURP projects in the Great Lakes Basin consisted of
 assessment data to  help determine the existence of water quality problems
 caused by urban runoff and best management practice  data to determine the
 effectiveness of control practices.
                                      217

-------
     Examination of the assessment data from the Great Lakes projects shows
that the loading values for the studied pollutants are relatively low.  The
numbers calculated for all the pollutants were lower by at least 15% than
the nationwide values reported in the other NURP projects.

     The NURP team focused on total phosphorus loads from the Great Lakes
Basin and found that urban runoff accounted for 7% of the nonpoint load to
the lakes and 3% of the total load.  PLUARG reported similar loading values.

      Thus, based on an analysis of the NURP data, urban nonpoint sources do
not constitute a major portion of the pollutant load to the Great Lakes Basin.
Pollutants in urban runoff, however, may contribute to water quality problems
in the local receiving waters and near shore areas of the Great Lakes.

      The PLUARG report also concluded that pollutant loadings from urban run-
off generally do not constitute a significant problem on a lakewide basis.

      Two control practices were evaluated in the Great Lakes Basin—street
sweeping and detention basins.  Analysis of the NURP street sweeping data
showed that no significant reductions in event concentrations were realized
by street sweeping.  In no case did reductions in concentration ever exceed
50%.  It can be concluded that street sweeping is generally ineffective as a
technique for improving the quality of urban runoff.

      Most of the detention basins monitored in the Great Lakes area were wet
basins—that is, basins that maintain a permanent pool of water.   The basins
monitored were designed such that runoff from an individual storm displaces
all or part of the prior volume,  and the residual is retained until the next
event.  Analysis of the detention basin data in the Great Lakes area generally
showed that they were effective in removing most pollutants.   It  was found
that performance improved with detention basin size relative to catchment
size and hence the magnitude of the runoff processed.   Reduction  in overall
mass load ranged from negative to greater than 90% removal.
                                    218

-------
   TRENDS IN THE DEVELOPMENT OF WATER TOXICOLOGY IN THE USSR AMD THE US

                                    by

                             L. A. Lesnikov^
                                 ABSTRACT
     Studies of the chronic effects of toxicants on fish in the Union of
Soviet Socialist Republics and the United States are reviewed and maximum
permissible concentrations and water quality  criteria of the respective
countries are compared.
                       INTRODUCTION AND DISCUSSION

     The problem of contamination has acquired urgency in connection with
the swift growth of industry and urbanization of the population (Klein 1957),
Water toxicology — the science of the influence of contaminants on water
organisms — began to develop.  In the USSR, the first toxicological works
concerned estimates of the effect of petroleum contamination on fish
(Arnold 1897, Nikolskiy 1983, Khlopin 1902, Chermak 1986), and in
Great Britain — of the salts of heavy metals (Carpenter 1927).  According
to "Quality Criteria for Water" (Anon. 1972), the study of the effect of
contaminants on fish was begun from the beginning of the century (Marsh
1907, Shelford 1917).

     In our country, the dependence of the survival rate of test organisms
on the concentration of the substance being studied was analyzed on the
basis of brief experiments (Beklemishev and Lyubishchev 1924).  In our
opinion (Lesnikov 1976), this direction is most promising.  In the United
States, the basic indicator in estimating the effect is the establishment
of median lethal concentrations — 24, 48, and 96-hour LC5Q (Anon. 1979,
Anon. 1976).  Along with this, proposals to establish 1X59 for a nurber of
periods and only then analyze the shape of the curve are encountered
(Alabaster and Lloyd 1980, Anderson 1948).  Probably, both curves  should
be identical within the limits of statistical accuracy (Figure  1).
Anderson (1948) proposes considering the value of LC^Q.  Alabaster and
Lloyd (1980) consider the asymptote toward which  this segment  of the
curve strives as the threshold of the median concentration.
      State  Scientific Research  Institute  of  Lake,  River  and Fishing Man-
agement, Leningrad, USSR.
                                     219

-------

-------
et al. 1977, McKim et al.  1976); toxaphene (Mayer et al. 1975); phthalic
esters (Sanders et al.  19-); Bayer-73 (Sanders 1977); acrolein, heptachlor,
endosulfan, and trifluralin (Macek et al. 1976); chromium (Sauter et al.
1976); arochlor-1254 (Snarski and Puglisi 1976); diazinon (Allison and
Hermanutz 1977); and hydrogen sulfide (Lloyd 1976).  Obviously, the list
of substances with, which chronic experiments were conducted in the United
States is far from complete.

     In the USSR, up to now about 500 fishing industry MFC's have been
developed that are based on the results of chronic experiments.

     We examine fishing industry MFC's in the USSR and "Quality Criteria
for Water"  (Anon. 1976) which protect the hydrobionts in the United States
since these are the standards.  According to our data, they are close to
those of public health and, in 60 percent of the cases, below them.  There-
fore, in protecting the fish-producing properties of basins, we also pro-
tect other  types of water  consumption.  Protection of fishing industry
interests is not a special point of little significance in the overall
strategy of protecting basins from contamination.

     To what degree are the procedures for working out the MFC's in the
USSR and the water quality criteria in the United States comparable?
Some of the test organisms used in both countries are identical.  They
are the fish—Salmo irrideus, Cyprinus carpio, Esox lucius, and Ferca
fluviatilis; the invertebrates— Daphnia magna, Chironomus plumosus, and
Asellus aquaricus as well  as various species of Gammaridae; and algae—
Scenedesmus quadricanda.

     A number of species are similar in toxicological resistance (Lesnikov
1980).  Therefore, the data obtained in both countries are completely
comparable.  A comparison  of the MFC values and the water quality criteria
shows that, as a rule, the figures are either identical or close to one
another (Table 1).

     A comparison of the values obtained shows that in the United States
greater significance is devoted to the consideration of local  conditions
while in the USSR values common for the country are established.  The
latter may  be excessively  rigid for some cases but more convenient for
monitoring purposes and more economical as regards calculations of water
protection  systems.  A zero MFC is adopted in the USSR if the  MFC of  the
substance is below 0.0001 mg/1.

     In the USSR one of the mandatory indices is the estimate  of  the
effect of contaminants on  the hydrochemical condition  of basins  (the  pH
dynamics, dissolved oxygen, biological oxygen requirement,  permanganate
oxidizability, forms of nitrogen).  We did not find similar  studies  in
accessible  literature from the United States.

      In  turn, a procedure  has been developed in  the United  States to  esti-
mate  the  effect of substances on the spawning of fish, which permits  con-
sidering  the  effect of  toxicants on the maternal species,  on their progeny
from  roe  to spawning, and  on the roe and larvae  from  them.   Unquestionably,


                                    221

-------
TABLE 1.  WATER QUALITY CRITERIA (WQC) OF THE U.S. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
          AGENCY (Anon. 1976) IN COMPARISON WITH CORRESPONDING FISH INDUSTRY
          MFC's OF THE USSR (mg/1)
Contaminants
                   WQC
           U.S.
                 Notes
                       MPC
                                             USSR
                 Notes
Ammonia
   0.02
nonionized, e.g.,
ammonia gas
Arsenic

Cadmium
Chromium

Copper


Cyanides

Mercury
   0.05

   0.0004
   0.004

   0.012

   0.005

   0.1

   0.1
96 h LC50

   0.005

   0.00005
Nickel
   0.0001

   0.01
96 h LC5(J
for salmon;
in soft water,

  for other species

in soft water

in hard water

in sea water
for most sensitive
species
in fresh water
in sea water

for most sensitive
species
0.05


0.5

0.005

0.005
0.01

0.001

0.001
0.005

0.05

0.0001



0.00001


0.001

0.01
                                                              ammonia gas
                                                              ammonia salt
in fresh water
                                                              in sea water
in fresh water
in sea water
                                                             mercuric
                                                             chloride in
                                                             fresh  water

                                                             granosan in
                                                             fresh  water

                                                             in  sea water
(continued on next  page)
                                    222

-------
Table 1.  (Continued)
Contaminants
                  WQC
                           U.S.
                                                            USSR
                     Notes
                       MFC
              Notes
Petroleum
products and
lubricating
oils
Dissolved
oxygen
DDT



Lindane


  -isomer  of
hexachloran

Malathion

(karbofos)

Toxaphene
   0.01
96 h LC50
   5.0
   and
   more
   0.000004
   0.0001
for several most
sensitive species:
film on water sur-
face and in soils
prohibited; commer-
cial qualities of
hydrobionts should
not spoil (no exact
figures)

in water and soils
of salmon spawning
grounds
0.05
0.01
for fresh
water film on
water surface
prohibited for
sea water
6.0 and
more
                                                     6.0
                                                     4.0
   0.000001
   0.00001     for fresh water
for sea water
   0.000005
in summer in
water
          in winter in
          1st category
          basins

          in winter in
          2d category
          basins

          absence of
          any prepara-
          tive forms

          absence of
          all forms

          and isomers
          of hexachloran

          absent
                                                absent
 (Polychlorocamphene)
 (continued on next page)
                                      223

-------
Table 1.   (Continued)
Contaminants
                  WOC
                           U.S.
                                    Notes
                                                            USSR
                                                     MFC
                                                     Notes
PH
Phenol
Phosphate
Phosphorous
   6.5-9.0       for  fresh water        6.5-8.5
   6.5-8.5       for  sea water

   0.001         to protect  com-        0.001
                mercial quality
                of fish

   0.1           for  river sections     0.04
                far  from lakes

   0.05         for  rivers  near
                lakes
                                for K2HP03
                                (0.31 for salt)
                0.025
Phthalic
esters

Zinc
   0.003
   0.01
96 h LC50
                for  lakes  and  res-
                ervoirs; in  addi-
                tion,  the  charge
                for  basins is
                calculated
according to sensi-
tivity of local
species
0.05      phthalic anhy-
          dride

0.01      for fresh water
0.05      for sea water
these are important and needed studies.  In the USSR, the introduction of
such procedures is hindered in that our country is located further north.
The fish have relatively long life cycles (4 to 7 years or more); therefore,
such experiments are unrealistic.  However, we are now selecting species
with a relatively short life cycle and sufficiently sensitive to contami-
nants.  Such experiments on invertebrates and Daphnias have long been con-
ducted in the USSR.  It is shown on fish that if the producers (male or
female or one of the parents) are in a toxic solution during the last month
of ovogenesis the viability of the progeny is reduced noticeably (Bykova
1978).  The experiments were performed on lamprey (Misgurnus fossilis).

     A common scheme for the conduct of experiments to estimate the danger
of contaminants in the U.S. is close.  Therefore, cooperation of efforts
and the exchange of data are fully realistic.  At present there are about
650 substances on which various toxicological data are available in the
                                    224

-------
USSR and the US or other countries.  Now tens of thousands of contaminants
are entering the basins.  The conduct of toxicological studies according to
the full program requires from one to three and a half years.  Therefore,
cooperative efforts of Soviet and American water toxicologists is not only
desirable, but also necessary to accelerate the process of compiling a
"toxicological catalog" of at least the basic contaminants.
                                 REFERENCES

Alabaster J. S. and R. Lloyd.  1980.  Water Quality Criteria for Freshwater
     Fish.  London; Boston.  297 p.

Allison D. T. and 0. Hermanutz.  1977.  Toxicity of Diazinon to brook trout
     and fathead minnows.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Washington
     B.C.  EPA-600/3-77-060.

Anderson B. G.  1948.  The apparent threshold of toxicity to Daphia magna
     for chlorides of different metals when added to Lake Erie water.
     Trans. Amer. Fish. Soc.   78:96-113.

Anon. 1976.  Quality Criteria  for Water,  U.S. Environmental Protection
     Agency, Washington D.C.   256 p.

Anon.  1979.  A review of the  EPA Red Book:  Quality Criteria for Water.
     Bethesda, MD.  313 p.

Arnold, I. N.  1897.  On the effect of petroleum on fish.  Vestnik
     Rybopromyshlennosti.  12(4):167-196.           '

Beklemishev, V. N.  1923.  On  the course of the extinction of the ento-
     mostraca population in a  salt solution.  Trudy pervogo Vserossiyskogo
     syezda zoologov, anatomov, i gistologov  [Proceedings of the First
     Ail-Russian Congress of'Zoologists, Anatomists, and Histologists].
     pp. 142-143.

Beklemishev, V. N. and A. A. Lyubishchev.   1924.  Formulas to find constants
     in toxicity equations.  Izvestiya Biologicheskikh Nii I Biologicheskikh
     Statyey Permskogo Universiteta.  3(4):41-52.

Benoit D.A., E.N. Leonard, G.M.  Christensen and J.T. Fiandt.  197b.  Effects
     of cadmium on three generations  of brook trout (Salvelinus fontinalis).
     Trans. Amer. Fish. Soc.   105(4):550-556.

Brungs, W.A.  1972.  Effects of  pesticides  and  industrial wastes  on  surface
     water use.  In:  River Ecology and Man.  N.Y.  p.  353-365.

Bykova, A.V.  1972.  Toxic effect of  mercuric chloride  on embryogenesis
     of fish using the example of lamprey.  Express information service of
     Central Scientific-Research Institute  of Information and Technical-
     Economic Studies of the Fishing  Industry.   Issue  9.  pp 11-13.
                                     225

-------
Carlson, A.R.  1972.  Effects of long term exposure to carbaril (sevin) on
     survival, growth and reproduction of the fathead minnow (Pimephales
     promelas).  J. Fish. Res. Board Canada.  28(5):583-587.

Carpenter, K.E.  1927.  The lethal action of soluble metallic salts on
     fishes.  Brit. J. Exper. Biol.  (4):278-390,

Carwell, R.D., D.G. Foreman, T.R. Payne and D.J. Wilbar.  1977.  Acute and
     chronic  toxicity of chlordane to fish and invertebrates.  U.S. Environ-
     mental Protection Agency. Washington DC.  EPA-600/3-77-019.

Chermak, N.   1986.  On the effect of petroleum on fish.  Vestnik Rybopromy-
     shlennosti.  1:1-30.

Christensen G., E. Hunt and J. Fiandt.  1977.  The effect of methylmercuric
     chloride, cadmium chloride and lead nitrate on six biochemical factors
     of brook trout (Salvelinus fontinalis).  Toxicology and Applied
     Pharmacology.  42:523-530.

Khlopin, G.V.  1902.  Contamination of running water by farm and factory
     waste products and measures for its elimination.  Ucheniye zapisky
     Yuryevetskogo Universiteta (Scientific Notes of Yurevets University).
     No 2.  p  115.

Klein, L.  1957.  Aspect of River Pollution.  621 p.

Lesnikov, L.A.  1973.  Methodological Instructions on Establishing Permis-
     sible Concentrations of Harmful Substances in the Water of Fishing
     Industry Basins.  Leningrad, USSR.  22 pages.

Lesnikov, L.A.  1976.  A comparison of various procedures for the conduct
     of water toxicological experiments.  Izvestiya Gosniorkh.  109:3-7.

Lesnikov, L.A. 1980.  Comparison of principles of development and use of
     water quality standards in the USSR and the USA.  U.S. Environmental
     Protection Agency: Washington DC.  EPA-600/9-80-034.

Lloyd, L.S.   1976.  Chronic effects of low levels of hydrogen sulfide on
     freshwater fish.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Washington DC.
     EPA-600/3-78-076.

Lloyd, L.S., D.M. Oseid D.M., I.R. Adelman and Broderius.  1976.  Effect
     of hydrogen sulfide and invertebrates.  Part 1.  Acute and chronic
     Toxicity Studies.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Washington
     DC.  EPA-600/3-76-062.

Macek, K.J., M.A. Lindberg, S. Sauter, K.S. Buxton and P.H. Costa.  1976.
     Toxicity of four pesticides to water fleas and fathered minnows.
     Acute and chronic toxicity of acrolein, heptachlor, endosulfan, and
     trifluralin to the water flea (Daphnia magna) and and the fathead
     minnow (Pimephales promelas).  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
     Washington DC.  EPA-600/3-76-899.


                                     226

-------
Marsh, M.C.  1907.  The effect of some industrial wastes on fishes.  Water
     supply and irrigation paper.  N  192, p. 337-348.

Mayer, F.L., P.M. Mehrle and W.P. Dwyer.  1975.  Toxaphene effects on repro-
     reproduction, growth, and mortality of brook trout.  U.S. Environmental
     Protection Agency, Washington DC.  EPA-600/3-75-013.

McKim, J.M., G.F. Olson and G.W. Holcombe.  1976.  Long-term effects of
     methylmercuric chloride on three generations of brook trout (Salvelinus
     fontinalis).  Toxicity, accumulation, distribution and elimination.
     J. Fish. Res. Board Canada.  33(12):2726-2734.

Nikolskiy, A.M.   1893.  On the significance of petroleum in the life of
     •fish of the  Volga River.  Rybnoye Delo.   15:260-288.

Pickering G., W.  Brungs and M. Cast.  1977.  Effect of exposure time and
     copper concentration on reproduction of the fathead minnow (Pimephales
     promelas).   Water Research.  11:1079-1083.

Sanders, H.O.  1977-  Toxicity of the molluscocide and residue dynamics of
     Bayer 2352 in aquatic invertebrates.  Investigation in Fish control.
     78:1-7.

Sanders, H.O. , F.L. Mayer and D.F. Walsh.  19 — -  Toxicity, residue dynamics
     and reproductive effects of phthalate esters on aquatic invertebrates.
     Environmental Res..  6(1):84-90.

Sauter S. , K.S. Buxton, R.J. Macek and S.R. Petrocelli.  1976.  Effects of
     exposure to  heavy metals on selected freshwater fish.  Toxicity of cop-
     per, cadmium, chromium and lead  to eggs and fry of seven fish species.
     U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Washington DC.  (EPA-600/3-76-105),

Shelford, V.E.  1917.  An experimental study of the effects of gas wastes
     upon fishes  with especial reference to stream pollution.  Bull.
     Illinois State Lab. for Nat. History.  11:381-412.

Snarski, V.M. and F.A. Puglisi.  1976.  Effects of arochlor or 1284 on brook
     trout (Salvelinus fontinalis).   U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
     Washington DC.EPA-600/3-76-112.

Stroganov, N.S.   1941.  New ways to solve the  problem of the effect of indus-
     trial runoff water on water organisms.  Scientific notes of Moscow
     State University.  Biologiya.  Issue 60.  pp 5-24.

Stroganov, N.S.   1971.  A procedure for determining toxicity of the water
     Medium.  In:  Metodiki issledovaniy po vodnoy toksikologii (Procedures
     for Studies  on Water Toxicology).  Moscow, USSR,  pp 14-60.

Yeltsina, N.V.  1939.  The effect of  sea salt  on the development of daphnia
     and adaptation to conditions of  increased salinity.  Problems in
     Ecology and  Biocenology.  Issue  4.  pp 128-142.
                                     227

                          -.US GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE 19860646-116-40649

-------